ADC Network Router Broadband System User Manual

ADCP-61-471  
Issue 4  
June 2000  
Soneplex® Broadband System  
Operation and Maintenance  
Manual (V5.3)  
1037961 Rev A  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Preface  
LIST OF CHANGES  
The technical changes incorporated into this issue are listed below.  
SECTION  
IDENTIFIER  
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGE  
Removed list of contents.  
Added new publications.  
Cover/Title page  
Related Publications  
FM  
FM  
List of Acronyms  
and Abbreviations  
Added new acronyms and abbreviations.  
1
TAD-101  
Turned specifications into a TAD. Combined Version D HLXC tables and  
Version E HLXC information into one table.  
Various  
Changed “smartjack” to “NID”.  
Old Sections  
1, 3, 4, and 5  
Removed and transferred sections on system description and front panel  
interface to 61-472 (Soneplex Description, Design, and Application Manual).  
Various  
Added information on dual repeater functionality, Version E HLXC, Version E  
HLXR, HLXR 3192, and RLXIOR throughout manual.  
Removed NTP-006 (empty page) and renumbered successive NTPs.  
Changed DLP-524 (Access Identifier) to TAD-106, and renumbered successive  
DLPs.  
Removed DLP-532 (empty page) and renumbered successive DLPs.  
Added TAD-102 (Loopback Process Description)  
Moved “TBOS Daisy-Chaining” from TBOS section; created DLP-574 from it.  
Moved TBOS interface description information from TBOS section; created  
TAD-104 from it.  
Moved TL1 interface description information from TL1 section; created  
TAD-105 from it.  
TRADEMARK INFORMATION  
ADC and Soneplex are registered trademarks of ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
CLEI is a trademark of Bellcore.  
SLC-96 is a trademark of AT&T Technologies, Inc.  
"SLC" is a registered trademark of Lucent Technologies, Inc.  
Page iii  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Preface  
Page iv  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Preface  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
Content  
Page  
FRONT MATTER  
ABOUT THIS MANUAL ...................................................................... ix  
RELATED PUBLICATIONS .................................................................... ix  
ADMONISHMENTS..........................................................................x  
GENERAL SAFETY PRECAUTIONS................................................................x  
FCC COMPLIANCE STATEMENT ................................................................ xi  
CERTIFICATION........................................................................... xi  
STANDARDS............................................................................. xi  
LIST OF ACRONYMS AND ABBREVIATIONS ........................................................xii  
SECTION 1  
INTRODUCTION  
1
2
3
GENERAL......................................................................... 1-1  
USING THE CRAFT INTERFACE .......................................................... 1-1  
EDITING FIELDS .................................................................... 1-3  
3.1 Cursor ..................................................................... 1-3  
3.2 Arrow Keys .................................................................. 1-3  
3.3 Enter and Return Keys .......................................................... 1-3  
3.4 Space Bar................................................................... 1-4  
3.5 "R" Key..................................................................... 1-4  
3.6 Control Key.................................................................. 1-4  
3.7 Pop-Up Screens............................................................... 1-4  
3.8 Help Screen ................................................................. 1-4  
3.9 Data Entry .................................................................. 1-5  
USING A TOP DOCUMENT.............................................................. 1-5  
4
1
SECTION 2  
OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE  
GENERAL......................................................................... 2-1  
ALPHABETICAL TASK LIST .................................................................. 2-1  
–48 VDC POWER SUPPLY TEST ........................................................ DLP-508  
ACCESS IDENTIFIER ................................................................ TAD-106  
ACO (ALARM CUT-OFF) COMMAND ...................................................... DLP-539  
ALARM HISTORY CLEARANCE COMMAND ................................................. DLP-527  
ALARM HISTORY DISPLAY............................................................ DLP-544  
ALARM SUMMARY DISPLAY .......................................................... DLP-543  
ALARM TROUBLESHOOTING ...........................................................TAP-101  
ALARM/EVENT NOTIFICATION LEVEL SETTING .............................................. DLP-552  
(continued)  
Page v  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Preface  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
Content  
Page  
SECTION 2  
OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE  
(continued)  
ALARMS PROCEDURES .............................................................. NTP-006  
APU INSTALLATION AND TESTING ....................................................... DLP-503  
ASSIGNMENT RECORDS.............................................................. DLP-523  
CHASSIS INSPECTION ............................................................... DLP-501  
CIRCUIT ID DISPLAY ................................................................ DLP-566  
CONFIGURATION DATA DOWNLOAD COMMAND.............................................. DLP-555  
CONFIGURATION DATA UPLOAD COMMAND ................................................ DLP-554  
CRAFT INTERFACE SYSTEM LOGOFF ..................................................... DLP-564  
CRAFT INTERFACE SYSTEM LOGON ...................................................... DLP-526  
DLX ALARM LEVEL SETTING ........................................................... DLP-563  
DLX AND REMOTE SYSTEM END-TO-END TEST PROCEDURES .................................... NTP-010  
DLX CONFIGURATION ............................................................... DLP-532  
DLX INSTALLATION AND TESTING ....................................................... DLP-521  
DLX- OR RLX-EQUIPPED CIRCUIT END-TO-END TESTS ......................................... DLP-522  
DLX STATUS DISPLAY ............................................................... DLP-553  
DS1 PM CONFIGURATION............................................................. DLP-556  
DS3 MUX ALARM LEVEL SETTING ....................................................... DLP-560  
DS3 MUX APS TEST................................................................. DLP-512  
DS3 MUX CONFIGURATION............................................................ DLP-529  
DS3 MUX FORCED SWITCH TEST........................................................ DLP-511  
DS3 MUX INSTALLATION AND TESTING ................................................... DLP-505  
DS3 MUX STATUS DISPLAY ........................................................... DLP-546  
DUAL REPEATER INCOMPATIBILITY DIAGNOSIS.............................................. TAP-104  
FIBER OPTIC CONNECTOR AND ADAPTER CLEANING AND MATING INSTRUCTIONS ...................... DLP-507  
FORCE/APS COMMANDS ............................................................. DLP-537  
HDSL PM CONFIGURATION............................................................ DLP-557  
HDSL-EQUIPPED CIRCUIT CROSS-CONNECTS ............................................... DLP-515  
HLX ALARM LEVEL SETTING ........................................................... DLP-562  
HLX AND HRX STATUS DISPLAY ........................................................ DLP-548  
HLX CONFIGURATION ............................................................... DLP-531  
HLX LOOPBACK CONFIGURATION ....................................................... DLP-573  
HLXC AND HLXR END-TO-END TESTS ..................................................... DLP-520  
HLXC AND REMOTE SYSTEM END-TO-END TEST PROCEDURES ................................... NTP-009  
HLXC INSTALLATION AND TESTING ...................................................... DLP-516  
INVENTORY DISPLAY................................................................ DLP-540  
LOCAL CRAFT INTERFACE CONNECTION TROUBLESHOOTING..................................... TAP-103  
LOCAL CRAFT INTERFACE CONNECTION ................................................... DLP-504  
(continued)  
Page vi  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Preface  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
Content  
Page  
SECTION 2  
OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE  
(continued)  
LOOPBACK PROCESS DESCRIPTION ..................................................... TAD-102  
LOOPBACK STATUS/COMMANDS ....................................................... DLP-541  
MAINTENANCE PHILOSOPHY .......................................................... TAD-100  
MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES.......................................................... NTP-005  
MENU SECURITY EDITING ............................................................ DLP-536  
MODULE INSTALLATION AND TESTING PROCEDURES ......................................... NTP-002  
MPU ALARM LEVEL SETTING .......................................................... DLP-559  
MPU CONFIGURATION DATA SAVE AND TRANSFER PROCEDURES ................................. NTP-008  
MPU INSTALLATION AND TESTING ...................................................... DLP-502  
MPU REPLACEMENT AND TESTING ...................................................... DLP-519  
MPU SOFTWARE DOWNLOAD COMMAND.................................................. DLP-551  
MPU VERSION 5 SOFTWARE INSTALLATION AND TESTING PROCEDURES ............................ NTP-007  
ODS2 DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM AND QFLC/QLX CHASSIS END-TO-END TESTS .......................... DLP-510  
ODS2 MODULE ALARM LEVEL SETTING ................................................... DLP-561  
ODS2 MODULE AND REMOTE SYSTEM END-TO-END TEST PROCEDURES ............................ NTP-003  
ODS2 MODULE APS TEST ............................................................ DLP-514  
ODS2 MODULE CONFIGURATION ....................................................... DLP-530  
ODS2 MODULE FORCED SWITCH TEST THROUGH THE CRAFT INTERFACE............................ DLP-513  
ODS2 MODULE INSTALLATION AND TESTING ............................................... DLP-506  
ODS2 MODULE STATUS DISPLAY ....................................................... DLP-547  
PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTING LOCATIONS ........................................ TAD-103  
PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTS DESCRIPTION .........................................TAP-102  
PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTS RETRIEVAL .......................................... DLP-565  
RESET/LED TEST COMMANDS ......................................................... DLP-538  
RLX ALARM LEVEL SETTING .......................................................... DLP-518  
RLX (OR RLXIOR) AND REMOTE SYSTEM END-TO-END TEST PROCEDURES........................... NTP-011  
RLX CONFIGURATION ............................................................... DLP-534  
RLX INSTALLATION AND TESTING ...................................................... DLP-525  
RLX AND RLXIOR STATUS DISPLAY ..................................................... DLP-509  
RLX (OR RLXIOR) TO REPEATER VOLTAGE AND CURRENT TEST .................................. DLP-567  
RLX-EQUIPPED CIRCUIT CROSS-CONNECTS ................................................ DLP-569  
RLXIOR CONFIGURATION ............................................................ DLP-533  
RLXIOR INSTALLATION AND TESTING .................................................... DLP-524  
RTAU INSTALLATION AND TESTING ..................................................... DLP-517  
RTAU OPERATION ................................................................. DLP-570  
SERIAL PORT CONFIGURATION ........................................................ DLP-549  
SHELF HOUSEKEEPING ALARM LABELS................................................... DLP-550  
(continued)  
Page vii  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Preface  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
Content  
Page  
SECTION 2  
OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE  
(continued)  
SHELF STATUS DISPLAY ............................................................. DLP-545  
SPECIFICATIONS................................................................... TAD-101  
STREAKER INSTALLATION AND TESTING .................................................. DLP-571  
SYSTEM COMPONENTS INSPECTION ..................................................... DLP-500  
SYSTEM OR CIRCUIT PROVISIONING PROCEDURES ........................................... NTP-004  
SYSTEM TID/DATE/TIME SETTING ....................................................... DLP-528  
TAU INSTALLATION AND TESTING ....................................................... DLP-574  
TAU OPERATION ................................................................... DLP-575  
TBOS CHASSIS DAISY-CHAINING ........................................................ DLP-576  
TBOS INTERFACE DESCRIPTION ........................................................ TAD-104  
TRANSACTION LANGUAGE 1 (TL1) INTERFACE DESCRIPTION..................................... TAD-105  
USER ACCOUNT EDITING ............................................................. DLP-535  
VERSION C HLXC VOLTAGE TO HLXR TEST ................................................. DLP-568  
VERSION D (OR LATER) HLXC VOLTAGE TO HLXR TEST......................................... DLP-572  
X.25 PORT CONFIGURATION........................................................... DLP-558  
SECTION 3  
GENERAL INFORMATION  
1
2
3
4
5
6
WARRANTY/SOFTWARE ...............................................................3-1  
REPAIR/ADVANCE REPLACEMENT POLICY ...................................................3-1  
REPAIR CHARGES ...................................................................3-2  
REPLACEMENT/SPARE PRODUCTS ........................................................3-2  
RETURNED MATERIAL ................................................................3-2  
CUSTOMER INFORMATION AND ASSISTANCE .................................................3-3  
Page viii  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Preface  
ABOUT THIS MANUAL  
This manual describes how to operate and maintain the ADC Soneplex Broadband system  
(V5), which is a DS1-based multiplexer with an interface that is compatible with DS3  
networks. It is specifically designed for use as a hub to distribute DS1 HiCap circuits for local  
access. For a complete description of the Soneplex Broadband system, refer to Soneplex  
Description, Design, and Application manual, listed under Related Publications in this section.  
RELATED PUBLICATIONS  
Listed below are related manuals and their publication numbers. Copies of these publications  
can be ordered by contacting the ADC Technical Assistance Center at 1-800-366-3891  
(in U.S.A. or Canada) or 612-946-3000, extension 3223 (outside U.S.A. and Canada).  
Title  
ADCP Number  
DS1 Fiber Loop Converter One Position Wall Mount Cabinet User Manual  
DS3 Soneplex Remote Control System Description Manual (V5.1 or later)  
DS3 Soneplex Remote Control System Installation Manual (V5.1 or later)  
DS3 Soneplex Remote Control System Operation Manual (V5.1 or later)  
61-122  
61-490  
61-489  
61-488  
Fiber Loop Converter (FLC) Installation, Operation and Maintenance Quick  
Reference Guide  
61-124  
61-120  
61-125  
61-129  
61-135  
61-151  
61-152  
61-412  
61-768  
61-470  
61-473  
61-732  
61-495  
61-743  
61-449  
61-419  
61-708  
Fiber Loop Converter Model 4 Position Universal Wall Mount Cabinet User Manual  
Fiber Loop Converter Two Position Horizontal Mounting Shelf User Manual  
Model FLC-A10MPU Fiber Loop Converter Micro Processor Unit  
Quad DS1 Fiber Loop Converter (B2/B3/D3) User Manual  
Quad Loop Extender (QLX) and Remote Terminal Description Manual  
Quad Loop Extender (QLX) Operation and Maintenance Manual  
Soneplex Broadband System Chassis Installation Manual  
Soneplex Integrated Broadband Chassis Installation Manual  
Soneplex Broadband System Description, Design and Application Manual (V5)  
Soneplex Broadband System Reference Guide (V5)  
Soneplex HLXR 3192 Remote System Operation and Maintenance Manual  
Soneplex Main Processor Unit (MPU) Installation Instructions  
Soneplex RTAU (Remote Test Access Unit) Installation Instructions  
Soneplex Test Access Unit Installation Instructions  
Soneplex System TL1 Interface Specification  
Soneplex System X.25 Concentrator Installation and Operation Manual  
Soneplex Version D or later HLXR Remote System Operation and Maintenance  
Manual  
61-314  
Page ix  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Preface  
ADMONISHMENTS  
Important safety admonishments are used throughout this manual to warn of possible hazards  
to persons or equipment. An admonishment identifies a possible hazard and then explains  
what may happen if the hazard is not avoided. The admonishments — in the form of Dangers,  
Warnings, and Cautions — must be followed at all times. These warnings are flagged by use  
of the triangular alert icon (seen below), and are listed in descending order of severity of  
injury or damage and likelihood of occurrence.  
Danger: Danger is used to indicate the presence of a hazard that will cause severe personal  
injury, death, or substantial property damage if the hazard is not avoided.  
Warning: Warning is used to indicate the presence of a hazard that can cause severe  
personal injury, death, or substantial property damage if the hazard is not avoided.  
Caution: Caution is used to indicate the presence of a hazard that will or can cause minor  
personal injury or property damage if the hazard is not avoided.  
GENERAL SAFETY PRECAUTIONS  
Danger: To avoid electric shock, be careful when working near HDSL loop connections or  
telecommunications circuits. An electrical potential of 130 volts exists on HDSL loop  
connections and telecommunications circuits. Coming in contact with this high electrical  
potential will result in death or severe personal injury.  
Danger: Do not look into the ends of any optical fiber, or look directly into the module fiber  
connectors. Exposure to invisible laser radiation may result, which can damage the retina of  
the eye. An optical power meter should be used to verify active fibers.  
Warning: To prevent electrical shock, never install telephone equipment in a wet location or  
during a lightning storm. When installing or modifying telephone lines, disconnect lines on  
the network side before working with uninsulated lines or terminals.  
Caution: Electronic modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before  
handling modules, wear an anti-static discharge wrist strap to prevent damage to electronic  
components. Place modules in anti-static packing material when transporting or storing.  
When working on modules, always place them on an approved anti-static mat that is  
electrically grounded.  
Page x  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Preface  
FCC COMPLIANCE STATEMENT  
Class A  
The Soneplex Broadband system has been certified to comply with the requirements for class  
A computing devices per part 15 of the FCC regulations.  
Warning: This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and if not  
installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause interference to radio  
communications. It has been tested and found to comply with limits for a Class A digital  
device pursuant to Subpart B of Part 15 of FCC Rules, which are designed to provide  
reasonable protection against such interference when operated in a commercial environment.  
Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause interference to TV and  
radio reception in which case the user, at their own expense, will be required to take whatever  
measures may be required to correct the interference.  
This equipment does not exceed Class A limits for radio emission for digital apparatus, set out  
in the radio interference regulation of the authorization methods of Industry Canada.  
Operation in a residential area may cause unacceptable interference to TV and radio  
reception requiring the owner or operator to take whatever steps are necessary to correct the  
interference.  
This product conforms to all applicable standards of 21 CFR 1040.  
CERTIFICATION  
UL Listed  
The Soneplex Broadband system is compliant with UL 1459, Second Edition.  
STANDARDS  
The following listing is a bibliography of applicable documents:  
ANSI T1.231  
CB-149  
Layer 1 In-Service Digital Performance Monitoring.  
Maintenance Standards for Digital Transmission Systems, Issue 4,  
November 1, 1989.  
GR-63-CORE  
GR-487-CORE  
GR-499-CORE  
GR-1089-CORE  
Network Equipment-Building (NEBS) Generic Equipment  
Requirements, Physical Protection, Issue 1, October 1995.  
Generic Requirements for Electronic Equipment Cabinets, Issue 1,  
June 1996.  
Transport Systems Generic Requirements (TSGR): Common  
Requirements, Issue 1, December 1995.  
Electromagnetic Compatibility and Electrical Safety Generic  
Criteria for Network Telecommunication Equipment, Issue 2,  
November 1997, Revision 1, February 1999.  
Page xi  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Preface  
TA-NWT-001210  
TR-TSY-000827  
Generic Requirements for High Bit Rate Digital Subscriber Lines  
(HDSL), Issue 1, October 1991.  
OTGR: Generic Operations Interfaces: Non-OSI Communications  
Architecture, Sections 11.1 and 11.3 (Issue 1).  
LIST OF ACRONYMS AND ABBREVIATIONS  
The acronyms and abbreviations used in this manual are detailed in the following list:  
ADM Add/Drop Multiplexer  
AIS Alarm Indication Signal  
ALM Alarm  
AMI Alternate Mark Inversion  
ANSI American National Standards Institute  
APS Automatic Protection Switching  
APU Alarm Processor Unit  
ATAG Autonomously Generated Correlation Tag  
AWG American Wire Gauge  
B3ZS Bipolar Three-Zero Substitution  
B8ZS Bipolar Eight-Zero Substitution  
BB Broadband  
BBC Broadband Chassis  
BER Bit Error Rate  
BIP Bit Interleaved Parity  
BPS Bits Per Second  
BPV Bipolar Violation  
CAM Communications Access Module  
CCAS Communication Channel Access System  
CEV Controlled Environmental Vault  
CGA Carrier Group Alarm  
CI Customer Interface  
CIF Craft Interface  
CKT Circuit  
CLEI Common Language Equipment Identifier  
CO Central Office  
CPE Customer Premises Equipment  
CPM Craft Performance Monitor module (used in a Remote Terminal cabinet)  
CR Critical  
CRC Cyclic Redundancy Code  
CRP Repeater - Central Office (network) side (MPU version 5.2 and 5.3)  
CSA Carrier Serving Area  
CSU Channel Service Unit  
CTAG Correlation Tag  
CV Code Violation  
DCE Data Communication Equipment  
Page xii  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Preface  
DFMS Digital Facility Maintenance System  
DLP Detailed Level Procedure (TOP term)  
DLX DS1 Loop Extender module (BB system only)  
DS1 Digital Signal - Level 1  
DS2 Digital Signal - Level 2  
DS3 Digital Signal - Level 3  
DS3 MUX DS3 Multiplexer module  
DSX Digital Signal Cross-Connect  
DTE Data Terminal Equipment  
ESD Electrostatic Discharge  
ESF Extended Super Frame  
EV Event  
EXT External  
EXZ Excessive Zeros  
FCC Federal Communications Commission  
FE Far End  
FEND Far End  
GND Ground  
HDSL High-bit-rate Digital Subscriber Line  
HEMI High Power HDSL Module  
HiCap High Capacity  
HLXC HDSL Loop Extender - Central Office module  
HLXR HDSL Loop Extender - Remote module  
HRX HDSL Repeater  
HS High Speed  
HSP High Speed Protect slot for EC1M module (in SONET system only)  
HSW High Speed Working slot for EC1M module (in SONET system only)  
IS In Service  
IXL Task Index List (TOP term)  
KBPS Kilobits Per Second  
KFT Kilo Feet  
LAPB Link Access Procedure Balanced  
LE Loop Extender  
LEC Local Exchange Carrier  
LEC Loop Extender Chassis  
LED Light Emitting Diode  
LIU Line Interface Unit  
LMPTST Lamp Test  
LOP Loss of Pointer  
LOS Loss of Signal  
LOSW Loss of Synch Word  
LS Low Speed  
MBPS Megabits Per Second  
MJ Major  
MN Minor  
Page xiii  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Preface  
MON Monitor  
MPU Main Processor Unit  
MUX Multiplexer  
MXP DS3 MUX Protect slot  
MXW DS3 MUX Working slot  
NE Near End  
NE Network Element  
NEND Near End  
NID Network Interface Device  
NMA Bell Network Monitoring and Analysis System  
NRZ Non-Return-to-Zero  
NTP Non-Trouble Clearing Procedure (TOP term)  
OAM&P Operation, Administration, Maintenance & Provisioning  
ODS2 Optical Digital Signal 2  
OOF Out Of Frame  
OOS Out Of Service  
OR a type of Boolean operator  
OSS Operations Support System  
OTGR Operations Technology Generic Requirements  
PC Personal Computer  
PCB Printed Circuit Board  
PIC Plastic Insulated Cable  
PID Personal Identification  
PM Performance Monitoring  
PRM Performance Report Message  
PVC Permanent Virtual Circuit  
PWR Power  
QFLC Quad Fiber Loop Converter module  
QLX Quad DS1 Loop Extender module  
R
Ring  
RAI Remote Alarm Indication  
RCV Receive  
RDI Remote Defect Indication  
REPC Repeater - Central office (network) side (MPU version 5.1)  
REPR Repeater - Remote (customer) side (MPU version 5.1)  
RFI Remote Failure Indication  
RLX Repeater Loop Extender module  
RLXIOR Repeater Loop Extender Intelligent Office Repeater  
RMT Remote  
RRP Repeater - Remote (customer) side (MPU version 5.2 and 5.3)  
RTAU Remote Test Access Unit  
RX Receive  
SEF Severely Errored Framing  
SF Super Frame  
SLM Signal Label Mismatch  
Page xiv  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Preface  
SNR Signal-to-Noise Ratio  
SONET Synchronous Optical Network  
SPX Soneplex  
St Status  
STAT Status  
STK Streaker module  
SVC Switched Virtual Circuit  
T
Tip  
TAD Trouble Analysis Data (TOP term)  
TAP Trouble Analysis Procedure (TOP term)  
TASC Telecommunications Alarm Surveillance and Control  
TAU Test Access Unit  
TBOS Telemetry Byte Oriented Serial  
TID Target Identifier  
TL1 Transaction Language 1  
TOP Task Oriented Process  
TSGR Transport Systems Generic Requirements  
TX Transmit  
VC Virtual Circuit  
VOM Volt Ohmmeter  
WW Wire Wrap  
XCVR Transceiver  
XMT Transmit  
Page xv  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 1: Introduction  
SECTION 1: INTRODUCTION  
Content  
Page  
1
2
3
GENERAL......................................................................... 1-1  
USING THE CRAFT INTERFACE .......................................................... 1-1  
EDITING FIELDS .................................................................... 1-3  
3.1 Cursor ..................................................................... 1-3  
3.2 Arrow Keys .................................................................. 1-3  
3.3 Enter and Return Keys .......................................................... 1-3  
3.4 Space Bar................................................................... 1-4  
3.5 "R" Key..................................................................... 1-4  
3.6 Control Key.................................................................. 1-4  
3.7 Pop-Up Screens............................................................... 1-4  
3.8 Help Screen ................................................................. 1-4  
3.9 Data Entry .................................................................. 1-5  
USING A TOP DOCUMENT.............................................................. 1-5  
4
1 GENERAL  
This section provides instructions on how to use the Craft Interface and how to use a  
document arranged in the Task Oriented Practice (TOP) format.  
Information in this manual is divided into sections as listed below:  
Section 1 – Introduction (this section), provides instructions on how to use the Craft  
Interface and how to use a TOP document.  
Section 2 – Operation and Maintenance, contains NTPs, DLPs, TAPs, and TADs for  
installation, operation, and maintenance of the Soneplex Broadband System.  
Section 3 – General Information, located at the back of this manual provides  
information about warranty, repair, and support services.  
2 USING THE CRAFT INTERFACE  
After the initial installation of a Soneplex Broadband system, most testing and local  
operations are conducted with the Craft Interface through a VT-100 compatible terminal. This  
terminal is connected either to the front panel of the MPU plug-in module, or through a port  
located on the rear of the Soneplex Broadband chassis. Both of these connecting points  
provide a standard EIA-232C interface.  
When you are configuring the Soneplex Broadband system, monitoring alarms, or clearing  
trouble, the TOP procedure guides you through a series of menu commands using the Craft  
Interface. The Main Menu on the Craft Interface lists all the major functions, while sub-menus  
further break down the functions. The menu structure is shown in Figure 1-1.  
Page 1-1  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 1: Introduction  
Figure 1-1. Soneplex Broadband (V5) Craft Interface Menu Tree  
Page 1-2  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 1: Introduction  
A logon is required to gain access to the Craft Interface. The logon remains active until either  
the operator logs off or a user-selectable period of keyboard inactivity is exceeded. The  
default time-out period is 30 minutes. Passwords are used to limit access to the system. When  
you enter your assigned User Name, the Soneplex Broadband system will request a password.  
When you enter your assigned password, the Main Menu appears. It includes the current  
software version number (top right corner) and a copyright insignia. A default user ID and  
password are available for a newly installed system; but to ensure system security, these  
should be removed by the system administrator after the system is in operation.  
3 EDITING FIELDS  
The keyboard is used to select menus, view the various screens, and when necessary, to enter  
alpha and numeric information into the system. Keyboard operations make use of the alpha  
and numeric keys, arrow keys, enter or return key, space bar, and control key.  
3.1 Cursor  
In the Craft Interface system, a cursor is used to indicate menu selections, option settings, and  
data entry fields. The cursor may take the form of a block, a highlighted field, or a flashing  
line. When selecting a menu, the cursor is moved by pressing either the arrow or number keys.  
When selecting an option setting or making a data entry, the cursor is moved by pressing the  
arrow keys.  
3.2 Arrow Keys  
The arrow keys are used to move the cursor to indicate menu selections, option settings, and  
data entry fields. In screens that have more than one page, the up and down arrow keys also  
move the screen up or down one line at a time. In the same screens, the left arrow key moves  
the screen up one page and the right arrow key moves the screen down one page. Each time  
the screen is moved down one page, the last line from the previous screen is displayed as the  
first line on the new page. Each time the screen is moved up one page, the first line from the  
previous screen is displayed as the last line on the new page.  
3.3 Enter and Return Keys  
The Enter and Return keys causes the system to act on the data that was entered. Selections  
may be entered into the system in one of two ways:  
1. By pressing an arrow key and then the Enter or Return key once.  
2. By pressing the Enter or Return key twice after all selections and entries are made in the  
screen but before leaving the screen.  
Page 1-3  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 1: Introduction  
3.4 Space Bar  
Pressing the space bar when the cursor is in a toggle field changes the item at the cursor. If the  
item is selected from a list of options, pressing the space bar brings up the next choice.  
3.5 “R” Key  
If you press the “R” key by itself when you are in a toggle field, the selection will revert to its  
previous value.  
3.6 Control Key  
Special functions are activated by pressing the Control key and another key at the same time,  
as shown in Table 1-1.  
Table 1-1. Control Key Functions  
HOLDING DOWN THE CONTROL RESULTS IN…  
KEY AND PRESSING…  
A
D
P
Display of the help screen  
Termination of the session and logging the user out  
Cancellation of the current operation and movement of the  
cursor to the previous menu  
R
T
Cancellation of the current operation and refreshing (i.e.,  
redrawing) of the current screen with the last saved values  
Cancellation of the current operation and movement of the  
cursor to the Main Menu  
3.7 Pop-Up Screens  
In some areas of the Craft Interface, screens pop up presenting error data and information  
screens to assist you in operating the system. The information is displayed in a box that appears  
in front of the current screen display in reverse image (i.e., light on dark).  
3.8 Help Screen  
A help screen is available from all screens. Pressing CONTROL-A activates the help screen.  
The help screen displays information about moving among the fields and making edits.  
Page 1-4  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 1: Introduction  
3.9 Data Entry  
Table 1-2 shows the different field types in the Craft Interface, and how to enter data in them.  
A "toggle" field type means the user can press the space bar and "R" key to view and select  
different options that are described. An "input" field type means the user must type an entry in  
the field according to the parameters described. A "fixed" field is locked, and cannot be changed  
by the user.  
Table 1-2. Craft Interface Data Entry  
FIELD STATUS  
FLASHING  
HIGHLIGHTED  
FIELD TYPE  
OPTION  
DESCRIPTION  
Yes  
Yes  
Toggle  
Press the Toggles forward through field  
space bar options.  
Press the Toggles backward through field  
“R” key  
options.  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Input  
Type any Overwrites the character at the  
character cursor.  
Press  
Erases the character at the cursor.  
Delete  
Toggle or  
Input  
Use any  
arrow key  
• If no edit has been made: Moves  
the cursor to the next field.  
• If an edit has been made: Enters an  
edit without saving it and moves  
the cursor to another field.  
Press  
If the arrow key has not been  
Enter once pressed: Stops the edit mode and  
enters the edit without saving it.  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
Toggle or  
Input  
Press  
If an edit has been made and Enter  
Enter once has already been pressed once:  
Pressing Enter again saves the edit.  
Toggle or  
Input  
N/A  
• No edit has been made and the  
cursor is no longer in that field or  
• The edit has been saved using the  
arrow keys and pressing Enter once  
or  
• The edit has been saved by  
pressing Enter twice.  
4 USING A TOP DOCUMENT  
The procedures in this section are written in the Task Oriented Practice (TOP) format. The TOP  
method of presenting information provides step-by-step instructions for the successful completion  
of the indicated task. To find the instructions for performing enclosure installation, plug-in unit  
installation and initial turn-up, and installation troubleshooting tasks, follow these steps:  
1. Find the task to be performed in the Task Index List (IXL-001).  
Page 1-5  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 1: Introduction  
2. Locate the specified director level, detail level, or trouble-clearing procedure. All  
procedures are in numerical order, regardless of type. The TOP procedures in this  
manual are of the following four types:  
Non Trouble Clearing Procedure (NTP): A director level procedure that lists normal  
work items to be performed that are not trouble clearing procedures.  
Trouble Analysis Procedure (TAP): A director level procedure that provides step-by-  
step instructions to locate and fix trouble.  
Detailed Level Procedure (DLP): Detailed step-by-step instructions or procedures.  
Trouble Analysis Data (TAD): A trouble-clearing aid containing non-procedural data.  
3. Perform all the items in the director level procedure (NTP or TAP) in the order listed  
unless sent to another director level procedure. When a director level procedure is  
finished, the task is completed. When more detailed information is required, the reader  
will be sent to a DLP. A DLP may also direct the reader to another DLP.  
Note: When a DLP is complete, return to the procedure that preceded the DLP.  
Note: When sent from one director level procedure to another director level procedure,  
in most instances it will not be necessary to go back to the first director level procedure  
after competing the second.  
4. In some procedures, it will be necessary to verify that certain responses have occurred. If  
the expected response is not observed, refer to the appropriate TAP. If additional data is  
required (such as a schematic diagram, line drawing, tabulated data, maintenance  
philosophy, or trouble-clearing strategy), the reader will be sent to a TAD.  
Page 1-6  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
SECTION 2: OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE  
Content  
Page  
1
GENERAL...............................................................2-1  
ALPHABETICAL TASK LIST ........................................................2-1  
TASK INDEX LIST ...........................................................IXL-001  
1 GENERAL  
This section provides procedures to install and maintain a Soneplex Broadband system. The  
procedures are given in a Task Oriented Practice (TOP) format. Regardless of your work  
experience, TOP can be a useful tool in doing your job. If you have done a particular job many  
times, the TOP serves as a memory jogger for those instructions you cannot recall. If you have  
never done a particular job, or do it infrequently, a TOP provides step-by-step instructions to  
complete the task.  
ALPHABETICAL TASK LIST  
–48 VDC POWER SUPPLY TEST ............................................................. DLP-508  
ACCESS IDENTIFIER ..................................................................... TAD-106  
ACO (ALARM CUT-OFF) COMMAND .......................................................... DLP-539  
ACTIVE ALARMS DISPLAY ................................................................. DLP-542  
ALARM HISTORY CLEARANCE COMMAND ...................................................... DLP-527  
ALARM HISTORY DISPLAY................................................................. DLP-544  
ALARM SUMMARY DISPLAY ............................................................... DLP-543  
ALARM TROUBLESHOOTING ................................................................TAP-101  
ALARM/EVENT NOTIFICATION LEVEL SETTING ................................................... DLP-552  
ALARMS PROCEDURES................................................................... NTP-006  
APU INSTALLATION AND TESTING ........................................................... DLP-503  
ASSIGNMENT RECORDS .................................................................. DLP-523  
CHASSIS INSPECTION.................................................................... DLP-501  
CIRCUIT ID DISPLAY..................................................................... DLP-566  
CONFIGURATION DATA DOWNLOAD COMMAND .................................................. DLP-555  
CONFIGURATION DATA UPLOAD COMMAND..................................................... DLP-554  
CRAFT INTERFACE SYSTEM LOGOFF.......................................................... DLP-564  
CRAFT INTERFACE SYSTEM LOGON .......................................................... DLP-526  
DLX ALARM LEVEL SETTING ............................................................... DLP-563  
DLX AND REMOTE SYSTEM END-TO-END TEST PROCEDURES ......................................... NTP-010  
DLX CONFIGURATION .................................................................... DLP-532  
DLX INSTALLATION AND TESTING ........................................................... DLP-521  
DLX- OR RLX-EQUIPPED CIRCUIT END-TO-END TESTS .............................................. DLP-522  
DLX STATUS DISPLAY.................................................................... DLP-553  
DS1 PM CONFIGURATION ................................................................. DLP-556  
(continued)  
2-1  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
ALPHABETICAL TASK LIST  
(continued)  
DS3 MUX ALARM LEVEL SETTING ............................................................DLP-560  
DS3 MUX APS TEST......................................................................DLP-512  
DS3 MUX CONFIGURATION.................................................................DLP-529  
DS3 MUX FORCED SWITCH TEST.............................................................DLP-511  
DS3 MUX INSTALLATION AND TESTING ........................................................DLP-505  
DS3 MUX STATUS DISPLAY ................................................................DLP-546  
DUAL REPEATER INCOMPATIBILITY DIAGNOSIS...................................................TAP-104  
FIBER OPTIC CONNECTOR AND ADAPTER CLEANING AND MATING INSTRUCTIONS ...........................DLP-507  
FORCE/APS COMMANDS ..................................................................DLP-537  
HDSL PM CONFIGURATION.................................................................DLP-557  
HDSL-EQUIPPED CIRCUIT CROSS-CONNECTS ....................................................DLP-515  
HLX ALARM LEVEL SETTING ................................................................DLP-562  
HLX AND HRX STATUS DISPLAY .............................................................DLP-548  
HLX CONFIGURATION ....................................................................DLP-531  
HLX LOOPBACK CONFIGURATION ............................................................DLP-573  
HLXC AND HLXR END-TO-END TESTS ..........................................................DLP-520  
HLXC AND REMOTE SYSTEM END-TO-END TEST PROCEDURES ........................................NTP-009  
HLXC INSTALLATION AND TESTING ...........................................................DLP-516  
INVENTORY DISPLAY.....................................................................DLP-540  
LOCAL CRAFT INTERFACE CONNECTION TROUBLESHOOTING..........................................TAP-103  
LOCAL CRAFT INTERFACE CONNECTION ........................................................DLP-504  
LOOPBACK PROCESS DESCRIPTION...........................................................TAD-102  
LOOPBACK STATUS/COMMANDS .............................................................DLP-541  
MAINTENANCE PHILOSOPHY ...............................................................TAD-100  
MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES ...............................................................NTP-005  
MENU SECURITY EDITING .................................................................DLP-536  
MODULE INSTALLATION AND TESTING PROCEDURES...............................................NTP-002  
MPU ALARM LEVEL SETTING ...............................................................DLP-559  
MPU CONFIGURATION DATA SAVE AND TRANSFER PROCEDURES ......................................NTP-008  
MPU INSTALLATION AND TESTING............................................................DLP-502  
MPU REPLACEMENT AND TESTING ...........................................................DLP-519  
MPU SOFTWARE DOWNLOAD COMMAND .......................................................DLP-551  
MPU VERSION 5 SOFTWARE INSTALLATION AND TESTING PROCEDURES .................................NTP-007  
ODS2 DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM AND QFLC/QLX CHASSIS END-TO-END TESTS ...............................DLP-510  
ODS2 MODULE ALARM LEVEL SETTING ........................................................DLP-561  
ODS2 MODULE AND REMOTE SYSTEM END-TO-END TEST PROCEDURES ..................................NTP-003  
ODS2 MODULE APS TEST ..................................................................DLP-514  
ODS2 MODULE CONFIGURATION .............................................................DLP-530  
ODS2 MODULE FORCED SWITCH TEST THROUGH THE CRAFT INTERFACE .................................DLP-513  
ODS2 MODULE INSTALLATION AND TESTING ....................................................DLP-506  
ODS2 MODULE STATUS DISPLAY ............................................................DLP-547  
PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTING LOCATIONS..............................................TAD-103  
PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTS DESCRIPTION ..............................................TAP-102  
PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTS RETRIEVAL................................................DLP-565  
(continued)  
2-2  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
ALPHABETICAL TASK LIST  
(continued)  
RESET/LED TEST COMMANDS .............................................................. DLP-538  
RLX ALARM LEVEL SETTING ............................................................... DLP-518  
RLX (OR RLXIOR) AND REMOTE SYSTEM END-TO-END TEST PROCEDURES................................ NTP-011  
RLX CONFIGURATION .................................................................... DLP-534  
RLX INSTALLATION AND TESTING ........................................................... DLP-525  
RLX AND RLXIOR STATUS DISPLAY .......................................................... DLP-509  
RLX (OR RLXIOR) TO REPEATER VOLTAGE AND CURRENT TEST ....................................... DLP-567  
RLX-EQUIPPED CIRCUIT CROSS-CONNECTS ..................................................... DLP-569  
RLXIOR CONFIGURATION ................................................................. DLP-533  
RLXIOR INSTALLATION AND TESTING ......................................................... DLP-524  
RTAU INSTALLATION AND TESTING .......................................................... DLP-517  
RTAU OPERATION ...................................................................... DLP-570  
SERIAL PORT CONFIGURATION ............................................................. DLP-549  
SHELF HOUSEKEEPING ALARM LABELS........................................................ DLP-550  
SHELF STATUS DISPLAY .................................................................. DLP-545  
SPECIFICATIONS ....................................................................... TAD-101  
STREAKER INSTALLATION AND TESTING ....................................................... DLP-571  
SYSTEM COMPONENTS INSPECTION.......................................................... DLP-500  
SYSTEM OR CIRCUIT PROVISIONING PROCEDURES................................................ NTP-004  
SYSTEM TID/DATE/TIME SETTING............................................................ DLP-528  
TAU INSTALLATION AND TESTING ........................................................... DLP-574  
TAU OPERATION ....................................................................... DLP-575  
TBOS CHASSIS DAISY-CHAINING ............................................................ DLP-576  
TBOS INTERFACE DESCRIPTION ............................................................. TAD-104  
TRANSACTION LANGUAGE 1 (TL1) INTERFACE DESCRIPTION ......................................... TAD-105  
USER ACCOUNT EDITING.................................................................. DLP-535  
VERSION C HLXC VOLTAGE TO HLXR TEST...................................................... DLP-568  
VERSION D (OR LATER) HLXC VOLTAGE TO HLXR TEST ............................................. DLP-572  
X.25 PORT CONFIGURATION ............................................................... DLP-558  
2-3  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
2-4  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
IXL-001  
Page 1 of 4  
TASK INDEX LIST  
Find Your Job in the List Below  
Then Go To  
MODULE INSTALLATION AND TESTING PROCEDURES .............................................. NTP-002  
System Components Inspection....................................................... DLP-500  
Chassis Inspection ............................................................... DLP-501  
–48 VDC Power Supply Test ......................................................... DLP-508  
MPU Installation and Testing......................................................... DLP-502  
MPU Replacement and Testing ....................................................... DLP-519  
APU Installation and Testing ......................................................... DLP-503  
DS3 MUX Installation and Testing ..................................................... DLP-505  
HLXC Installation and Testing ........................................................ DLP-516  
HLXC and HLXR End-To-End Tests..................................................... DLP-520  
DLX Installation and Testing ......................................................... DLP-521  
DLX- or RLX-Equipped Circuit End-To-End Tests............................................ DLP-522  
RLX Installation and Testing ......................................................... DLP-525  
RLXIOR Installation and Testing....................................................... DLP-524  
ODS2 Module Installation and Testing................................................... DLP-506  
RTAU Installation and Testing ........................................................ DLP-517  
Streaker Installation and Testing ...................................................... DLP-571  
TAU Installation and Testing ......................................................... DLP-574  
Assignment Records .............................................................. DLP-523  
ODS2 MODULE AND REMOTE SYSTEM END-TO-END TEST PROCEDURES ................................. NTP-003  
Local Craft Interface Connection ...................................................... DLP-504  
Craft Interface System Logon ........................................................ DLP-526  
Alarm History Clearance Command..................................................... DLP-527  
System TID/Date/Time Setting........................................................ DLP-528  
DS3 MUX Configuration ............................................................ DLP-529  
ODS2 Module Configuration ......................................................... DLP-530  
ODS2 Distribution System and QFLC/QLX Chassis End-To-End Tests .............................. DLP-510  
Force/APS Commands ............................................................. DLP-537  
DS3 MUX Forced Switch Test ........................................................ DLP-511  
DS3 MUX APS Test ............................................................... DLP-512  
ODS2 Module Forced Switch Test through the Craft Interface ................................... DLP-513  
ODS2 Module APS Test ............................................................ DLP-514  
Craft Interface System Logoff ........................................................ DLP-564  
Assignment Records .............................................................. DLP-523  
SYSTEM OR CIRCUIT PROVISIONING PROCEDURES................................................ NTP-004  
Craft Interface System Logon ........................................................ DLP-526  
Alarm History Clearance Command..................................................... DLP-527  
System TID/Date/Time Setting........................................................ DLP-528  
Serial Port Configuration ........................................................... DLP-549  
X.25 Port Configuration ............................................................ DLP-558  
Menu Security Editing ............................................................. DLP-536  
(continued)  
2-5  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
IXL-001  
Page 2 of 4  
TASK INDEX LIST, continued  
Find Your Job in the List Below  
Then Go To  
SYSTEM OR CIRCUIT PROVISIONING, continued...................................................NTP-004  
User Account Editing ..............................................................DLP-535  
DS3 MUX Configuration ............................................................DLP-529  
ODS2 Module Configuration..........................................................DLP-530  
HLXC Installation and Testing.........................................................DLP-516  
DLX Configuration ................................................................DLP-532  
RLX Configuration ................................................................DLP-534  
RLXIOR Configuration..............................................................DLP-533  
DS1 PM Configuration .............................................................DLP-556  
HDSL PM Configuration ............................................................DLP-557  
Alarm/Event Notification Level Setting ...................................................DLP-552  
MPU Alarm Level Setting............................................................DLP-559  
DS3 MUX Alarm Level Setting ........................................................DLP-560  
ODS2 Module Alarm Level Setting......................................................DLP-561  
HLX Alarm Level Setting ............................................................DLP-562  
DLX Alarm Level Setting ............................................................DLP-563  
RLX Alarm Level Setting ............................................................DLP-518  
Craft Interface System Logoff.........................................................DLP-564  
MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES ...............................................................NTP-005  
Craft Interface System Logon .........................................................DLP-526  
Access Identifier .................................................................TAD-106  
ACO (Alarm Cutoff) Command ........................................................DLP-539  
Alarm History Display ..............................................................DLP-544  
Alarm Summary Display ............................................................DLP-543  
Alarm Troubleshooting .............................................................TAP-101  
Circuit ID Display .................................................................DLP-566  
DLX Status Display................................................................DLP-553  
DS3 MUX Status Display ............................................................DLP-546  
Dual Repeater Incompatibility Diagnosis..................................................TAP-104  
HLX and HRX Status Display .........................................................DLP-548  
HLX Loopback Configuration .........................................................DLP-573  
Local Craft Interface Connection Troubleshooting............................................TAP-103  
Loopback Process Description ........................................................TAD-102  
Loopback Status/Commands.........................................................DLP-541  
Maintenance Philosophy ............................................................TAD-100  
ODS2 Module Status Display .........................................................DLP-547  
Performance Monitoring Reporting Locations ..............................................TAD-103  
Performance Monitoring Reports Description ..............................................TAP-102  
Performance Monitoring Reports Retrieval. ...............................................DLP-565  
Reset/LED Test Commands..........................................................DLP-538  
RLX and RLXIOR Status Display .......................................................DLP-509  
Shelf Housekeeping Alarm Labels ......................................................DLP-550  
(continued)  
2-6  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
IXL-001  
Page 3 of 4  
TASK INDEX LIST, continued  
Find Your Job in the List Below  
Then Go To  
MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES, continued ....................................................... NTP-005  
Shelf Status Display .............................................................. DLP-545  
Specifications................................................................... TAD-101  
RTAU Operation ................................................................. DLP-570  
TAU Operation .................................................................. DLP-575  
TBOS Chassis Daisy-Chaining ........................................................ DLP-576  
TBOS Interface Description .......................................................... TAD-104  
Transaction Language 1 (TL1) Interface Description ......................................... TAD-105  
Version C HLXC Voltage to HLXR Test................................................... DLP-568  
Version D (or Later) HLXC Voltage to HLXR Test ............................................ DLP-572  
Craft Interface System Logoff ........................................................ DLP-564  
ALARMS PROCEDURES................................................................... NTP-006  
Active Alarms Display ............................................................. DLP-542  
Alarm History Clearance Command..................................................... DLP-527  
Alarm History Display ............................................................. DLP-544  
Alarm Summary Display ............................................................ DLP-543  
MPU VERSION 5 SOFTWARE INSTALLATION AND TESTING PROCEDURES ................................. NTP-007  
Local Craft Interface Connection ...................................................... DLP-504  
Craft Interface System Logon ........................................................ DLP-526  
MPU Software Download Command .................................................... DLP-551  
Craft Interface System Logoff ........................................................ DLP-564  
MPU CONFIGURATION DATA SAVE AND TRANSFER PROCEDURES ...................................... NTP-008  
Local Craft Interface Connection ...................................................... DLP-504  
Craft Interface System Logon ........................................................ DLP-526  
Configuration Data Upload Command ................................................... DLP-554  
MPU Replacement and Testing ....................................................... DLP-519  
Configuration Data Download Command ................................................. DLP-555  
Craft Interface System Logoff ........................................................ DLP-564  
HLXC AND REMOTE SYSTEM END-TO-END TEST PROCEDURES ........................................ NTP-009  
Local Craft Interface Connection ...................................................... DLP-504  
Craft Interface System Logon ........................................................ DLP-526  
Alarm History Clearance Command..................................................... DLP-527  
System TID/Date/Time Setting........................................................ DLP-528  
DS3 MUX Configuration ............................................................ DLP-529  
HLX Configuration................................................................ DLP-531  
HLXC and HLXR End-To-End Tests..................................................... DLP-520  
Force/APS Commands ............................................................. DLP-537  
DS3 MUX Forced Switch Test ........................................................ DLP-511  
DS3 MUX APS Test ............................................................... DLP-512  
HDSL-Equipped Circuit Cross-Connects ................................................. DLP-515  
Craft Interface System Logoff ........................................................ DLP-564  
Assignment Records .............................................................. DLP-523  
(continued)  
2-7  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
IXL-001  
Page 4 of 4  
TASK INDEX LIST, continued  
Find Your Job in the List Below  
Then Go To  
DLX AND REMOTE SYSTEM END-TO-END TEST PROCEDURES .........................................NTP-010  
Local Craft Interface Connection .......................................................DLP-504  
Craft Interface System Logon .........................................................DLP-526  
Alarm History Clearance Command .....................................................DLP-527  
System TID/Date/Time Setting ........................................................DLP-528  
DS3 MUX Configuration ............................................................DLP-529  
DLX Configuration ................................................................DLP-532  
DLX- or RLX-Equipped Circuit End-To-End Tests ............................................DLP-522  
Force/APS Commands .............................................................DLP-537  
DS3 MUX Forced Switch Test.........................................................DLP-511  
DS3 MUX APS Test ...............................................................DLP-512  
Craft Interface System Logoff.........................................................DLP-564  
Assignment Records ..............................................................DLP-523  
RLX (OR RLXIOR) AND REMOTE SYSTEM END-TO-END TEST PROCEDURES ................................NTP-011  
Local Craft Interface Connection .......................................................DLP-504  
Craft Interface System Logon .........................................................DLP-526  
Alarm History Clearance Command .....................................................DLP-527  
System TID/Date/Time Setting ........................................................DLP-528  
DS3 MUX Configuration ............................................................DLP-529  
RLX Configuration ................................................................DLP-534  
RLX (or RLXIOR) to Repeater Voltage and Current Test ........................................DLP-567  
RLXIOR Configuration..............................................................DLP-533  
Force/APS Commands .............................................................DLP-537  
DS3 MUX Forced Switch Test.........................................................DLP-511  
DS3 MUX APS Test ...............................................................DLP-512  
RLX-Equipped Circuit Cross-Connects ...................................................DLP-569  
Craft Interface System Logoff.........................................................DLP-564  
Assignment Records ..............................................................DLP-523  
2-8  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-002  
Page 1 of 3  
MODULE INSTALLATION AND TESTING PROCEDURES  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for installing the various modules in the  
installed chassis and verifying operation. Installation includes inspecting the chassis for proper  
installation, checking the power supply, inserting the modules into the chassis, and testing  
various functions. This procedure assumes that the Soneplex Broadband chassis and associated  
Heat Baffle/Fiber Management Panel are installed in the rack, and that all power, signal, and  
alarm cables are connected. This procedure must be performed before attempting to test or  
operate the entire circuit or system that will be using this equipment.  
Danger: To avoid electric shock, be careful when working near HDSL loop connections  
or telecommunications circuits. An electrical potential of 130 volts exists on HDSL  
loop connections and telecommunications circuits. Coming in contact with this high  
electrical potential will result in death or severe personal injury.  
Caution: Electronic modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before  
handling modules, wear an anti-static discharge wrist strap to prevent damage to  
electronic components. Place modules in anti-static packing material when transporting  
or storing. When working on modules, always place them on an approved anti-static mat  
that is electrically grounded.  
Do Items Below in the Order Listed  
For Details Go To  
1. Obtain the following tools and equipment:  
#2 or #3 Phillips-head screwdriver  
Anti-static wrist strap  
Digital volt ohmmeter (VOM)  
Optical power meter (if installing ODS2 modules)  
Standard hand tools  
Two fiber optic patch cables (1 to 3 meters long each)  
2. Open Soneplex Broadband chassis front cover.  
3. Inspect the Soneplex Broadband chassis for proper installation and  
correct installation of all cables. Refer to the Soneplex Broadband  
System Chassis Installation Manual, listed under Related  
Publications at the beginning of this manual, for more information.  
4. If required, unpack modules from their shipping container (they may  
be stored in the chassis). Inspect for damage or missing parts.  
DLP-500  
2-9  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-002  
Page 2 of 3  
Do Items Below in the Order Listed  
For Details Go To  
DLP-501  
5. Familiarize yourself with the Soneplex Broadband chassis, module  
locations, and wiring points.  
6. Verify that –48 VDC is present at the power supply terminal block  
located on the chassis backplane.  
DLP-508  
7. If specified in the work order, install and test the MPU module:  
Install a new MPU module in a non-provisioned chassis, and verify  
stand-alone operation.  
DLP-502  
Remove an MPU from an existing chassis, install it in another chassis,  
and verify stand-alone operation.  
DLP-519  
DLP-503  
8. Install and test APU module.  
9. Install and test the working DS3 MUX module in the MXW slot of  
the Soneplex Broadband chassis. If required, install the protect  
DS3 MUX in the MXP slot. In an unprotected system, the DS3  
MUX module must be installed in the working slot.  
DLP-505  
DLP-516  
DLP-520  
DLP-521  
DLP-522  
DLP-525  
10. Install and test Version C, D, E, or G HLXC module(s).  
11. Perform end-to-end tests between the HLXC and the HLXR.  
12. Install and test DLX module(s).  
13. Perform DLX-equipped circuit end-to-end tests.  
14a. Install and test RLX module(s).  
AND/OR  
14b. Install and test RLXIOR module(s).  
DLP-524  
DLP-522  
15. Perform RLX-equipped circuit end-to-end tests.  
16. Install and test ODS2 module(s). Install the Working ODS2  
module first, then the Protection module. In an unprotected system,  
the ODS2 module must be installed in the working slot.  
DLP-506  
DLP-517  
17. Install and test the Remote Test Access Unit (RTAU).  
2-10  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-002  
Page 3 of 3  
Do Items Below in the Order Listed  
For Details Go To  
Note: For information about installing and testing the Remote Test Access Unit  
(RTAU), which is used with MPU Software Version 5.3, refer to the Soneplex RTAU  
(Remote Test Access Unit) Installation Instructions manual, listed under Related  
Publications at the beginning of this manual.  
18. Install and test the Streaker (STK) module (if present).  
DLP-571  
19. Complete assignment forms and update office records as required by  
local procedures.  
DLP-523  
20. Close the chassis front cover when installation of modules is  
complete. The chassis may remain powered up unless otherwise  
directed in the work order.  
2-11  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-003  
Page 1 of 2  
ODS2 MODULE AND REMOTE SYSTEM END-TO-END TEST PROCEDURES  
Summary: This procedure tells how to connect a Craft Interface device to the Soneplex  
equipment and configure ODS2 modules. It also tells how to connect test equipment, and how to  
perform an end-to-end test of a Soneplex system with ODS2 modules. Protection switching tests  
are also provided in case protect modules are employed in the system. The procedure assumes  
the equipment in the Soneplex chassis and at the remote Fiber Loop Converter has been installed  
and has passed local tests. It also assumes that fiber has been installed at both ends and the  
circuit connection is complete. This procedure must be performed before attempting to operate  
the entire circuit or system that will be using this equipment.  
Danger: Do not look into the ends of any optical fiber, or look directly into the module  
fiber connectors. Exposure to invisible laser radiation may result, which can damage the  
retina of the eye. An optical power meter should be used to verify active fibers.  
Danger: To avoid electric shock, be careful when working near HDSL loop connections  
or telecommunications circuits. An electrical potential of 130 volts exists on HDSL  
loop connections and telecommunications circuits. Coming in contact with this high  
electrical potential will result in death or severe personal injury.  
Do Items Below in the Order Listed  
For Details Go To  
1. Obtain the following tools and equipment:  
Anti-static wrist strap  
DS3 test set with DS1 option (for central office end of the circuit)  
DS1 test set (for remote end of the circuit)  
VT-100 compatible terminal or computer with terminal  
emulation software  
2. Coordinate test with a technician located at the remote end of the  
circuit and ensure test procedures there have been completed. Refer  
to the Quad DS1 Fiber Loop Converter (B2/B3/D3) User Manual,  
and the Quad Loop Extender (QLX) Operation and Maintenance  
Manual, listed under Related Publications at the beginning of this  
manual, for more information.  
3. At both ends of the circuit, make any necessary cross-connects at  
the optical patch panel (if used).  
4. Open the chassis front cover.  
2-12  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-003  
Page 2 of 2  
Do Items Below in the Order Listed  
For Details Go To  
5. Momentarily press the LMPTST switch on the APU front panel  
and verify that all indicators light.  
6. Connect terminal equipment to Craft port on the front of the MPU.  
7. Log on to the Craft Interface.  
DLP-504  
DLP-526  
DLP-527  
8. Clear Alarm History.  
9. Enter Target Identifier and set date and time now or during  
provisioning (the turn-up process).  
DLP-528  
DLP-529  
DLP-530  
DLP-507  
10. Configure DS3 MUX as required.  
11. Configure ODS2 modules as required.  
12. Clean and mate fiber optic connectors and adapters as required.  
13. Connect the test equipment at both ends of the system and perform  
an end-to-end test between the Soneplex chassis and the remote  
module.  
DLP-510  
DLP-537  
14. If the Soneplex system being tested is equipped with protection  
modules:  
Execute Force/APS commands through the Craft Interface.  
Perform Manual (Force) Switch to Protect test on DS3 MUX  
module.  
DLP-511  
DLP-512  
DLP-513  
DLP-514  
DLP-564  
Perform APS test on DS3 MUX module.  
Perform Manual (Force) Switch to Protect Test on ODS2 module.  
Perform APS test on ODS2 module.  
15. Log off from the Craft Interface system.  
16. Complete assignment forms and update office records as required by  
local procedures.  
DLP-523  
2-13  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-004  
Page 1 of 2  
SYSTEM OR CIRCUIT PROVISIONING PROCEDURES  
Summary: This procedure tells how to provision (turn-up) a new Soneplex system or circuit  
using the Craft Interface. The procedure assumes the equipment in the Soneplex chassis and the  
equipment at the other end of the circuit has been installed, and has passed all local and end-to-  
end tests. Some procedures may not be required and will depend upon how the system is  
equipped. This procedure must be performed before attempting to operate the entire circuit or  
system that will be using this equipment.  
Do Items Below  
For Details Go To  
DLP-526  
DLP-527  
DLP-528  
1. Log on to the Craft Interface.  
2. Clear Alarm History (required only for a new installation).  
3. Set system date and time, and enter the Target Identifier.  
4. Set Craft Interface port configuration:  
For Craft Port on MPU or Port 2  
For X.25 Port  
DLP-549  
DLP-558  
5. Edit Menu Security (set privilege levels).  
DLP-536  
DLP-535  
DLP-550  
6. Edit User Accounts (set user IDs and passwords).  
7. Assign names to Housekeeping Alarm contacts.  
8. Configure the DS3 MUX as required, set service state, and set  
protect status. If required, insert Line Build-Out on the transmit  
side of the DS3 signal.  
DLP-529  
DLP-530  
9. If present, equip ODS2 modules; assign service state and line code  
for each DS1 on the ODS2 module.  
10. If present, equip Version C, D, E, or G HLXC modules and  
provision HDSL circuits.  
DLP-516  
DLP-532  
DLP-534  
11. If present, equip DLX modules and provision DS1 circuits.  
12a. If present, equip RLX modules and provision DS1 circuits.  
AND/OR  
12b. If present, equip RLXIOR modules and provision DS1 circuits.  
DLP-533  
DLP-556  
13. Assign performance monitoring thresholds for each DS1 in the  
system.  
2-14  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-004  
Page 2 of 2  
Do Items Below  
For Details Go To  
14. If equipped, assign performance monitoring thresholds for each  
HDSL facility in the system.  
DLP-557  
DLP-552  
DLP-559  
DLP-560  
DLP-561  
DLP-562  
DLP-563  
DLP-518  
DLP-564  
15. Set alarm/event notification level.  
16. Set MPU alarm levels.  
17. Set DS3 MUX alarm levels.  
18. If equipped, set ODS2 alarm levels.  
19. If equipped, set HLX alarm levels.  
20. If equipped, set DLX alarm levels.  
21. If equipped, set RLX alarm levels.  
22. Log off the Craft Interface.  
23. Complete assignment forms and update office records as required by  
local procedures.  
DLP-523  
2-15  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-005  
Page 1 of 2  
MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES  
Summary: The following procedures can be used for maintenance for a Soneplex Broadband  
system. These procedures use the Craft Interface. They do not have to be performed in any  
particular order except logging on and logging off.  
Do Items Below As Required  
For Details Go To  
Craft Interface System Logon  
Access Identifier  
DLP-526  
TAD-106  
DLP-539  
DLP-544  
DLP-543  
TAP-101  
DLP-566  
DLP-553  
DLP-546  
DLP-548  
DLP-573  
TAP-103  
TAD-102  
DLP-541  
TAD-100  
DLP-547  
TAD-103  
TAP-102  
DLP-565  
DLP-538  
DLP-509  
DLP-550  
DLP-545  
TAD-101  
DLP-570  
ACO (Alarm Cutoff) Command  
Alarm History Display  
Alarm Summary Display  
Alarm Troubleshooting  
Circuit ID Display  
DLX Status Display  
DS3 MUX Status Display  
HLX and HRX Status Display  
HLX Loopback Configuration  
Local Craft Interface Connection Troubleshooting  
Loopback Process Description  
Loopback Status/Commands  
Maintenance Philosophy  
ODS2 Module Status Display  
Performance Monitoring Reporting Locations  
Performance Monitoring Reports Description  
Performance Monitoring Reports Retrieval  
Reset/LED Test Commands  
RLX and RLXIOR Status Display  
Shelf Housekeeping Alarm Labels  
Shelf Status Display  
Specifications  
RTAU Operation  
2-16  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-005  
Page 2 of 2  
Do Items Below As Required  
For Details Go To  
Note: For information about installing, testing, and operating the Remote Test Access  
Unit (RTAU), which is used with MPU Software Version 5.3, refer to the Soneplex  
RTAU (Remote Test Access Unit) Installation Instructions manual, listed under Related  
Publications at the beginning of this manual.  
TAU Operation  
DLP-575  
DLP-576  
TAD-104  
TAD-105  
DLP-568  
DLP-572  
DLP-564  
TBOS Chassis Daisy-Chaining  
TBOS Interface Description  
Transaction Language 1 (TL1) Interface Description  
Version C HLXC to HLXR Voltage and Current Test  
Version D (or Later) HLXC to HLXR Voltage and Current Test  
Craft Interface System Logoff  
2-17  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-006  
Page 1 of 1  
ALARMS PROCEDURES  
Summary: The following procedures can be used to display alarms and locate trouble in a  
Soneplex system using the Craft Interface device. They may be performed in any order.  
Do Items Below As Required  
For Details Go To  
Active Alarms Display  
DLP-542  
DLP-527  
DLP-544  
DLP-543  
Alarm History Clearance Command  
Alarm History Display  
Alarm Summary Display  
2-18  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-007  
Page 1 of 1  
MPU VERSION 5.3 SOFTWARE INSTALLATION AND TESTING PROCEDURES  
Summary: This procedure is used to install MPU Version 5.3 software on an MPU. To perform  
this procedure, a host computer with VT-100 emulation and XMODEM file transfer capability is  
required. The application software requires 12 to 17 minutes to transfer depending on the type of  
host computer and the communication program used. MPU Version 5.3 software can only be  
downloaded to MPU Version 5.3 hardware.  
Do Items Below in the Order Listed  
For Details Go To  
1. The following tools and equipment are required to perform  
this procedure:  
Host computer system with VT-100 emulation  
PC communication software with VT-100 emulation and with  
XMODEM file transfer capability  
MPU Version 5.3 application software and download software  
(provided on diskette)  
Straight through EIA-232 cable (for Craft port on MPU) or  
null-modem cable (for Port 2 or 3 on chassis back panel)  
2. Connect the host computer to chassis port configured as the Craft  
port. Turn the power on.  
DLP-504  
3. Insert the diskette with MPU Version 5.3 software and the database  
equalization software into the computer disk drive.  
4. Log on to the Craft Interface system.  
DLP-526  
DLP-551  
DLP-564  
5. Download the MPU Version 5.3 software program and verify that  
transfer is successfully completed.  
6. If no additional operations are required, log off from the Craft  
Interface.  
2-19  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-008  
Page 1 of 1  
MPU CONFIGURATION DATA SAVE AND TRANSFER PROCEDURES  
Summary: This procedure is used to save the configuration data from an installed MPU and  
then transfer it to another MPU. A host computer containing software that can emulate a VT-100  
terminal and perform XMODEM file transfers is required.  
Do Items Below in the Order Listed  
For Details Go To  
Note: Any configuration database from an MPU with Version 3.1 or  
later software can be downloaded to an MPU with Version 5  
software. When downloading to an MPU that is not running  
Version 5 software, the MPU software version of the source MPU  
must match the software version of the destination MPU.  
1. The following tools and equipment are required to perform this  
procedure:  
Host computer system  
VT-100 emulator program with XMODEM file transfer  
capability  
MPU Version 5 application software.  
MPU hardware with Boot Code Version 2.0 or later  
Straight-through RS-232 cable (for Craft port on MPU) or null-  
modem cable (for Port 2 on chassis back panel)  
2. Connect host computer to either the Craft port on the MPU or Port  
2 on the chassis back panel. Turn host computer power on.  
DLP-504  
DLP-526  
3. Insert a diskette into the computer disk drive.  
4. Log on to the Craft Interface system.  
5. Perform the Configuration Upload command and transfer the  
configuration data to the host computer.  
DLP-554  
DLP-519  
6. Replace the MPU or connect host computer to another MPU.  
7. At the new MPU, repeat Steps 4 and 5, then select the Execute  
Configuration Data Download command and transfer the  
configuration data from the host computer to the new MPU.  
DLP-555  
DLP-564  
8. If additional operations are not required, log off the Craft Interface.  
2-20  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-009  
Page 1 of 2  
HLXC AND REMOTE SYSTEM END-TO-END TEST PROCEDURES  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for performing end-to-end tests between a  
central office Version C, D, E, or G HLXC module and a remote Version E or Version D HLXR  
module. Performing an end-to-end test includes connecting the cross-connect jumper wires,  
verifying that the HDSL loops synchronize, and then sending a test signal between the two  
systems. This procedure assumes that installation of the HLXC modules, the remote module  
enclosure, and the remote HLXR module is complete. This procedure must be performed before  
attempting to operate the entire circuit or system that will be using this equipment.  
Danger: To avoid electric shock, be careful when working near HDSL loop connections  
or telecommunications circuits. An electrical potential of 130 volts exists on HDSL  
loop connections and telecommunications circuits. Coming in contact with this high  
electrical potential will result in death or severe personal injury.  
Warning: To prevent electrical shock, never install telephone equipment in a wet  
location or during a lightning storm. When installing or modifying telephone lines,  
disconnect lines on the network side before working with uninsulated lines or terminals.  
Caution: Electronic modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before  
handling modules, wear an anti-static discharge wrist strap to prevent damage to  
electronic components. Place modules in anti-static packing material when transporting  
or storing. When working on modules, always place them on an approved anti-static mat  
that is electrically grounded.  
Note: Two technicians are required to perform this procedure, one at the central office  
and one at the remote location. Turn-up tests for the remote HLXR module should be  
done at the remote site following completion of stand-alone testing at the central office.  
Do Items Below in The Order Listed  
For Details Go To  
1. Obtain the following tools and equipment:  
Anti-static wrist strap  
DS3 test set with DS1 option (for central office end of the  
circuit)  
DS1 test set (for remote end of the circuit)  
VT-100 compatible terminal or computer with terminal  
emulation software  
2. Coordinate test with a technician located at the remote end of the  
circuit and ensure test procedures there have been completed.  
3. Open the chassis front cover.  
2-21  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-009  
Page 2 of 2  
Do Items Below in The Order Listed  
For Details Go To  
4. Momentarily press the LMPTST switch on the APU front panel  
and verify that all indicators light.  
5. Connect terminal equipment to Craft port on the front of the MPU.  
6. Log on to the Craft Interface.  
DLP-504  
DLP-526  
DLP-527  
7. Clear Alarm History.  
8. Enter Target Identifier and set date and time now or during  
provisioning (the turn-up process).  
DLP-528  
DLP-529  
DLP-531  
9. Configure DS3 MUX as required.  
10. Configure HLXC modules as required.  
11. Check the HLXC to HLXR voltage and current:  
Version C HLXC to HLXR Voltage and Current Test.  
DLP-568  
DLP-572  
Version D (or Later) HLXC to HLXR Voltage and Current Test.  
12. Connect the test equipment at both ends of the system and perform an  
end-to-end test between the chassis and the remote HLXR.  
DLP-520  
DLP-537  
13. If the DS3 MUX protect module is installed:  
Execute Force/APS commands through the Craft Interface.  
Perform Manual (Force) Switch to Protect test on DS3 MUX  
module.  
DLP-511  
DLP-512  
Perform APS test on DS3 MUX module.  
14. Coordinate the test with a technician located at the remote end of  
the circuit and ensure test procedures there have been completed.  
Refer to the Soneplex Version D HLXR Remote System Operation  
and Maintenance Manual, listed under Related Publications at the  
beginning of this manual.  
15. At both ends of the circuit, make any necessary cross-connects at  
the distribution frames.  
DLP-515  
DLP-564  
16. Log off from the Craft Interface system.  
17. Complete assignment forms and update office records as required by  
local procedures.  
DLP-523  
2-22  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-010  
Page 1 of 2  
DLX AND REMOTE SYSTEM END-TO-END TEST PROCEDURES  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for performing end-to-end tests between the  
DLX modules and the remote system. Performing an end-to-end test includes connecting the  
cross-connect jumper wires, and then sending a test signal between the chassis and the network  
equipment. This procedure assumes that the T1 facility between the Soneplex Broadband chassis  
and network equipment (e.g., DLC, channel bank, etc.) is functional, and that the DLX modules  
to be tested have already been installed. This procedure must be performed before attempting to  
operate the entire circuit or system that will be using this equipment.  
Warning: To prevent electrical shock, never install telephone equipment in a wet  
location or during a lightning storm. When installing or modifying telephone lines,  
disconnect lines on the network side before working with uninsulated lines or terminals.  
Caution: Electronic modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before  
handling modules, wear an anti-static discharge wrist strap to prevent damage to  
electronic components. Place modules in anti-static packing material when transporting  
or storing. When working on modules, always place them on an approved anti-static mat  
that is electrically grounded.  
Do Items Below in The Order Listed  
For Details Go To  
1. Obtain the following tools and equipment:  
Anti-static wrist strap  
DS3 test set with DS1 option (for central office end of the  
circuit)  
DS1 test set (for remote end of the circuit)  
VT-100 compatible terminal or computer with terminal  
emulation software  
2. Coordinate test with a technician located at the remote end of the  
circuit and ensure test procedures there have been completed.  
3. Open the chassis front cover.  
4. Momentarily press the LMPTST switch on the APU front panel  
and verify that all indicators light.  
5. Connect terminal equipment to Craft port on the front of the MPU.  
6. Log on to the system.  
DLP-504  
DLP-526  
2-23  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-010  
Page 2 of 2  
Do Items Below in The Order Listed  
For Details Go To  
7. Clear Alarm History.  
DLP-527  
8. Enter Target Identifier and set date and time now or during  
provisioning (the turn-up process).  
DLP-528  
DLP-529  
DLP-532  
9. Configure DS3 MUX as required.  
10. Configure DLX modules as required.  
11. Connect the test equipment at both ends of the system and perform  
an end-to-end test.  
DLP-522  
DLP-537  
12. If the DS3 MUX protect module is installed:  
Execute Force/APS commands through the Craft Interface.  
Perform Manual (Force) Switch to Protect test on DS3 MUX  
module.  
DLP-511  
DLP-512  
Perform APS test on DS3 MUX module.  
13. Make any necessary cross-connects at the DSX.  
14. Log off from the Craft Interface system.  
DLP-564  
DLP-523  
15. Complete assignment forms and update office records as required  
by local procedures.  
2-24  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-011  
Page 1 of 2  
RLX (OR RLXIOR) AND REMOTE SYSTEM END-TO-END TEST PROCEDURES  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for performing end-to-end tests between the  
Version A or Version B RLX modules, or RLXIOR modules, and the remote system. Performing  
an end-to-end test includes connecting the cross-connect jumper wires, and then sending a test  
signal between the two systems. This procedure assumes that the T1 facility between the central  
office and the repeater is functional, and that the RLX modules to be tested have already been  
installed. This procedure must be performed before attempting to operate the entire circuit or  
system that will be using this equipment.  
Warning: To prevent electrical shock, never install telephone equipment in a wet  
location or during a lightning storm. When installing or modifying telephone lines,  
disconnect lines on the network side before working with uninsulated lines or terminals.  
Caution: Electronic modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before  
handling modules, wear an anti-static discharge wrist strap to prevent damage to  
electronic components. Place modules in anti-static packing material when transporting  
or storing. When working on modules, always place them on an approved anti-static mat  
that is electrically grounded.  
Do Items Below in The Order Listed  
For Details Go To  
1. Obtain the following tools and equipment:  
Anti-static wrist strap  
DS3 test set with DS1 option (for central office end of the  
circuit)  
DS1 digital transmission test set (T-Berd 211 or equivalent)  
VT-100 compatible terminal or computer with terminal  
emulation software  
2. Coordinate test with a technician located at the remote end of the  
circuit and ensure test procedures there have been completed.  
3. Open the chassis front cover.  
4. Momentarily press the LMPTST switch on the APU front panel  
and verify that all indicators light.  
5. Connect terminal equipment to Craft port on the front of the MPU.  
6. Log on to the system.  
DLP-504  
DLP-526  
2-25  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
NTP-011  
Page 2 of 2  
Do Items Below in The Order Listed  
For Details Go To  
7. Clear Alarm History.  
DLP-527  
8. Enter Target Identifier and set date and time now or during  
provisioning (the turn-up process).  
DLP-528  
DLP-529  
9. Configure DS3 MUX as required.  
10. Configure RLX or RLXIOR modules as required.  
11. Check RLX voltage to repeater.  
DLP-534 or DLP-533  
DLP-567  
12. Connect the test equipment at both ends of the system and perform  
an end-to-end test.  
DLP-522  
DLP-537  
13. If the DS3 MUX protect module is installed:  
Execute Force/APS commands through the Craft Interface.  
Perform Manual (Force) Switch to Protect test on DS3 MUX  
module.  
DLP-511  
DLP-512  
Perform APS test on DS3 MUX module.  
14. At both ends of the circuit, make any necessary cross-connects at  
the DSX.  
DLP-569  
DLP-564  
15. Log off from the Craft Interface system.  
16. Complete assignment forms and update office records as required  
by local procedures.  
DLP-523  
2-26  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-500  
Page 1 of 1  
SYSTEM COMPONENTS INSPECTION  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for opening the shipping cartons, verifying that  
the correct components and quantities were received, and checking for damages.  
Caution: Modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before handling  
any modules, ESD protection must always be used. Ensure that all modules removed  
from the chassis or not installed are properly stored in anti-static packing material.  
When working with modules, always place the module on an electrically-grounded,  
approved, anti-static mat.  
1. The following tools and equipment are required for unpacking:  
ESD wristband  
Box cutter  
2. Open the shipping carton and carefully unpack the equipment from the protective packing  
material.  
3. Check each component against the packing list to verify that the correct catalog numbers  
and quantities were received. Verify that all parts are received before discarding the  
shipping containers and packing material in case a return is necessary.  
4. Inspect the components for broken or bent wire wrap pins on the chassis backplane. Check  
the BNC connectors on the backplane to ensure that they are securely fastened.  
5. Inspect each module for broken or damaged indicators and switches.  
6. Does your work order call for you to store the modules in the chassis?  
If No, return the modules to their containers and store them securely for later use.  
If Yes, when the chassis is installed, slide the modules loosely into their slot locations  
on the chassis. Do not plug them into the chassis.  
7. If there are any damaged or missing parts, file a claim with the commercial carrier. Contact  
ADC Telecommunications for replacement parts. See the General Information section of  
this manual for procedures.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-27  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-501  
Page 1 of 2  
CHASSIS INSPECTION  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for identifying the Soneplex Broadband chassis  
and module locations. The chassis front and locations for modules are shown in Figure 501-1.  
The chassis backplane is shown in Figure 501-2.  
1. See Figure 501-1 to identify module locations at the front of the chassis. A working DS3  
MUX module, an APU, and an MPU are always required. The slots identified for low-  
speed modules can house:  
Up to 14 ODS2 modules (7 working and 7 protect),  
28 HLXC modules,  
28 DLX modules,  
28 RLX modules, or  
Any combination up to a maximum of 28 DS1 circuits.  
2. See Figure 501-2 to identify components and locations on the chassis backplane.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
LOW SPEED UNITS  
APU  
HSP  
1-1 1-3 2-1 2-3 3-1 3-3 4-1 4-3 5-1 5-3 6-1 6-3 7-1 7-3  
HSW  
MXW MXP TAU  
CR  
MJ  
MN  
ACO  
PWR  
RTAU  
HSKP  
RMT  
ALM  
STATUS  
LPBK  
STATUS  
LPBK  
D
I
S
P
R
M
T
LMPTST  
DS3 FAIL  
ENABLE  
ENABLE  
APU  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
ONLINE  
ONLINE  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
STATUS  
APS  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
APS  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
LMPTST/  
APS  
LMPTST/  
APS  
RESET  
RESET  
RESET  
MPU  
1-2 1-4 2-2 2-4 3-2 3-4 4-2 4-4 5-2 5-4 6-2 6-4 7-2 7-4  
5915-B  
DS3 MUX  
UNITS  
RTAU  
MODULE  
Figure 501-1. Soneplex Broadband Chassis, Front View  
2-28  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-501  
Page 2 of 2  
Figure 501-2. Soneplex Broadband Chassis Backplane  
2-29  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-502  
Page 1 of 2  
MPU INSTALLATION AND TESTING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions on unpacking and installing a new MPU in a  
non-provisioned chassis, and then verifying that it is functioning properly.  
Caution: Modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before  
handling any modules, ESD protection must always be used. An ESD grounding  
post is located on the chassis for connecting the ESD wrist band. Ensure that all  
modules removed from the equipment or not installed, are properly stored in anti-  
static packing material. When working with modules, always place the module on  
an electrically-grounded, approved, anti-static mat.  
Note: When installing a new MPU module, use the same DIP switch settings on  
the MPU’s printed circuit board as the DS3 MUX’s DIP switch settings. Keeping  
both switch settings the same enables communication between the MPU and the  
DS3 MUX for OAM&P.  
Note: When replacing an MPU in a configured chassis, the configuration data  
from the modules in the chassis is automatically loaded into the new MPU. If an  
MPU from a provisioned chassis is moved to another chassis, the chassis unit  
configurations may not match the MPU unit configurations, resulting in alarms  
and erroneous information. Refer to DLP-519 (Replace MPU and Verify Stand-  
Alone Operation) for more information.  
1. Open the shipping carton and carefully unpack the MPU from its protective packaging.  
Note: DO NOT change any DIP switch settings on the printed circuit board of the  
MPU; this could make the MPU incompatible with your Soneplex Broadband system.  
2. Refer to Figure 502-1 for a drawing showing the MPU module slot in the chassis. Align the  
edges of the printed circuit card with the card guides in the chassis.  
3. Using the ejector, push the MPU into the slot marked MPU located in the lower right  
corner of the chassis until it is firmly seated in the connector. If there is excessive  
resistance, remove the module and check for improper alignment or obstructions.  
4. Use the screw to secure the MPU to chassis.  
5. Refer to Figure 502-2 for a drawing of the MPU front panel. Verify that STATUS indicator  
lights red, then yellow, and then remains green.  
6. If STATUS indicator is not lit (i.e., green), check for A and B power at the connections on  
the backplane.  
Reference: DLP-508 –48 VDC Power Supply Test  
2-30  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-502  
Page 2 of 2  
7. If there is power at both of the connections (A and B), remove and replace the MPU with a  
new one.  
8. If STATUS indicator is red, this indicates an MPU hardware failure. Remove and replace  
the MPU with a new one.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
HIGH SPEED UNITS  
LOW SPEED UNITS  
HSW HSP MXW MXP TAU  
APU  
1-1 1-3 2-1 2-3 3-1 3-3 4-1 4-3 5-1 5-3 6-1 6-3 7-1 7-3  
A
P
U
M
P
U
1-2 1-4 2-2 2-4 3-2 3-4 4-2 4-4 5-2 5-4 6-2 6-4 7-2 7-4  
MPU  
8025-A  
Figure 502-1. Soneplex Broadband Chassis (Front View) Mounting Slot for MPU  
M
P
U
STATUS  
C
R
A
F
T
RESET  
1749-B  
Figure 502-2. MPU Front Panel  
2-31  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-503  
Page 1 of 1  
APU INSTALLATION AND TESTING  
Summary: This procedure provides guidelines for installing and testing the APU.  
Caution: Modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before  
handling any modules, ESD protection must always be used. An ESD grounding  
post is located on the chassis for connecting the ESD wrist band. Ensure that all  
modules removed from the equipment or not installed, are properly stored in anti-  
static packing material. When working with modules, always place the module on  
an electrically-grounded, approved, anti-static mat.  
1. Remove the APU from protective packaging.  
2. Push the APU into slot marked APU located in the upper right corner of the chassis.  
3. Use screw to secure the APU to chassis.  
4. If PWR indicator is not lighted at all, check for power at the A and B connections on the  
backplane.  
Reference: DLP-508 –48 VDC Power Supply Test  
5. If there is power at both of the connections (A and B), remove and replace the APU with a  
new one.  
6. Press the LMPTST switch to verify that all APU indicators light. If any indicator does not  
light, replace the APU.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-32  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-504  
Page 1 of 2  
LOCAL CRAFT INTERFACE CONNECTION  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for accessing the Craft Interface. It can be  
accessed locally from a VT-100 compatible terminal or a host computer connected to either the  
front or rear of the Soneplex Broadband chassis.  
1. Locate the port that will be used to connect the control terminal or host computer to the  
Craft Interface. The MPU Craft port is located on the front of the MPU as shown in Figure  
504-1 and is configured as a DCE connection. Ports 2 and 3 are located on the chassis rear  
panel and are configured as DTE connections.  
2. Select the cable that is required for connecting the terminal or computer to the chassis.  
Maximum length of the cable is specified by the EIA-232 protocol. A straight-through, 25-  
pin, connectorized EIA-232 cable is required to connect the terminal or computer to the  
MPU Craft port. Pin-out information for the MPU Craft port is shown in Table 504-1. A  
null-modem cable or adapter is required to connect the terminal or computer to Port 2 or  
Port 3. Ports 2 and 3 provide an EIA-232 interface and use 25-pin D-subminiature female  
connectors for the cable connections.  
3. Connect one end of the cable to the terminal or computer and the other end to the  
appropriate port.  
4. Turn on the power to the terminal or computer. If using a computer, enter the  
communications software package resident on the computer. Serial port default settings are  
listed in Table 549-1.  
Reference: DLP-549 Serial Port Configuration  
5. Press Enter or Return.  
6. The Logon screen with User Name field should appear.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-33  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-504  
Page 2 of 2  
Table 504-1. MPU Craft Port Wiring  
PIN  
1
NAME  
FG  
SOURCE  
CIRCUIT CCITT  
CIRCUIT EIA  
AA  
FUNCTION  
101  
103  
104  
102  
Frame Ground  
Transmitted Data  
Received Data  
Signal Ground  
2
TD  
DTE  
DCE  
BA  
3
RD  
SG  
BB  
7
AB  
Cable uses Type DB-25 Male connector.  
Overall shielding, common for all leads.  
Use 26 AWG or larger wire, stranded pairs.  
M
P
U
STATUS  
C
R
A
F
T
RESET  
1749-B  
Figure 504-1. MPU Front Panel  
2-34  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-505  
Page 1 of 2  
DS3 MUX INSTALLATION AND TESTING  
Summary: This procedure describes how to install working and protect D1 DS3 MUX modules  
in the Soneplex Broadband chassis, as well as how to troubleshoot the installation.  
Caution: Modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before handling  
any modules, ESD protection must always be used. An ESD grounding post is located on  
the chassis for connecting the ESD wrist band. Ensure that all modules removed from  
the equipment or not installed are properly stored in anti-static packing material. When  
working with modules, always place the module on an electrically-grounded, approved,  
anti-static mat.  
1. Remove D1 DS3 MUX from protective packaging.  
2. Refer to Figure 505-1 for DS3 MUX module locations.  
3. Using the ejectors, fully seat the D1 DS3 MUX in the slot labeled MXW. Because of the  
large connector on the back of this module, a significant amount of force is required to  
properly seat the module in the backplane connector.  
4. Verify the following:  
The STATUS indicators first appeared red, turned yellow, and now remain green.  
The ONLINE indicator is lighted green.  
The DS3 LOS indicator is lighted red (indicating a lack of DS3 signal).  
If these three conditions are met, continue to Step 5.  
If not, replace the D1 DS3 MUX and return to Step 1.  
5. On the APU, press LMPTST/APS switch.  
If all DS3 MUX indicators light, continue to Step 6.  
If not, replace the D1 DS3 MUX and return to Step 1.  
6. If this system is to be configured as DS3 Protected, continue to Step 7.  
If not, Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
7. Remove a D1 DS3 MUX from protective packaging and inspect the module for damage.  
Note: The online indicator will not light green for the Protect DS3 MUX. Only one  
module at a time can be "online".  
8. Install the D1 DS3 MUX in the chassis slot labeled MXP.  
2-35  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-505  
Page 2 of 2  
9. Repeat Steps 3 through 5, then Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
1-1 1-3 2-1 2-3 3-1 3-3 4-1 4-3 5-1 5-3 6-1 6-3 7-1 7-3  
HSW HSP MXW MXP TAU  
APU  
CR  
MJ  
MN  
ACO  
PWR  
HSKP  
RMT  
ALM  
STATUS  
LPBK  
STATUS  
LPBK  
D
I
S
P
R
M
T
LMPTST  
ENABLE  
ONLINE  
ENABLE  
APU  
ONLINE  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
STATUS  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
APS  
APS  
C
R
A
F
T
LMPTST/  
APS  
LMPTST/  
APS  
RESET  
RESET  
RESET  
1-2 1-4 2-2 2-4 3-2 3-4 4-2 4-4 5-2 5-4 6-2 6-4 7-2 7-4  
MPU  
1984-A  
DS3 MUX UNITS  
Figure 505-1. DS3 MUX Locations  
2-36  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-506  
Page 1 of 5  
ODS2 MODULE INSTALLATION AND TESTING  
Summary: This procedure describes how to install working and protect ODS2 modules in the  
Soneplex Broadband chassis, as well as how to troubleshoot the installation. The working ODS2  
module must be installed before the protect ODS2 module.  
Safety Considerations  
Sufficient invisible infrared energy can be emitted from the end of an active fiber or operational  
transmitter to seriously damage the retina of the eye. Danger labels located on the chassis, alert  
you to the potential of exposure to invisible laser radiation. Observe the procedures described in  
the following Danger notice.  
Danger: Do not look into the ends of any optical fiber. Exposure to invisible laser  
radiation may result. An optical power meter should be used to verify active fibers. Do  
not look directly into the module fiber connectors. Exposure to invisible laser radiation  
may result.  
Warning: Do not insert module edge connectors into the chassis connectors before  
connecting the optical fiber to the module. Exposure to invisible laser radiation may  
occur if the module edge connectors are allowed to connect with the chassis connectors  
before connecting the optical fiber to the module. Verify that all indicators are dark (off)  
and the module is not engaged with the chassis connectors before proceeding.  
Caution: The ODS2 module MUST be unequipped when it is in the chassis with the  
optical loopback patch cord; otherwise, the Craft Interface will not function properly  
when accessing the module. Before seating the ODS2 module in the chassis, check the  
ODS2 Configuration screen to be sure that the module’s Unit Equip State is set to  
UNEQUIPPED.  
Caution: Always allow sufficient fiber length to permit routing without severe bends.  
Fibers may be permanently damaged if bent/curved to a radius of less than  
1.5 inches (3.81 cm).  
Caution: Modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before handling  
any modules, ESD protection must always be used. An ESD grounding post is located on  
the chassis for connecting the ESD wrist band. Ensure that all modules removed from  
the equipment or not installed, are properly stored in anti-static packing material. When  
working with modules, always place the modules on an electrically-grounded, approved,  
anti-static mat.  
Note: When using ODS2 modules in a group, NEVER install other Soneplex modules  
(RLX, DLX, or HLXC) in any of the unused slots in the group.  
2-37  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-506  
Page 2 of 5  
1. The fibers should have been placed in the rack when the chassis was installed. Route the  
fibers through the fiber management baffle into the top of the chassis to the ODS2 module  
locations. Protective covers must be in place on the fiber connectors to prevent dust and  
damage to the connections. The fibers should be tagged to identify the circuit and the  
transmission direction.  
2. Select the ODS2 module. If the module is not already installed, remove the module from  
the protective ESD packaging. If ODS2 module is installed, remove it and inspect for  
physical damage.  
3. Refer to Figure 506-1 for ODS2 module locations. Then refer to Table 506-1 and your work  
order for slots to be used. Working ODS2 modules are always installed in the top odd slots  
(1-1, 2-1, 3-1, 4-1, 5-1, 6-1, and 7-1). Protection ODS2 modules are installed in the  
adjoining odd numbered slots (1-3, 2-3, 3-3, 4-3, 5-3, 6-3, and 7-3).  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
4. Insert the working ODS2 module first. Align the module with the slots and slide module  
into the chassis until the two fiber connectors protrude about three inches out from the front  
of the chassis. Do not seat module in connector at this time.  
5. Remove the protective dust caps from the transmit and receive connectors on the ODS2  
module.  
6. Remove the protective covers from the fibers.  
7. Clean fiber optic connectors and adapters.  
Reference: DLP-507 Fiber Optic Connector and Adapter Cleaning and Mating  
Instructions  
8. Connect a fiber optic patch cord between the transmit and receive connector on the ODS2  
module. See Figure 506-2. This sets the configuration of the module in optical loopback.  
9. Using the ODS2 module ejector, press the module into the chassis until it is properly seated.  
10. On the APU, press LMPTST/APS switch. Did all ODS2 indicators light?  
If Yes, continue to Step 11.  
If No, replace ODS2 module and go to Step 4.  
11. Is the STATUS indicator on the ODS2 module lighted green?  
If Yes, continue to Step 12.  
If No, replace ODS2 module and go to Step 4.  
2-38  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-506  
Page 3 of 5  
12. Is the OPT FAIL indicator lighted red?  
If Yes, check the patch cord connection. If indicator remains lighted, replace the ODS2  
module and go to Step 4.  
If No, go to Step 13.  
13. Pull the ODS2 module out far enough to remove fiber optic patch cord. Connect transmit  
fiber to the rear connector. See Figure 506-2. Connect receive fiber to the front connector.  
Route fiber out the top of the chassis.  
Reference: DLP-507 Fiber Optic Connector and Adapter Cleaning and Mating  
Instructions  
14. With the module still withdrawn, adjust the fibers as required to remove any excess slack.  
Hold the fibers with one hand to guide them while the module is being fully inserted into  
the chassis.  
15. Slide the ODS2 module slowly into the chassis. Route the fibers through the Fiber  
Management Baffle without exceeding the minimum bend radius.  
16. Using the ODS2 module ejector, press the module into the chassis until it is properly  
seated. If there is excessive resistance, withdraw the module and check for alignment or  
obstructions.  
17. Did the STATUS indicator light green? If there is no DS2 signal present, the OPT FAIL  
indicator will be lighted red.  
If Yes, continue to Step 18.  
If No, replace ODS2 module and go to Step 4.  
18. Will this system be configured as DS2 Protected?  
If Yes, continue to Step 19.  
If No, go to Step 23.  
19. Remove an ODS2 module from the protective packaging and inspect for damage.  
20. Install protect ODS2 module in the slot adjacent to the working module.  
Reference: DLP-523 Assignment Records  
21. Align protect module with the slots and slide module into the chassis until the two fiber  
connectors protrude about three inches out from the front of the chassis. Do not seat  
module in connector at this time.  
2-39  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-506  
Page 4 of 5  
22. Repeat Steps 5 through 17 for the protection ODS2 module, then go to Step 23.  
23. Repeat the entire procedure for each ODS2 module to be installed.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
1 to 14 WORKING AND PROTECT ODS2 UNITS  
(TOP ROW ONLY)  
APU  
HSP  
1-1 1-3 2-1 2-3 3-1 3-3 4-1 4-3 5-1 5-3 6-1 6-3 7-1 7-3  
HSW  
MXW MXP TAU  
CR  
MJ  
MN  
ACO  
PWR  
RTAU  
HSKP  
RMT  
ALM  
STATUS  
LPBK  
STATUS  
LPBK  
D
I
S
P
R
M
T
LMPTST  
DS3 FAIL  
ENABLE  
ENABLE  
APU  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
ONLINE  
ONLINE  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
STATUS  
APS  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
APS  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
LMPTST/  
APS  
LMPTST/  
APS  
S
RESET  
RESET  
MPU  
1-2 1-4 2-2 2-4 3-2 3-4 4-2 4-4 5-2 5-4 6-2 6-4 7-2 7-4  
6184-B  
DS3 MUX  
UNITS  
RTAU  
MODULE  
Figure 506-1. ODS2 Module Locations  
Table 506-1. DS2 Signal Routing  
DS2  
SIGNAL  
DS1  
SIGNALS  
GROUP-SLOT  
NUMBER  
WORKING UNIT  
GROUP-SLOT  
NUMBER  
PROTECT UNIT  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1 to 4  
5 to 8  
1-1  
2-1  
3-1  
4-1  
5-1  
6-1  
7-1  
1-3  
2-3  
3-3  
4-3  
5-3  
6-3  
7-3  
9 to 12  
13 to 16  
17 to 20  
21 to 24  
25 to 28  
2-40  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-506  
Page 5 of 5  
RECEIVE  
TRANSMIT  
CONNECTOR CONNECTOR  
2170-A  
Figure 506-2. ODS2 Transmit and Receive Connector Locations  
2-41  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-507  
Page 1 of 2  
FIBER OPTIC CONNECTOR AND ADAPTER  
CLEANING AND MATING INSTRUCTIONS  
Summary: The performance of an optical fiber system is largely dependent on the fiber  
connector cleaning procedures performed before installation. This procedure provides  
instructions for cleaning and mating optical fibers.  
1. Assemble the following required cleaning materials, as shown in Figure 507-1:  
Lint-free laboratory wipes  
Cotton tipped swabs  
Isopropyl alcohol in a pressurized dispenser  
Lint-free pipe cleaners  
Clean, dry, oil-free compressed air  
100  
PIPE  
SIX INCH  
CLEANERS  
DR  
U
I
L
S
K
B
O
Y
L
P
O
H
OP YLL  
P
R
M
A
A
SDLJF;LETHIEDF  
H
L
O
CO  
L
F
L
F
F
L
O
C OOHL  
OL  
ISOPROPYL  
F
L
L
L
P AI  
OPPR OPY  
AIS  
SO  
L
C
C
H
B
K
A
U
P
A
M
ASKLHF;  
KDL  
SDA  
P
R
O
SINGLE TIPPED  
APPLICATIONORS  
L
U
K
L
M
M
B
L
L
K
B
A
A
U
H
W
S
F
O
FA  
B
F
H
W
H
O
S
L
F
O
B
O
O
S
F
F
B
F
PIPE  
CLEANERS  
L
S
W
B
K
H
L
S
B
A
A
U
U
B
W
H
H
H
M
M
KDLF;L  
B
K
H
B
H
100  
SIX INCH  
1178-A  
Figure 507-1. Cleaning Materials  
2. Clean connectors by moistening a lint-free wipe with alcohol, then wipe completely around  
the connector ferrule twice and several times across the tip.  
3. Use a lint-free dry wipe to wipe completely around the connector ferrule twice. Also wipe  
several times across the tip.  
4. Blow across the end of the ferrule with clean, dry, compressed air.  
5. Visually inspect the connector tip for cleanliness. If the tip does not appear to be  
thoroughly cleaned, repeat Steps 2, 3, and 4.  
6. SC and FC adapters are cleaned by using a pipe cleaner moistened with alcohol. Insert the  
pipe cleaner into either end of the adapter and rotate so the inside surface of the adapter is  
wiped by the pipe cleaner. Repeat this procedure for the opposite end. Blow the adapter dry  
with clean compressed air.  
7. Clean attenuators with clean, dry compressed air only. Do not use a moistened wipe or pipe  
cleaner.  
8. Mate the SC and FC connectors by inserting the connector into the adapter and aligning the  
connector key with the adapter key slot.  
2-42  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-507  
Page 2 of 2  
9. On FC connectors, push the connector into the adapter and screw the threaded cap  
clockwise onto the adapter to complete the connection.  
10. Connect SC connector by aligning the housing key with the slot in the adapter. Push the  
connector into the adapter until a click is heard/felt indicating that the latching system is  
engaged. When connector is fully engaged, the white stripes on the sides of the connector  
housing should be hidden inside the adapter.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-43  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-508  
Page 1 of 1  
–48 VDC POWER SUPPLY TEST  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for testing the voltage at the power terminal  
block located on the Soneplex Broadband chassis backplane. The multimeter should indicate  
between –42.5 VDC and –56.5 VDC.  
1. Obtain a multimeter capable of measuring 40 to 60 volts DC.  
2. Are fuses installed at the fuse and alarm panel?  
If No, continue to Step 3.  
If Yes, continue to Step 4.  
3. Install –48 VDC fuses in both A and B fuse holders.  
4. Are any of the fuses open or blown?  
If No, continue to Step 8.  
If Yes, continue to Step 5.  
5. Replace blown fuse or fuses.  
6. Did fuse blow again?  
If Yes, continue to Step 7.  
If No, continue to Step 8.  
7. Clear trouble in the fuse and alarm panel or chassis backplane.  
8. Using a multimeter, measure and record the DC voltages. Measure voltage by placing one  
probe on the positive contact and the other probe on a solid frame ground. Observe DC  
polarity when taking voltage measurements.  
Measure the A power feed bus voltage at the fuse holder.  
Measure the B power feed bus voltage at the fuse holder.  
Measure the voltage across the –48 A and RTN A terminals on the chassis backplane.  
Measure the voltage across the –48 B and RTN B terminals on the chassis backplane.  
9. Was the voltage measured at all points between –42.5 VDC and –56.5 VDC?  
If Yes, Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
If No, continue to Step 10.  
10. The problem is in the fuse and alarm panel, the power feed cabling, or at the chassis.  
Inspect and repair as necessary.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-44  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-509  
Page 1 of 1  
RLX AND RLXIOR STATUS DISPLAY  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for displaying the status of the RLX or  
RLXIOR modules installed in the selected chassis.  
Note: The RLXIOR is displayed as “RLX” in the Craft Interface menus and screens.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information about moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Display RLX Status from the Display Status menu. Press Enter  
or Return. A Display RLX Status screen is shown in Figure 509-1.  
2. Move to the Group toggle field. Select group number 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.  
3. Move to the Slot toggle field. Select slot number 1, 2, 3, or 4.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
RLX STATUS  
Group: 1  
Slot: 1  
Circuit ID:  
DS1 Lpbk Active: NO  
Customer LOS: NO  
Network LOS: NO  
DS1 Line Code: AUTO-NR-B8ZS  
DS1 Frame Format: AUTO-NR-ESF  
DS1 BER Thresh Exceeded: NO  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6180-B  
Figure 509-1. RLX Status Screen (Typical)  
2-45  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-510  
Page 1 of 2  
ODS2 DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM AND QFLC/QLX CHASSIS END-TO-END TESTS  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for performing end-to-end system tests on the  
equipment in a Soneplex ODS2 distribution system to an QFLC or QLX chassis. Two telephone  
technicians may be required to perform this test, one at the near end and one at the far end of the  
system. The installation must be complete and the equipment operating properly. If you are  
unfamiliar with the Craft Interface system, refer to the Task Index List (IXL-001) found earlier  
in this manual.  
Caution: Modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before handling  
any modules, ESD protection must always be used. Ensure that all modules removed  
from the chassis or not installed are properly stored in anti-static packing material.  
When working with modules, always place the module on an electrically-grounded,  
approved, anti-static mat.  
1. The following tools and equipment are required to perform this test:  
Anti-static wrist strap  
DS3 digital transmission test set with DS1 option  
DS1 digital transmission test set  
Patch cords to connect test sets and patch panel  
2. At the chassis location, connect a DS3 test set, with DS1 option to the DSX-3 cross-connect  
or to the DS3 RX and TX connections at the rear of the chassis. See Figure 510-1.  
3. Identify the ODS2 working and protect pair corresponding to the DS1 circuit to be tested.  
4. Identify the remote QFLC or QLX working and protect pair corresponding to the DS1  
circuit to be tested.  
5. At the QFLC or QLX location, connect DS1 test set to the DS1 circuit to be tested at the  
QFLC or QLX DS1 input and output connections, the DS1 patch panel, or at the DSX-1.  
See Figure 510-1.  
6. At both ends of the circuit to be tested, make necessary cross-connects so that both ends of  
the circuits are connected end-to-end.  
7. Using the Craft Interface, verify that the DS3 MUX is EQUIPPED and IN SERVICE.  
Reference: DLP-529 DS3 MUX Configuration  
8. Using the Craft Interface, verify that the ODS2 module to be tested is EQUIPPED and is IN  
SERVICE and the DS1 to be tested is PROVISIONED and IN SERVICE.  
Reference: DLP-530 ODS2 Module Configuration  
2-46  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-510  
Page 2 of 2  
9. At the chassis location, insert a test signal into the DS1 to be tested using the DS3 test set  
with DS1 option.  
10. Verify that all alarm indicators on the chassis are off and the DS1 test set at the QFLC or  
QLX DS1 output is receiving error-free data for the DS1 test signal selected.  
11. Repeat Steps 9 and 10 for all DS1 circuits to be tested on the ODS2 module selected.  
12. At the QFLC or QLX location, insert a DS1 test signal into the QFLC or QLX DS1 input  
using the DS1 test set.  
13. Verify that all alarm indicators on the chassis are out and the DS3 test set with DS1 option  
is receiving error-free data in the DS1 selected for test.  
14. Repeat Steps 12 and 13 for all DS1 circuits to be tested on the ODS2 module selected.  
15. Repeat procedure starting at Step 3 for all ODS2 modules to be tested.  
16. Record test results and update office records following local office practices.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
DSX-3  
CROSS-CONNECT  
SONEPLEX  
BROADBAND  
CHASSIS  
DS3 TEST SET  
RX  
MON  
TX  
OUT  
IN  
DS3  
RX  
TX  
DSX-1  
CROSS-CONNECT  
SONEPLEX  
BROADBAND  
CHASSIS  
QFLC or QLX  
MON  
TX  
DS1 TEST SET  
O
D
S
2
OUT  
IN  
RX  
RX  
TX  
6185-B  
Figure 510-1. Test Setup  
2-47  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-511  
Page 1 of 1  
DS3 MUX FORCED SWITCH TEST  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for testing the forced-switch capability of the  
DS3 MUX in the Soneplex Broadband system. An end-to-end data path test is also performed  
using only the working DS3 MUX. The forced-switch occurs first to bring the Protect DS3 MUX  
online, then the end-to-end data path test is repeated.  
Caution: Modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before handling  
any modules, ESD protection must always be used. Ensure that all modules removed  
from the chassis or not installed are properly stored in anti-static packing material.  
When working with modules, always place the module on an electrically-grounded,  
approved, anti-static mat.  
1. Identify the offline DS3 MUX; its STATUS indicator is green and its ONLINE indicator is  
extinguished.  
2. Hold ENABLED button down and momentarily press LMPTST/APS on offline DS3 MUX.  
3. Verify that the DS3 MUX that was offline is now online (its ONLINE indicator is now  
green) and DS3 MUX that was online is now offline (its ONLINE indicator is  
extinguished).  
4. Verify that APS indicator on online DS3 MUX is yellow indicating a forced switch and  
APS disabled.  
5. Repeat Step 2 and verify that APS indicator is off.  
6. Perform end-to-end test and verify error-free data.  
7. Set up the chassis and perform end-to-end tests between chassis and remote unit.  
Reference: DLP-510 ODS2 Distribution System and QFLC/QLX ChassisEnd-to-End  
Tests  
Reference: DLP-520 HLXC and HLXR End-to-End Tests  
Reference: DLP-522 DLX- or RLX-Equipped Circuit End-to-End Tests  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-48  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-512  
Page 1 of 2  
DS3 MUX APS TEST  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for verifying that the APS (Automatic  
Protection Switching) feature of the DS3 MUX module is working. Both working (online) and  
protect (offline) DS3 MUX modules are tested.  
Caution: Modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before handling  
any modules, ESD protection must always be used. Ensure that all modules removed  
from the chassis or not installed are properly stored in anti-static packing material.  
When working with modules, always place the module on an electrically-grounded,  
approved, anti-static mat.  
1. Identify the offline DS3 MUX. Its STATUS indicator is green and its ONLINE indicator is  
extinguished.  
2. Slide the offline DS3 MUX part way out. This disconnects the DS3 MUX from the Soneplex  
Broadband system and ensures that data passes through the online DS3 MUX only.  
3. Perform end-to-end test and verify error-free data.  
4. Set up the Soneplex Broadband system and to perform end-to-end tests between chassis and  
remote unit.  
Reference: DLP-510  
ODS2 Distribution System and QFLC/QLX Chassis End-to-End  
Tests  
Reference: DLP-520  
Reference: DLP-522  
HLXC and HLXR End-to-End Tests  
DLX- or RLX-Equipped Circuit End-to-End Tests  
5. Using the DS3 MUX ejectors, press the module into the chassis until it is properly seated.  
6. Verify that the STATUS indicator on the offline DS3 MUX is green and the ONLINE  
indicator is extinguished.  
7. Verify that the STATUS indicator on the online DS3 MUX is green and the ONLINE  
indicator is green.  
8. If the online DS3 MUX APS LOCKOUT/FORCE indicator is on, hold the ENABLED  
button down and momentarily press LMPTST/APS to extinguish the APS indicator.  
9. Slide the online DS3 MUX partly out to cause an APS.  
10. Verify that the DS3 MUX that was offline is now online (its ONLINE indicator is green).  
2-49  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-512  
Page 2 of 2  
11. Perform the end-to-end test and verify error-free data.  
Reference: DLP-510 ODS2 Distribution System and QFLC/QLX Chassis End-to-End  
Tests  
Reference: DLP-520 HLXC and HLXR End-to-End Tests  
Reference: DLP-522 DLX- or RLX-Equipped Circuit End-to-End Tests  
12. Insert partially removed DS3 MUX back into the chassis until it is properly seated.  
13. Verify that STATUS indicator on offline DS3 MUX is green and its ONLINE indicator is  
extinguished.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-50  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-513  
Page 1 of 2  
ODS2 MODULE FORCED SWITCH TEST THROUGH THE CRAFT INTERFACE  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for verifying that the force-to-protect feature of  
the ODS2 module is working. Both working (online) and protect (offline) ODS2 modules are  
tested.  
Warning: Do not insert module edge connectors into the chassis connectors before  
connecting the optical fiber to the module. Exposure to invisible laser radiation may  
occur if the module edge connectors are allowed to connect with the chassis connectors  
before connecting the optical fiber to the module. Verify that all indicators are dark (off)  
and the module is not engaged with the chassis connectors before proceeding.  
Warning: Verify that module is completely disconnected from the chassis connectors  
before removing the optical fiber from the module. Verify that the far end transmitter is  
off before proceeding. Exposure to invisible laser radiation from the optical fiber is  
possible if the far end transmitter is transmitting. Verify that all indicators are dark (off).  
Caution: Modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before handling  
any modules, ESD protection must always be used. Ensure that all modules removed  
from the chassis or not installed are properly stored in anti-static packing material.  
When working with modules, always place the module on an electrically-grounded,  
approved, anti-static mat.  
1. Set up the chassis and a remote QFLC or QLX chassis, then perform end-to-end tests  
between chassis and the remote chassis.  
Reference: DLP-510 ODS2 Distribution System and QFLC/QLX Chassis End-to-End  
Tests  
2. Identify the offline ODS2 module of the working and protect pair to be tested. Its STATUS  
indicator is green and is the only illuminated indicator (its ONLINE indicator is  
extinguished).  
3. Slide the offline ODS2 module part way out; this disconnects the offline module from the  
chassis and ensures that data passes through the online ODS2 module only.  
4. Perform end-to-end test and verify error-free data.  
Reference: DLP-510 ODS2 Distribution System and QFLC/QLX Chassis End-to-End  
Tests  
5. Using the ODS2 module ejector, press the module into the chassis until it is properly seated.  
6. Verify that the STATUS indicator on offline ODS2 module is green and its ONLINE  
indicator is extinguished.  
2-51  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-513  
Page 2 of 2  
7. Hold ENABLED button down and momentarily press LMPTST/APS on the offline ODS2  
module.  
8. Verify that the ODS2 module that was offline is now online (its ONLINE indicator is  
green) and ODS2 module that was online is now offline (its ONLINE indicator is  
extinguished).  
9. Verify that the APS indicator on the online ODS2 module is red indicating a forced switch  
and APS disabled.  
10. Slide the offline ODS2 module part way out of the chassis; this disconnects the offline  
module from the chassis and ensures that data passes through the online ODS2 module only.  
11. Perform end-to-end test and verify error-free data.  
Reference: DLP-510 ODS2 Distribution System and QFLC/QLX Chassis End-to-End  
Tests  
12. Using the ejector, press the offline ODS2 module into the chassis until it is properly seated.  
13. Verify that STATUS indicator on offline ODS2 module is green and ONLINE indicator is  
extinguished.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-52  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-514  
Page 1 of 2  
ODS2 MODULE APS TEST  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for verifying that the APS (Automatic  
Protection Switching) feature of the ODS2 module is working. Both working (online) and protect  
(offline) ODS2 modules are tested.  
Warning: Verify that module is completely disconnected from the chassis connectors  
before removing the optical fiber from the module. Verify that the far end transmitter is  
off before proceeding. Exposure to invisible laser radiation from the optical fiber is  
possible if the far end transmitter is transmitting. Verify that all indicators are dark (off).  
Warning: Do not insert module edge connectors into the chassis connectors  
before connecting the optical fiber to the module. Exposure to invisible laser  
radiation may occur if the module edge connectors are allowed to connect with  
the chassis connectors before connecting the optical fiber to the module. Verify  
that all indicators are dark (off) and the module is not engaged with the chassis  
connectors before proceeding.  
Caution: Modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before handling  
any modules, ESD protection must always be used. Ensure that all modules removed  
from the chassis or not installed are properly stored in anti-static packing material.  
When working with modules, always place the module on an electrically-grounded,  
approved, anti-static mat.  
1. Set up the Soneplex Broadband system and QFLC or QLX to perform end-to-end tests.  
Reference: DLP-510 ODS2 Distribution System and QFLC/QLX Chassis End-to-End  
Tests  
2. Identify the offline ODS2 module of the working and protect pair to be tested. The  
STATUS indicator is green and is the only illuminated indicator (its ONLINE indicator is  
extinguished).  
3. Slide offline ODS2 part way out. This disconnects the ODS2 from the chassis and ensures  
that data passes through the online ODS2 only.  
4. Perform end-to-end test and verify error-free data.  
Reference: DLP-510 ODS2 Distribution System and QFLC/QLX Chassis End-to-End  
Tests  
5. Using the ODS2 module ejector, press the offline module into the chassis until it is  
properly seated.  
6. Verify that the STATUS indicator on the offline ODS2 module is green, and that its  
ONLINE indicator is extinguished.  
2-53  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-514  
Page 2 of 2  
7. Verify that the STATUS indicator on the online ODS2 module is green, and that its  
ONLINE indicator is green.  
8. If the online ODS2 module APS indicator is red, hold the ENABLED button down and  
momentarily press LMPTST/APS to extinguish the APS indicator and enable APS.  
9. Initiate an Automatic Protection Switch (APS) on the offline ODS2 module using one of  
the following methods:  
Slide the online ODS2 module part way out to simulate online board failure.  
Disconnect fiber cable from the online ODS2 module RX to simulate RX LOS.  
Slide the online QFLC or QLX partway out to simulate a far-end module failure.  
Disconnect the fiber cable from the online QFLC or QLX RX to simulate a far-end  
RX LOS.  
10. Verify that ODS2 that was offline is now online (its ONLINE indicator is green).  
11. Perform end-to-end test and verify error-free data.  
Reference: DLP-510 ODS2 Distribution System and QFLC/QLX Chassis End-to-End  
Tests  
12. Using the ODS2 module ejector, press the module into the chassis until it is properly seated.  
13. Verify that STATUS indicator on offline ODS2 module is green and its ONLINE indicator  
is extinguished.  
14. Repeat Steps 8 through 13 for each APS simulation given in Step 9.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-54  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-515  
Page 1 of 1  
HDSL-EQUIPPED CIRCUIT CROSS-CONNECTS  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for making any necessary cross-connects on  
HDSL loops, and then re-install the HLXC modules.  
Danger: To avoid electric shock, be careful when working near HDSL loop connections  
or telecommunications circuits. An electrical potential of 130 volts exists on HDSL  
loop connections and telecommunications circuits. Coming in contact with this high  
electrical potential will result in death or severe personal injury.  
Caution: Electronic modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before  
handling modules, wear an anti-static discharge wrist strap to prevent damage to  
electronic components. Place modules in anti-static packing material when transporting  
or storing. When working on modules, always place them on an approved anti-static mat  
that is electrically grounded.  
1. Open the chassis cover.  
2. Use the ejector at the bottom of each HLXC module front panel to carefully disengage the  
module from its connector.  
3. Withdraw each HLXC module part way to break electrical contact with the backplane  
connector.  
Note: The HLXC module can be configured to supply –130 VDC simplex current over  
the HDSL loops to supply power to the remote HLXR modules. When an HDSL  
Repeater (HRX) is in the HDSL loops, HLXC modules can be configured to supply  
130 VDC. Partially withdrawing the HLXC module ensures that current is not present  
when cross-connects are installed.  
4. At the central office, make necessary cross-connects at the Main Distribution Frame, or  
other facility, in accordance with local practice.  
5. At the remote location, make necessary cross-connects at the remote distribution frame, or  
other facility, in accordance with local practice.  
6. Re-install the HLXC module(s) in their mounting slots.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-55  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-516  
Page 1 of 6  
HLXC INSTALLATION AND TESTING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for installing the Version C, D, E, or G HLXC  
module, which mounts in the half-height slots located in the middle of the chassis. A typical  
HDSL Loop Extension (HLX) system consists of an HLXC module installed in the chassis and  
an HLXR module installed at a remote location. There is no protection for the module or signal  
when using HDSL circuits.  
Caution: Modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before handling  
any modules, ESD protection must always be used. Ensure that all modules removed  
from the chassis or not installed are properly stored in anti-static packing material.  
When working with modules, always place the module on an electrically-grounded,  
approved, anti-static mat.  
Note: When using HLXC modules in a group, NEVER install ODS2 modules in any of  
the unused slots in the group.  
1. Select the HLXC module. If it is not already installed, remove the module from its  
protective ESD packaging. If the HLXC module is installed, remove it and inspect for  
physical damage.  
2. Version C HLXC only: locate the configuration switches on the HLXC module printed  
circuit board as shown in Figure 516-1.  
3. Version C HLXC only: set the configuration switches as specified in the work order.  
These switch settings do not need to be set if the unit is to be provisioned via the software.  
Otherwise, refer to Figure 516-1 for the switch handle settings. The following operating  
parameters are switch-selectable:  
Loop 2 (enable/disable)  
Loop Power (on/off)  
Note: With loop 2 enabled, both HDSL loops will be active allowing a full DS1 payload.  
With loop 2 disabled, the first 12 DS0 channels will be carried on loop 1 and DS0  
channels 13 through 24 will be filled with all ones (fractional DS1).  
Note: When the Loop Power switch is set to the ON position, the HLXC module  
supplies –130 VDC simplex power to the loops.  
4. Determine which HLXC slots are to be used, referring to your work order and Figure 516-  
2. Chassis slots 1-1 through 7-4 correspond to DS1 signals 1 through 28. See Table 516-1.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
2-56  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-516  
Page 2 of 6  
5. Align the edges of the printed circuit card with the card guides in the chassis. Use the  
injector at the bottom of the front panel to press the HLXC module into the chassis. If there  
is excessive resistance to insertion, remove the module and check for improper alignment  
or obstructions.  
6. Perform the initial start-up test detailed in Figure 516-3, observing the front panel LEDs,  
and verify that each LED operates as specified. Refer to Figure 516-4 for front panel  
layouts of the different HLXC versions.  
If the STATUS LED is green following self-test, proceed to Step 7.  
If the STATUS indicator is red, the HLXC module has failed self-test diagnostics.  
Remove and then reinsert the HLXC module and then wait while the HLXC module  
again performs self-test diagnostics. If the STATUS indicator turns red at the end of the  
second self-test, the HLXC module is defective. Remove and replace the HLXC, and  
then repeat Steps 1 through 6.  
7. Press the LMPTST switch on the APU to verify that the all the indicators on the HLXC  
module front panel light yellow. This indicates that each indicator is functional.  
If each indicator is yellow, continue to Step 8 or 9.  
If each indicator is not yellow, the HLXC module is defective. Remove and replace the  
HLXC, and then repeat Steps 1 through 7.  
8. Version C HLXC only: if the Loop Power option is selected in Step 3, measure DC voltage  
and DC current being supplied to the HLXR. (The Version E and Version D HLXC defaults  
to loop power enabled.)  
Reference: DLP-568 Version C HLXC to HLXR Voltage and Current Test  
Reference: DLP-572 Version D (or Later) HLXC to HLXR Voltage and Current Test  
9. Repeat entire procedure for each HLXC module.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-57  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-516  
Page 3 of 6  
SWITCH  
FUNCTION  
LOOP POWER  
UNUSED  
POSITION  
6
5
4
ON (ENABLED)  
OFF (DISABLED)  
6
5
4
3
2
1
LOOP 2  
ON (ENABLED)  
OFF (DISABLED)  
ON  
3,2,1  
LINE LENGTH  
0 - 133 FT  
133 - 266 FT  
266 - 399 FT  
399 - 533 FT  
533 - 655 FT  
3
2
1
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
OFF  
CONFIGURATION SWITCHES  
(COMPONENT SIDE VIEW)  
DEFAULT SWITCH SETTINGS : 6, 5, 4 - ON, 3, 2, 1 - OFF  
6
5
4
3
2
1
ON  
5170-C  
Figure 516-1. Version C HLXC Module Configuration Switches  
2-58  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-516  
Page 4 of 6  
1 to 28 HLXC UNITS  
APU  
HSP  
1-1 1-3 2-1 2-3 3-1 3-3 4-1 4-3 5-1 5-3 6-1 6-3 7-1 7-3  
HSW  
MXW MXP TAU  
CR  
MJ  
MN  
ACO  
PWR  
RTAU  
HSKP  
RMT  
ALM  
STATUS  
LPBK  
STATUS  
LPBK  
D
I
S
P
R
M
T
LMPTST  
DS3 FAIL  
ENABLE  
ENABLE  
APU  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
ONLINE  
ONLINE  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
STATUS  
APS  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
APS  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
LMPTST/  
APS  
LMPTST/  
APS  
RESET  
RESET  
MPU  
1-2 1-4 2-2 2-4 3-2 3-4 4-2 4-4 5-2 5-4 6-2 6-4 7-2 7-4  
6181-B  
DS3 MUX  
UNITS  
RTAU  
MODULE  
Figure 516-2. HLXC Module Locations  
Table 516-1. DS1 Signal Routing  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
GROUP-  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1-1  
8
2-4  
3-1  
3-2  
3-3  
3-4  
4-1  
4-2  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
4-3  
4-4  
5-1  
5-2  
5-3  
5-4  
6-1  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
6-2  
6-3  
6-4  
7-1  
7-2  
7-3  
7-4  
1-2  
9
1-3  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
1-4  
2-1  
2-2  
2-3  
2-59  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-516  
Page 5 of 6  
INITIAL START-UP TEST AND STAND ALONE OPERATION  
Note: When an HRX is installed, the HLXC indicators  
only verify the loop segment between the HLXC and  
the HRX.  
After the HLXC is installed in the chassis, its STATUS indicator  
will initially turn red to indicate the start of self-test diagnostics.  
While the self-test is in progress, all indicators will briefly  
turn yellow. Then all indicators except STATUS will turn off.  
Following the successful completion of the self-test, the HLXC  
front panel indicators will appear as follows:  
Green to indicate that the self-test was  
successfully completed.  
STATUS  
RMT/HSKP  
LPBK  
Off.  
Off.  
DS1 LOS/BER  
Red to indicate that a DS1 signal is not  
being received by the HLXC.  
HDSL CONT/SNR Red (after a short delay) if loop power  
is enabled which indicate the HDSL  
loops are open. Off if loop power is  
disabled.  
L1 and L2  
LOSW/BER  
Red to indicate that the HDSL loops are not  
synchronized (i.e., HLXR is not in service).  
If loop 2 is disabled, the L2 indicators will  
stay off.  
6762-C  
Figure 516-3. HLXC Module Initial Start-Up  
2-60  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-516  
Page 6 of 6  
H
L
X
H
L
X
H
L
X
2X  
STAT  
STAT  
STAT  
RMT/  
HSKP  
RMT/  
HSKP  
RMT/  
HSKP  
LPBK  
LPBK  
LPBK  
LOS  
BER  
LOS  
BER  
DS1  
DS1  
LOS  
DS1  
BER  
CONT  
SNR  
LOSW  
BER  
CONT  
SNR  
LOSW  
BER  
CONT  
HDSL  
L1  
HDSL  
L1  
SNR  
H
D
LOSW  
BER  
L1  
S
L
LOSW  
LOSW  
BER  
LOSW  
BER  
L2  
BER  
L2  
L2  
I-  
2X  
V -  
V-  
I-  
V+  
V–  
V+  
I+  
I+  
V+  
6770-A  
11395-A  
12391-A  
Versions C and D HLXC  
Version E HLXC  
Version G HLXC  
Figure 516-4. HLXC Front Panel Layouts  
2-61  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-517  
Page 1 of 1  
RTAU INSTALLATION AND TESTING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for installing the Remote Test Access Unit  
(RTAU) in the chassis and verifying that it is functioning properly. The RTAU requires no  
provisioning or periodic maintenance.  
Caution: Modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before handling  
any modules, ESD protection must always be used. An ESD grounding post is located on  
the chassis for connecting the ESD wrist band. Ensure that all modules removed from  
the equipment or not installed, are properly stored in anti-static packing material. When  
working with modules, always place the module on an electrically-grounded, approved,  
anti-static mat.  
Note: For information about installing and testing the RTAU, which is used with MPU  
Software Version 5.3, refer to the Soneplex RTAU (Remote Test Access Unit)  
Installation Instructions manual, listed under Related Publications at the beginning of  
this manual.  
1. Remove the RTAU from its protective packaging.  
2. Insert the RTAU into the full height chassis slot labeled TAU (as shown in Figure 517-1)  
until it reaches the backplane connector.  
3. Using the ejectors, fully seat the RTAU in the chassis. A moderate amount of force may be  
required to properly seat the module in the backplane connector.  
4. Did the STATUS indicator light green?  
If Yes, you have completed this procedure.  
If No, replace the RTAU and return to Step 1.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
APU  
1-1 1-3 2-1 2-3 3-1 3-3 4-1 4-3 5-1 5-3 6-1 6-3 7-1 7-3  
HSP  
HSW  
MXW MXP TAU  
CR  
MJ  
MN  
ACO  
PWR  
RTAU  
HSKP  
RMT  
ALM  
STATUS  
STATUS  
D
I
S
P
R
M
T
LPBK  
LPBK  
STATUS  
LMPTST  
ENABLE  
ENABLE  
B8ZS  
AMI  
APU  
ONLINE  
ONLINE  
LINE CODE  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
INTRUSIVE  
TEST  
STATUS  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
APS  
APS  
LMPTST/  
APS  
LMPTST/  
APS  
RX  
TX  
D
S
1
RESET  
RESET  
RESET  
1-2 1-4 2-2 2-4 3-2 3-4 4-2 4-4 5-2 5-4 6-2 6-4 7-2 7-4 MPU  
12692-A  
RTAU MODULE  
Figure 517-1. RTAU Mounting Position in the Soneplex Broadband Chassis  
2-62  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-518  
Page 1 of 2  
RLX ALARM LEVEL SETTING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for assigning RLX alarm levels to each field.  
Note: A togglefield type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the Rkey to view and select the  
previous option. An inputfield type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A fixedfield is locked, and cannot be changed  
by the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the Rkey to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved in one of two ways: 1) Press an  
arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return twice after all  
selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen. The message,  
Configuration SuccessfulPress Any Key To Continue," appears on the screen if the  
entries have been accepted.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Alarms from the Main Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Set Alarm Levels from the Alarms menu. Press Enter or  
Return.  
3. Select Set RLX Alarm Levels from the Alarm Levels menu. Press Enter or Return. An RLX  
Alarm Levels screen with default values is shown in Figure 518-1.  
4. Move to the Group toggle field. Select group number 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.  
5. Move to the Slot toggle field. Select slot number 1, 2, 3, or 4.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
6. Move to the Equipment Alarms toggle fields. Select CRITICAL (CR), MAJOR (MJ), MINOR  
(MN), EVENT (EV) or NOT RPTD (not reported) for each field that you wish to change.  
Note: Abbreviations of the alarm field options (except NOT RPTD) will appear in the  
Active Alarms and Alarm History screens. In addition, what options you select at any  
alarm level setting screen will determine whether you will be notified of the alarm.  
Reference: DLP-552 Alarm/Event Notification Level Setting  
2-63  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-518  
Page 2 of 2  
7. Move to the DS1 Facility Alarms toggle fields. Select CRITICAL, MAJOR, MINOR,  
EVENT, or NOT RPTD for each field that you wish to change.  
Reference: TAP-101 Alarm Troubleshooting  
8. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
RLX ALARM LEVELS  
Group: 1  
Slot: 1  
Equipment Alarms  
===================  
COMM FAIL  
: MAJOR  
DS1 Facility Alarms  
===================  
AIS  
: EVENT  
LOF  
LOS  
T-BERL  
YELLOW  
: MAJOR  
: MAJOR  
: MINOR  
: EVENT  
CUSTOMER LOOPBACK: MINOR  
NETWORK LOOPBACK : MINOR  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6118-D  
Figure 518-1. RLX Alarm Levels Screen (with Default Values)  
2-64  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-519  
Page 1 of 3  
MPU REPLACEMENT AND TESTING  
Summary  
This procedure provides instructions for installing a previously configured MPU in a chassis  
(whether provisioned or not) and verifying that the MPU is functioning. When an MPU from a  
provisioned chassis is moved to another chassis, the chassis unit (module) configurations may  
not match the MPU unit configurations. These instructions explain how to avoid unwanted data  
replacements or data conflicts. The MPU contains both general configuration data and unit  
configuration data.  
All configuration data can be restored to the MPU by performing a database upload or download  
procedure. The upload is outlined in DLP-554 (Configuration Data Upload Command), and the  
download is outlined in DLP-555 (Configuration Data Download Command).  
General Configuration Data  
System administration and maintenance tasks create general configuration data (alarm levels,  
PM thresholds, system identification, port configuration, and user account data).  
Unit Configuration Data  
Individual module configurations create unit configuration data (which includes unit service  
state, framing, line coding, etc.) Unit configuration data does not need to be re-entered as long as  
the chassis remains powered and transmission units remain installed. Unit configuration data is  
also stored in the transmission units and is loaded back into a non-configured MPU  
automatically.  
Note: When installing a replacement MPU module, use the same DIP or rotary switch  
settings on the MPUs printed circuit board as the MPU you are removing.  
Note: When an MPU is removed from a powered-up chassis, the MPU retains both  
general and unit configuration data for at least 24 hours. Do not install a still-configured  
MPU in an already-configured chassis. If you want to retain unit configuration data in all  
transmission units (or prevent alarms) and you are installing a previously configured  
MPU, verify that the MPUs unit configuration data is gone before you re-install it.  
Caution: Do NOT re-install MPUs with revisions older than 3.1, or MPUs that have an  
older revision than the currently installed MPU. A corrupted database may result.  
Caution: Electronic modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before  
handling modules, wear an anti-static discharge wrist strap to prevent damage to  
electronic components. Place modules in anti-static packing material when transporting  
or storing. When working on modules, always place them on an approved anti-static mat  
that is electrically grounded.  
2-65  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-519  
Page 2 of 3  
1. To save the replacement MPUs current configuration data, upload configuration data to the  
host computer. Contact the Technical Assistance Center at ADC Telecommunications,  
described in the General Information section of this manual, for more information.  
Reference: DLP-554 Configuration Data Upload Command  
2. Locate the mounting slot designated for the MPU as shown in Figure 519-1.  
3. Align the edges of the module printed circuit card with the guides in the chassis slot. Use  
the injector at the bottom of the front panel to press the MPU into the chassis. If there is  
excessive resistance to insertion, remove the module and check for improper alignment and  
obstructions.  
Note: If you are not sure that the MPUs database is cleared, contact the ADC Technical  
Assistance Center at 1-800-366-3891, ext. 3223, or 1-612-946-3223 for more  
information.  
4. Use the screw provided to secure the MPU to the top edge of the chassis.  
5. Observe the STATUS LED as shown in Figure 519-2. Initially, the status LED will be  
yellow while the MPU performs self-test diagnostics. When the self-test diagnostics are  
successfully completed, the STATUS LED will turn green.  
If the STATUS LED is green, continue to Step 6.  
If the STATUS LED is red, the MPU has failed self-test diagnostics. Press the MPU  
RESET switch and then wait while the MPU again performs self-test diagnostics. If the  
STATUS LED turns red at the end of the second self-test, the MPU is defective.  
Remove and replace the MPU, and then repeat Steps 2 through 5.  
6. Press the LMPTST switch on the APU to verify that the STATUS LED on the MPU front  
panel lights yellow. This indicates that the LED is functional. If the STATUS LED does not  
light yellow, the MPU is defective. Remove and replace the MPU, and then repeat Steps 2  
through 5.  
7. Connect a VT-100 (or equivalent) control terminal or host computer to the MPU Craft port.  
Reference: DLP-504 Local Craft Interface Connection  
8. Turn the power on to the control terminal or host computer and press Enter or Return. The  
Logon screen appears.  
9. Logon to the Craft Interface and check the status of each transmission module to verify that  
the configuration data is correct.  
Reference: DLP-526 Craft Interface System Logon  
2-66  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-519  
Page 3 of 3  
10. Re-enter the MPU configuration data manually or follow this procedure:  
Reference: DLP-555 Configuration Data Download Command  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
HIGH SPEED UNITS  
LOW SPEED UNITS  
HSW HSP MXW MXP TAU  
APU  
1-1 1-3 2-1 2-3 3-1 3-3 4-1 4-3 5-1 5-3 6-1 6-3 7-1 7-3  
A
P
U
M
P
U
1-2 1-4 2-2 2-4 3-2 3-4 4-2 4-4 5-2 5-4 6-2 6-4 7-2 7-4  
MPU  
8025-A  
Figure 519-1. Soneplex Broadband Chassis (Front View) Mounting Slot for MPU  
M
P
U
STATUS  
C
R
A
F
T
RESET  
1749-B  
Figure 519-2. MPU Front Panel  
2-67  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-520  
Page 1 of 2  
HLXC AND HLXR END-TO-END TESTS  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for using a DS3 test set (with DS1 option) to  
verify that error-free data is received from the HLXC module at the HLXR module.  
Caution: Modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before handling  
any modules, ESD protection must always be used. Ensure that all modules removed  
from the chassis or not installed are properly stored in anti-static packing material.  
When working with modules, always place the module on an electrically-grounded,  
approved, anti-static mat.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Connect a DS3 test set (with DS1 option) to the cross-connect or to the RX and TX  
connections at the rear of the chassis. See Figures 520-1 and 520-2.  
2. Identify the HLXC module corresponding to the DS1 circuit to be tested.  
3. Identify the HLXR module corresponding to the DS1 circuit to be tested.  
4. Connect the DS1 Test Set RX to the NET OUT jack on the front panel of the HLXR module.  
5. Connect the DS1 Test Set TX to the NET IN jack on the front panel of the HLXR module.  
6. Using the Craft Interface, verify that the DS3 MUX is EQUIPPED and is IN SERVICE.  
Reference: DLP-529 DS3 MUX Configuration  
7. Using the Craft Interface, verify that the HLXC module to be tested is EQUIPPED and IN  
SERVICE and the DS1 to be tested is PROVISIONED and IN SERVICE.  
Reference: DLP-531 HLX Configuration  
8. Insert a test signal into the DS1 to be tested using the DS3 test set with DS1 option.  
9. Verify that all alarm indicators on the chassis are out and the DS1 test set at the HLXR  
module NET OUT jack is receiving error-free data for the DS1 test signal selected.  
10. Insert a DS1 test signal into the HLXR module NET IN jack using the DS1 test set.  
11. Verify that all alarm indicators on the chassis are out and the DS3 test set with DS1 option  
is receiving error-free data in the DS1 selected for test.  
12. Repeat procedure starting at Step 2 for all HLXC modules to be tested.  
13. Record test results and update office records following local office practices.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-68  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-520  
Page 2 of 2  
DSX-3  
CROSS-CONNECT  
SONEPLEX  
BROADBAND  
CHASSIS  
DS3 TEST SET  
RX  
MON  
DS1 TEST SET  
TX  
TX  
OUT  
DS3  
IN  
RX  
TX  
RX  
SONEPLEX  
BROADBAND  
CHASSIS  
HLXR  
DS1 TEST SET  
OUT  
L1  
L2  
RX  
HLXC  
NET  
TX  
IN  
6187-D  
Figure 520-1. Test Set Up (Without HRX)  
DSX-3  
CROSS-CONNECT  
SONEPLEX  
BROADBAND  
CHASSIS  
DS3 TEST SET  
RX  
MON  
DS1 TEST SET  
TX  
TX  
OUT  
IN  
DS3  
RX  
TX  
RX  
SONEPLEX  
BROADBAND  
CHASSIS  
HLXR  
HRX  
DS1 TEST SET  
OUT  
L1  
L2  
L1  
L2  
RX  
NET  
IN  
HLXC  
TX  
6658-D  
Figure 520-2. Test Set Up (With HRX)  
2-69  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-521  
Page 1 of 2  
DLX INSTALLATION AND TESTING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for mounting DLX modules in the half-height  
slots located in the middle of the chassis. A typical DLX installation consists of a DLX installed  
in a chassis and a channel bank at the other end. There is no protection for this signal.  
Caution: Modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before handling  
any modules, ESD protection must always be used. Ensure that all modules removed  
from the chassis or not installed are properly stored in anti-static packing material.  
When working with modules, always place the module on an electrically-grounded,  
approved, anti-static mat.  
Note: When using DLX modules in a group, NEVER install ODS2 modules in any of  
the unused slots in the group.  
1. Remove the module from the protective packaging if required. Refer to your work order  
and determine which DLX slots are to be used. DLX chassis slots are shown in  
Figure 521-1. Chassis slots 1-1 through 7-4 correspond to DS1 signals 1 through 28 as  
shown in Table 521-1.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
2. Align module with the slots and slide module into the chassis. Using the ejector, press the  
DLX module into the chassis until it is properly seated.  
3. Press LMPTST switch on the APU. Are all indicators lighted?  
If Yes, continued to Step 4.  
If No, replace DLX module and go to Step 1.  
4. Repeat entire procedure for each DLX module.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-70  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-521  
Page 2 of 2  
1 to 28 DLX UNITS  
APU  
HSP  
1-1 1-3 2-1 2-3 3-1 3-3 4-1 4-3 5-1 5-3 6-1 6-3 7-1 7-3  
HSW  
MXW MXP TAU  
CR  
MJ  
MN  
ACO  
PWR  
RTAU  
HSKP  
RMT  
ALM  
STATUS  
LPBK  
STATUS  
LPBK  
D
I
S
P
R
M
T
LMPTST  
DS3 FAIL  
ENABLE  
ENABLE  
APU  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
ONLINE  
ONLINE  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
STATUS  
APS  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
APS  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
LMPTST/  
APS  
LMPTST/  
APS  
RESET  
RESET  
MPU  
1-2 1-4 2-2 2-4 3-2 3-4 4-2 4-4 5-2 5-4 6-2 6-4 7-2 7-4  
6182-B  
DS3 MUX  
UNITS  
RTAU  
MODULE  
Figure 521-1. DLX Module Locations  
Table 521-1. DS1 Signal Routing  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1-1  
1-2  
1-3  
1-4  
2-1  
2-2  
2-3  
8
2-4  
3-1  
3-2  
3-3  
3-4  
4-1  
4-2  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
4-3  
4-4  
5-1  
5-2  
5-3  
5-4  
6-1  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
6-2  
6-3  
6-4  
7-1  
7-2  
7-3  
7-4  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
2-71  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-522  
Page 1 of 2  
DLX- OR RLX-EQUIPPED CIRCUIT END-TO-END TESTS  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for performing end-to-end system tests on  
Soneplex circuits equipped with DLX or RLX plug-ins. Two telephone technicians may be  
required to perform this test, one at the near end and one at the far end of the system. The  
installation must be complete and the equipment operating properly before performing this test.  
Warning: To prevent electric shock and/or equipment damage, disable span power at  
the RLX module before performing this test.  
1. At the chassis, identify the DLX or RLX pair that corresponds to the DS1 circuit to be  
tested.  
Reference: DLP-532 DLX Configuration  
Reference: DLP-533 RLXIOR Configuration  
Reference: DLP-534 RLX Configuration  
2. At the chassis, connect a DS3 test set with DS1 option to the DSX-3 cross-connect or to the  
RX and TX connections at the rear of the chassis. Adjust the test set for the particular DS1  
to be tested. See Figure 522-1.  
3. At the far end of the circuit, identify the DS1 pair that corresponds to the circuit to be  
tested.  
4. At the far end of the circuit, connect a DS1 test set to the circuit to be tested at the DS1  
input and output connections, the DS1 patch panel, or at the DSX-1 module. Adjust the test  
set for the particular DS1 to be tested. See Figure 522-1.  
5. At both ends of the circuit to be tested, make necessary cross-connects so that the circuit(s)  
is connected end-to-end.  
6. Using the Craft Interface, verify that the modules are EQUIPPED and IN SERVICE.  
Reference: DLP-529 DS3 MUX Configuration  
Reference: DLP-532 DLX Configuration  
Reference: DLP-533 RLXIOR Configuration  
Reference: DLP-534 RLX Configuration  
7. At the chassis location, insert a test signal into the DS1 to be tested using the DS3 test set  
with DS1 option.  
8. Verify that all alarm indicators on the chassis are off and the DS1 test set at the far end DS1  
output is receiving error-free data for the selected DS1 test signal.  
9. Repeat Steps 7 and 8 for all DS1 circuits to be tested.  
2-72  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-522  
Page 2 of 2  
10. At the far end of the circuit, insert a DS1 test signal into the DS1 input using the DS1 test set.  
11. Verify that all alarm indicators on the chassis are off and the DS3 test set with DS1 option  
is receiving error-free data in the DS1 signal selected for test.  
12. Repeat Steps 10 and 11 for all DS1 circuits to be tested.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
DSX-3  
CROSS-CONNECT  
SONEPLEX  
BROADBAND  
CHASSIS  
DS3 TEST SET  
RX  
MON  
TX  
OUT  
IN  
DS3  
RX  
TX  
DSX-1  
CROSS-CONNECT  
SONEPLEX  
BROADBAND  
CHASSIS  
OFFICE EQUIPMENT  
MON  
TX  
DS1 TEST SET  
OUT  
IN  
DLX  
or  
RLX  
RX  
RX  
TX  
6186-B  
Figure 522-1. Test Setup  
2-73  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-523  
Page 1 of 2  
ASSIGNMENT RECORDS  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for recording circuit and facility names, along  
with the associated group-slot numbers. Each circuit in the Soneplex Broadband system is  
identified by signal type and location. Signal types are either T1, T2, or T3. Each circuit or  
system is also assigned a slot number when installed.  
1. An example of the circuit line assignment record that may be useful when troubleshooting  
is shown in Figure 523-1. Chassis slot numbers are shown in Figure 523-2.  
2. Record circuit or system name and the associated slot number on your record assignment  
form.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
HIGH SPEED UNITS  
LOW SPEED UNITS  
HSW HSP MXW MXP TAU  
APU  
1-1 1-3 2-1 2-3 3-1 3-3 4-1 4-3 5-1 5-3 6-1 6-3 7-1 7-3  
1-2 1-4 2-2 2-4 3-2 3-4 4-2 4-4 5-2 5-4 6-2 6-4 7-2 7-4  
MPU  
GROUP- NUMBERS  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1982-A  
Figure 523-1. Slot Numbers  
2-74  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-523  
Page 2 of 2  
GROUP-SLOT  
HSW/HSP  
MXW/MXP  
1-1  
SYSTEM (CIRCUIT) NAME  
1-2  
1-3  
1-4  
2-1  
2-2  
2-3  
2-4  
3-1  
3-2  
3-3  
3-4  
4-1  
4-2  
4-3  
4-4  
5-1  
5-2  
5-3  
5-4  
6-1  
6-2  
6-3  
6-4  
7-1  
7-2  
7-3  
7-4  
Figure 523-2. Assignment Record Form  
2-75  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-524  
Page 1 of 5  
RLXIOR INSTALLATION AND TESTING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for installing the Repeater Loop Extender  
Intelligent Office Repeater (RLXIOR) module in the chassis. A typical deployment consists of  
an RLXIOR module installed in a chassis that is connected to a repeater or a series of line  
repeaters. There is no protection for this signal, and an MPU must be installed to enable  
configuration and alarm reporting for this module.  
The installation procedure consists of unpacking the RLXIOR, setting two configuration  
switches, installing the RLXIOR in the chassis, and verifying that it is functioning  
properly. The RLXIOR may be installed in either a Soneplex Broadband chassis or a  
Soneplex Loop Extender chassis.  
Caution: To enable span power on the RLXIOR module, a proper connection must be  
made between chassis ground and –48V return at a location in the central office,  
following local practices. It is recommended that this connection be made outside the  
Soneplex chassis.  
Caution: Electronic modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before  
handling modules, wear an anti-static discharge wrist strap to prevent damage to  
electronic components. Place modules in anti-static packing material when transporting  
or storing. When working on modules, always place them on an approved anti-static mat  
that is electrically grounded.  
1. Open the shipping carton and carefully unpack the RLXIOR from the protective packing  
material. See Figure 524-1.  
2. Set the configuration switches on the RLXIOR to match the requirement of the work order.  
See Figure 524-2 for the location of switches. The following operating parameters are  
switch-selectable:  
Line Power (–130 Vdc or 130 Vdc)  
Channel Blocking Idle Code (7Fhex or FFhex)  
Note: Factory default settings for the RLXIOR switches are –130 Vdc for Line Power  
and 7Fhex for Channel Blocking Idle Code.  
3. Align the edges of the RLXIOR module with the slot guides. Use the ejector to press the  
module into the backplane connector in one of the module locations, as shown in Figure  
524-3. If excessive resistance is encountered, remove the module and check for  
obstructions or improper alignment.  
2-76  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-524  
Page 2 of 5  
R
L
X
I
O
R
S
T
A
T
L
P
B
K
N
E
T
L
B
O
S
E
R
L
IN  
E
L
B
O
E
S
R
I-  
11680-A  
V
-
I+  
V
+
Figure 524-1. Repeater Loop Extender Intelligent Office Repeater (RLXIOR) Module  
(With Configuration Switches Shown)  
2-77  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-524  
Page 3 of 5  
SPAN  
VOLTAGE  
BLOCK  
CODE  
130 FF  
–130V 7F  
11657-B  
Figure 524-2. RLXIOR Configuration Switches (With Default Settings)  
1 to 28 RLXIOR UNITS  
APU  
HSP  
1-1 1-3 2-1 2-3 3-1 3-3 4-1 4-3 5-1 5-3 6-1 6-3 7-1 7-3  
MXW MXP TAU  
HSW  
CR  
MJ  
MN  
ACO  
PWR  
RTAU  
HSKP  
RMT  
ALM  
STATUS  
STATUS  
D
I
S
P
R
M
T
LPBK  
LPBK  
STATUS  
LMPTST  
ENABLE  
ENABLE  
B8ZS  
AMI  
APU  
ONLINE  
ONLINE  
LINE CODE  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
INTRUSIVE  
TEST  
STATUS  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
APS  
APS  
LMPTST/  
APS  
LMPTST/  
APS  
RX  
TX  
D
S
1
RESET  
RESET  
RESET  
1-2 1-4 2-2 2-4 3-2 3-4 4-2 4-4 5-2 5-4 6-2 6-4 7-2 7-4 MPU  
rlxior.slots.eps  
RTAU MODULE  
Figure 524-3. RLXIOR Module Locations  
2-78  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-524  
Page 4 of 5  
4. Observe the front panel LED indicators as shown in Figure 524-4. Following insertion of  
the RLXIOR module into the chassis (assuming power is available), the STATUS LED  
turns red indicating the start of self-test diagnostics. All LEDs then turn yellow and remain  
yellow until self-test diagnostics are completed. Following successful completion of self-  
test diagnostics, the front panel LEDs appears as follows:  
STATUS — Green, indicates successful completion of self-test diagnostics.  
LPBK — Off  
NET LOS/BER — Off  
LINE LOS/BER — Off  
I
O
R
R
L
X
STAT  
LPBK  
LOS  
BER  
NET  
LOS  
BER  
LINE  
V -  
I-  
I+  
V+  
11784-A  
Figure 524-4. RLXIOR Front Panel  
2-79  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-524  
Page 5 of 5  
5. If the LED indicators respond as described, proceed to Step 6; otherwise, refer to the  
following to isolate the problem:  
STATUS is red — The RLXIOR module has failed self-test diagnostics. Remove and  
reinsert the module, then wait while it again performs self-test diagnostics. If the  
STATUS LED turns red at the end of the second self-test, the module is defective;  
replace the module, then repeat Steps 1 through 4.  
NET LOS/BER is red — A DS1 signal is not being received from the network.  
NET LOS/BER is yellow — The error rate of the DS1 network signal exceeds the  
threshold value (default value is 10–7).  
LINE LOS/BER is red — A DS1 signal is not being received from the line.  
LINE LOS/BER is yellow — The error rate of the DS1 line signal exceeds the  
threshold value (default value is 10–7).  
6. Press the LMPTST switch on the APU to verify that all the LEDs on the front panel of the  
RLXIOR light yellow. This indicates that the LEDs are functional. If all LEDs do not light  
yellow, the module is defective; replace the module, then repeat Steps 1 through 6.  
Note: The MPU must be installed in the chassis for Step 6 to work.  
7. Repeat this entire procedure for each RLXIOR module.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-80  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-525  
Page 1 of 6  
RLX INSTALLATION AND TESTING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for installing Version A RLX or Version B  
RLX (B1 RLX and B2 RLX+) modules in the chassis and verifying that each unit is functioning.  
A typical installation consists of an RLX module installed in a chassis that is connected to a  
repeater or a series of line repeaters. There is no protection for this signal. Version A RLX  
modules provide an APU interface, and can function without an MPU. There is no APU interface  
for either Version B RLX module, and an MPU must be installed to enable configuration and  
alarm reporting for these modules. Other differences between Version A and Version B RLX  
modules are described below.  
Caution: Modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before handling  
any modules, ESD protection must always be used. Ensure that all modules removed  
from the chassis or not installed are properly stored in anti-static packing material.  
When working with modules, always place the module on an electrically-grounded,  
approved, anti-static mat.  
Note: NEVER install an RLX in the same quad group with ODS2 modules.  
1. Locate the configuration switches on the Version A RLX module shown in Figure 525-1, or  
the jumpers on the Version B RLX module in Figure 525-2 (B1) and Figure 525-3 (B2).  
2. Set the configuration switches or jumpers as specified in the work order:  
Version A RLX only: The following operating parameters are switch-selectable:  
Span (line) Power (On or Off)  
Transmit Line Buildout (0.0 dB, 7.5 dB, 15.0 dB, or 22.5 dB of attenuation)  
NID Loop Code Recognition (Enable or Disable)  
Line Equalization for the DSX (0–133 feet, 133–266 feet, 266–399 feet,  
399–533 feet, and 533–655 feet.)  
Note: When the Span Power switch is placed in the On (closed) position, the RLX  
supplies –130 VDC simplex power to the line.  
Note: The MPU can override or select the Version A RLX hardware switch settings.  
These switch settings do not need to be set if the unit provisioning is being performed  
through the software.  
Reference: DLP-534 RLX Configuration  
Version B RLX only: b1 only The following operating parameters are jumper-selectable:  
Channel Blocking Idle Code (FFhex or 7Fhex)  
Line (span) Power (–130 VDC only on the B1 RLX; –130 VDC or 130 VDC  
on the B2 RLX+)  
2-81  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-525  
Page 2 of 6  
Note: The Version B RLX switches can be enabled or disabled by the MPU if the  
jumpers are in place. But the switches' jumper settings themselves (FFhex or 7Fhex for  
the Channel Blocking Idle switch; –130V or 130V for the Line Power switch) cannot  
be overridden by the MPU.  
Note: The B1 RLX factory default setting for the Channel Blocking Idle Code jumper is  
7Fhex; the B1 RLX factory default setting for the Line Power jumper is –130 VDC. The  
B2 RLX+ factory default setting for the Channel Blocking Idle Code jumper is FFhex;  
the B2 RLX+ factory default setting for the Line Power jumper is –130 VDC. A missing  
jumper in the Channel Blocking Idle Code causes a default to FFhex. A missing jumper  
in Line Power causes a default to no voltage output.  
Note: If the Line Power jumper is set, it must also be enabled, which is done through  
software.  
Reference: DLP-534 RLX Configuration  
3. Refer to your work order to determine which RLX slots are to be used. Slot locations are  
illustrated in Figure 525-4. Chassis slots 1-1 through 7-4 correspond to DS1 signals 1  
through 28 as shown in Table 525-1.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
4. Align the RLX module with the slots and slide it into the chassis. Use the ejector to press the  
RLX module into the backplane connector until it is properly seated. If there is excessive  
resistance to insertion, remove the unit and check for improper alignment or obstructions.  
5. Observe the front panel LED indicators as shown in Figure 525-5 and verify that each LED  
operates as specified in the initial start-up test.  
If the STATUS LED is green following self-test, continue to Step 5.  
If the STATUS LED is red, the RLX has failed self-test diagnostics. Remove and then  
reinsert the RLX and then wait while the RLX again performs self-test diagnostics. If  
the STATUS LED turns red at the end of the second self-test, the RLX is defective.  
Remove and replace the RLX, and then repeat Steps 1 through 5.  
6. Press the LMPTST switch on the APU and verify that all indicators light yellow.  
If Yes, continue to Step 7.  
If No, replace the RLX module and go to Step 1.  
Note: An MPU must be present for a Version B RLX lamp test. The MPU does not need  
to be present for a Version A RLX lamp test.  
7. If the Span Power (in the Version A RLX) option or Line Power (in the Version B RLX)  
option is selected in Step 1, measure DC voltage and DC current being supplied to the  
repeater.  
Reference: DLP-567 RLX Voltage to Repeater Test  
2-82  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-525  
Page 3 of 6  
8. Repeat entire procedure for each RLX module.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
SA2  
SA3  
SA3-1  
1
2
3
1
2
3
1
2
3
OPEN  
OPEN  
OPEN  
DSX LINE EQUALIZATION  
OPEN, OPEN, OPEN  
CLOSED, OPEN, OPEN  
OPEN, CLOSED, OPEN  
CLOSED, CLOSED, OPEN = 399 TO 533 FT  
OPEN. OPEN, CLOSED = 533 TO 655 FT  
NOT USED  
= 0 TO 133 FT  
= 133 TO 266 FT  
= 266 TO 399 FT  
SPAN POWER  
CLOSED = ON  
OPEN = OFF  
TRANSMIT LINE BUILDOUT  
CLOSED, CLOSED = 22.5 DB  
NID LOOP CODE RECOGNITION  
CLOSED = ENABLE  
CLOSED, OPEN  
OPEN CLOSED  
OPEN, OPEN  
= 15 DB  
= 7.5 DB  
= 0 DB  
OPEN  
= DISABLE  
CONFIGURATION  
SWITCH PLACEMENT  
SA2  
SA3-1  
SA3  
6262-A  
Figure 525-1. Version A RLX Configuration Switches  
2-83  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-525  
Page 4 of 6  
CHANNEL BLOCKING  
IDLE CODE  
LINE POWER  
OR  
FF  
7F  
130V  
7428-B  
Figure 525-2. Placement of B1 RLX Jumpers  
CHANNEL BLOCKING  
IDLE CODE  
LINE POWER  
OR  
OR  
FF  
7F  
130V  
130V  
7035-A  
Figure 525-3. Placement of B2 RLX+ Jumpers  
2-84  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-525  
Page 5 of 6  
1 to 28 RLX UNITS  
APU  
HSP  
1-1 1-3 2-1 2-3 3-1 3-3 4-1 4-3 5-1 5-3 6-1 6-3 7-1 7-3  
HSW  
MXW MXP TAU  
CR  
MJ  
MN  
ACO  
PWR  
RTAU  
HSKP  
RMT  
ALM  
STATUS  
LPBK  
STATUS  
LPBK  
D
I
S
P
R
M
T
LMPTST  
DS3 FAIL  
ENABLE  
ENABLE  
APU  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
ONLINE  
ONLINE  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
STATUS  
APS  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
APS  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
LMPTST/  
APS  
LMPTST/  
APS  
RESET  
RESET  
MPU  
1-2 1-4 2-2 2-4 3-2 3-4 4-2 4-4 5-2 5-4 6-2 6-4 7-2 7-4  
6183-B  
DS3 MUX  
UNITS  
RTAU  
MODULE  
Figure 525-4. RLX Module Locations  
Table 525-1. DS1 Signal Routing  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1-1  
1-2  
1-3  
1-4  
2-1  
2-2  
2-3  
8
2-4  
3-1  
3-2  
3-3  
3-4  
4-1  
4-2  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
4-3  
4-4  
5-1  
5-2  
5-3  
5-4  
6-1  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
6-2  
6-3  
6-4  
7-1  
7-2  
7-3  
7-4  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
2-85  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-525  
Page 6 of 6  
R
L
X
R
L
X
+
INITIAL START-UP TEST AND  
STAND ALONE OPERATION  
STAT  
STAT  
LPBK  
Following insertion into the mounting shelf, the STATUS  
LED will initially turn red to indicate the start of self-test  
diagnostics. While self-test diagnostics are in progress, all  
LEDs will turn yellow and then remain on until self-test  
diagnostics are completed.  
LPBK  
ENBL  
LOS  
BER  
LOS  
BER  
NET  
NET  
LOSW  
BER  
LOS  
BER  
LINE  
LINE  
Following the successful completion of self-test diagnostics,  
the front panel LEDs will appear as follows:  
V -  
V -  
I-  
I-  
STATUS - Green to indicate that self-test diagnostics were  
successfully completed.  
V+  
V+  
I+  
I+  
RESET  
LPBK - Off  
NET/LOS - Red to indicate that the network DS1 signal is  
not being received by the RLX.  
LINE/LOS - Red to indicate that the line DS1 signal is not  
being received by the RLX.  
A2 RLX  
Version B RLX  
7392-B  
Figure 525-5. RLX Initial Start-Up Test  
2-86  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-526  
Page 1 of 2  
CRAFT INTERFACE SYSTEM LOGON  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for logon to the Craft Interface system. Logging  
on consists of connecting the control terminal or host computer to the Soneplex Broadband  
chassis, entering the communication rate, user name and password, then setting the serial port  
configuration.  
1. Connect chassis to control terminal or host computer.  
Reference: DLP-504 Local Craft Interface Connection  
2. Locate power switch on terminal or computer and turn power on. Press Enter or Return. If  
using a computer, enter the communications software package resident on the computer.  
3. At the Enter User Name field on the Logon screen (Figure 526-1), enter assigned User  
Name. If no User Name is assigned yet, enter SONEPLEX (uppercase only). Press Enter or  
Return.  
4. The Craft Interface requests a password. Enter your assigned password or, if the  
SONEPLEX user name was used in Step 3, enter SONEPLEX1 (uppercase only). Press  
Enter or Return.  
5. The welcome message and Main Menu (Figure 526-2) should now be displayed on your  
screen. The welcome message includes the current software version number and a  
copyright insignia.  
6. If this is your initial use of the Craft Interface System, or if you are changing  
communication device parameter settings, perform the Serial Port Configuration procedure.  
Otherwise, proceed to Step 7.  
Note: Make the initial Craft Interface connection to the Craft port on the front of the  
MPU. Initial communication parameter settings for this port are: 9600 baud, no parity, 8  
data bits, 1 stop bit.  
Reference: DLP-549 Serial Port Configuration  
Note: Changes to port configurations take effect when you log off and then log back on  
to the system.  
Reference: DLP-564 Craft Interface System Logoff  
7. Use the arrow or number keys to select a sub-menu. After selecting a sub-menu, press Enter  
or Return to move to the menu you have selected.  
Note: The second line from the bottom of the screen displays any sub-menus available in  
the selection that is highlighted.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-87  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-526  
Page 2 of 2  
Welcome to ADC: SONEPLEX Shelf Interface Version 5.1.2  
(C) Copyright 1997 ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Enter User Name:  
10454-A  
Figure 526-1. Craft Interface Logon Screen  
Welcome to ADC: SONEPLEX Shelf Interface Version 5.1.2  
(C) Copyright 1997 ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
SONEPLEX MAIN MENU  
1. Alarms  
2. Display Status  
3. Unit Configuration  
4. System Administration  
5. System Configuration  
6. System Maintenance  
7. Performance Monitoring  
Display Shelf, MUX, ODS2, QLX, HLX, DLX, RLX Status  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6659-D  
Figure 526-2. Craft Interface Main Menu  
2-88  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-527  
Page 1 of 1  
ALARM HISTORY CLEARANCE COMMAND  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for clearing alarm history and all active alarms  
for the entire system.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Clear Alarm History from the Alarms menu.  
2. At the Clear Alarm History selection prompt, press Enter or Return. The system displays  
the following message (also shown in Figure 527-1):  
Deleting all ALARM HISTORY. . .  
Are You Sure? (y/n)  
3. Clear all alarm history by pressing Y for yes, or cancel clear alarm history by pressing N  
for no.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
ALARMS MENU  
1. Display Active Alarms  
2. Display Alarm Summary  
3. Display Alarm History  
4. Clear Alarm History  
5.  
vel  
6. Deleting all ALARM HISTORY...  
Are You Sure? (y/n)  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
5314-A  
Figure 527-1. Delete Alarm History Query  
2-89  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-528  
Page 1 of 2  
SYSTEM TID/DATE/TIME SETTING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for setting the Craft Interface system internal  
time and date clock; and entering the Target Identifier (TID). Time and date must be set when  
the system is first installed or if there is a change in time. Also, each Soneplex Broadband  
chassis requires a unique identification name or number, called the TID.  
Note: A togglefield type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the Rkey to view and select the  
previous option. An inputfield type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A fixedfield is locked, and cannot be changed  
by the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the Rkey to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message Configuration SuccessfulPress Any  
Key To Continueappears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys or number keys to select the System Configuration menu from the Main  
Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys or number keys to select the System TID/Date/Time screen. Press Enter  
or Return. The System TID/Date/Time screen should appear. See Figure 528-1.  
3. Move the cursor to the TID field and type the TID.  
Note: The TID label can be 1 to 20 characters with no spaces or periods allowed. Only  
ASCII alpha, numeric, or hyphen characters are allowed. The first character must be an  
alpha character; middle characters can be alpha, numeric, or hyphens; and the last  
character must be either alpha or numeric. If a TID of more than 20 characters is entered,  
all characters after the twentieth are cut off. The TID should be changed only when  
necessary. The current TID is shown on the System Configuration menu.  
4. Use the arrow keys to move the cursor to the Date field. Enter the two-digit number for the  
month and press the right arrow key. Enter the two-digit number for the date and press the  
right arrow key. Enter the two-digit number for the year and press the right arrow key.  
2-90  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-528  
Page 2 of 2  
5. Move the cursor to the Time field. Enter 00 to 23 for the hour and press the right arrow key.  
Enter 00 to 59 for the minutes. The Time field is updated each time the screen is refreshed.  
6. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
SYSTEM TID/DATE/TIME  
TID: ADC  
Date: 06/05/04  
Time: 00:11  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6121-B  
Figure 528-1. System TID/Date/Time Screen (Typical)  
2-91  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-529  
Page 1 of 4  
DS3 MUX CONFIGURATION  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for equipping each DS3 MUX as required, set  
its service state, and set its protect status.  
Note: A togglefield type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the Rkey to view and select the  
previous option. An inputfield type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A fixedfield is locked, and cannot be changed  
by the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the Rkey to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits in the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message Configuration SuccessfulPress Any Key  
To Continueappears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. C1 or D1 DS3 MUX only: Refer to Table 529-1 for DIP switch settings for the C1 or D1  
DS3 MUX, and DS3 CAM (Communications Channel Access Module) channels. Channels  
2, 5, 6, and 7 are available on both the DS3 MUX and the DS3 CAM for communication  
between the central office chassis and the remote control chassis. Although the DS3 MUX  
and the DS3 CAM both have the same channels, please note that their switch settings are  
different.  
Refer to Figure 529-1 for a detailed drawing of the switch. When a C1 or D1 DS3 MUX is  
used with a DS3 Soneplex Remote Control system, the DIP switches on the DS3 MUX  
board must be set to the correct communications channel. To assure proper operation, the  
same channel must be selected on the DS3 MUX as well as on the DS3 CAM installed in  
the remote control chassis. Figure 529-2 shows the location of the switch on the DS3 MUX.  
Note: For more information on the D1 DS3 MUX, refer to the Soneplex D1 DS3 MUX  
Installation Instructions manual, which is listed under Related Publications at the  
beginning of this manual.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Unit Configuration from the Main Menu. Press Enter or  
Return. The Unit Configuration menu appears, as shown in Figure 529-3.  
3. Use the arrow keys or number keys to select MUX Configuration from the Unit  
Configuration menu. Press Enter or Return. A DS3 MUX Configuration screen is shown in  
Figure 529-4.  
2-92  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-529  
Page 2 of 4  
4. Starting at the top of Table 529-2 and working your way to the bottom, configure the DS3  
MUX fields.  
5. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
Table 529-1. C1 and D1 DS3 MUX and DS3 CAM  
DIP Switch Settings for DS3 Soneplex Remote Control System  
C1 AND D1 DS3 MUX SWITCH  
2
DS3 CAM SWITCH  
2
CHANNEL  
1
3
1
3
7
6
5
2
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
OPEN  
OPEN  
OPEN  
CLOSED  
OPEN  
OPEN  
OPEN  
CLOSED  
OPEN  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
OPEN  
CLOSED  
CLOSED  
CLOSED  
CLOSED  
CLOSED  
CLOSED  
Note: The default setting is channel 7 for both the C1 and D1 DS3 MUX and the DS3 CAM.  
Note: The CLOSED/OPEN position indicates that the switch is depressed in that direction.  
D
S
3
CLOSED  
(ON)  
M
U
X
ON  
OFF  
STATUS  
LPBK  
3
2
ENABLE  
ONLINE  
1
DS3 FAIL  
OPEN  
APS  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
LMPTST/  
APS  
RESET  
OPEN  
(OFF)  
1
2
3
All switches shown are in the OFF position.  
OPEN  
10509-A  
7902-A  
Figure 529-1. C1 and D1 DS3  
MUX DIP Switch Detail  
Figure 529-2. C1 and D1 DS3 MUX Channel  
Selection DIP Switch Location  
2-93  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-529  
Page 3 of 4  
UNIT CONFIGURATION  
1. MUX Configuration  
2. ODS2 Configuration  
3. QLX Configuration  
4. HLX Configuration  
5. DLX Configuration  
6. RLX Configuration  
Display/Edit All MUX Configuration Parameters  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
8105-B  
Figure 529-3. Unit Configuration Menu  
DS3MUX CONFIGURATION  
Unit Equip State  
Unit Service State  
MUX Protect Status  
: EQUIPPED  
: OUT OF SERVICE  
: UNPROTECTED  
Facility Service State: OUT OF SERVICE  
Transmit LBO Setting : IN  
DS1 Loopback Mode  
: C-BIT  
DS3 Framing Format Status (Display Only): M13  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6660-C  
Figure 529-4. DS3 MUX Configuration Screen  
2-94  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-529  
Page 4 of 4  
Table 529-2. DS3 MUX Configuration Fields  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
Equipped  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
Unit Equipment Toggle  
State  
Sets all other fields to default values,  
UNEQUIPPED  
establishes communication with the MPU,  
and allows the MPU to process equipment  
alarms. Module must be set to EQUIPPED  
before remaining selections are allowed.  
UNEQUIPPED  
IN SERVICE  
No communication with the MPU.  
Unit Service  
State  
Toggle  
Toggle  
Places the unit in service and allows  
equipment alarm reporting by the MPU.  
Must be set to IS for reporting of equipment  
alarms.  
OUT OF SERVICE  
OUT OF  
SERVICE  
Removes the unit from service and stops  
equipment alarm reporting by the MPU.  
MUX Protect  
Status  
Protected  
Designates that equipment APS is available. UNPROTECTED  
UNPROTECTED Designates that equipment APS is not  
available.  
Facility Service Toggle  
State  
IN SERVICE  
Allows facility alarm reporting by the MPU. OUT OF SERVICE  
Must be set to IS for reporting of facility  
alarms.  
OUT OF  
Stops facility alarm reporting by the MPU.  
SERVICE  
Transmit LBO Toggle  
Setting  
IN  
Inserts a Line Build Out (LBO) equivalent to IN  
0 to 224 feet.  
OUT  
C-bit  
Inserts a 225 to 450 ft. LBO in the DS3  
circuit.  
DS1 Loopback Toggle  
Mode*  
A type of stuff indicator bit based on TR-  
TSY-000009. A C-bit is used to provide a  
loopback signal.  
C-BIT  
S-bit  
A type of stuff indicator bit invented by  
NEC. An S-bit is used to provide a loopback  
signal.  
FEAC  
FEAC (Far End Alarm and Control) is a 16-  
bit code based on GR-499-CORE used to  
send alarm or status information.  
DS3 Framing  
Format Status only  
Display M13 or C-bit  
This field displays what DS3 path framing  
format has been detected. Paths with the  
M13 format have their performance  
monitored for near-end transmissions; paths  
with C-Bit Parity format have their  
performance monitored for both near- and  
far-end transmissions.  
None  
* Note: The loopback type configured in this field involves the DS3 MUX only.  
2-95  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-530  
Page 1 of 3  
ODS2 MODULE CONFIGURATION  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for establishing initial ODS2 configurations,  
viewing, and/or editing existing ODS2 configurations for each ODS2 module in the Soneplex  
Broadband system.  
Note: A togglefield type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the Rkey to view and select the  
previous option. An inputfield type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A fixedfield is locked, and cannot be changed  
by the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the Rkey to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message Configuration SuccessfulPress Any  
Key To Continueappears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Unit Configuration from the Main Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select ODS2 Configuration from the Unit Configuration menu. Press  
Enter or Return. An ODS2 Configuration screen is shown in Figure 530-1.  
3. Starting at the top of Table 530-1 and working your way to the bottom, configure the ODS2  
for the group and slot selected.  
4. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
5. Repeat Steps 2 through 4 for each ODS2 module installed in the chassis.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-96  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-530  
Page 2 of 3  
ODS2 CONFIGURATION  
Group: 3  
Unit Equip State : EQUIPPED  
Unit Service State: IS  
Unit Protect State: UNPROTECTED  
T2 Service State : IS  
BER Alarm Thresh: 1E-8  
BER Switch Thresh: 1E-6  
T1  
Service Line  
PARAMETERS Provision State  
Code Circuit ID  
========= ======= ==== ====================  
T1 #1:  
T1 #2:  
T1 #3:  
T1 #4:  
YES  
YES  
YES  
YES  
OOS  
OOS  
OOS  
OOS  
AMI  
AMI  
AMI  
AMI  
T1  
Remote Pulse Remote  
Remote PPS  
PARAMETERS Equalization Frame Format Threshold  
=========== ============ =============  
T1 #1: N/A  
T1 #2: N/A  
T1 #3: N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
T1 #4: N/A  
Remote Housekeeping Labels:  
Working Card  
Protect Card  
HSKP1: RMT-HSKP1  
HSKP1: N/A  
HSKP2: RMT-HSKP2  
HSKP2: N/A  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
8110-C  
Figure 530-1. ODS2 Configuration Screen  
Table 530-1. ODS2 Configuration Fields  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
Group  
Toggle 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7  
Specifies the modules group number  
1
designated on the chassis.  
Unit Equipment  
State  
Toggle Equipped  
Establishes communication with MPU. Module UNEQUIPPED  
must be set to EQUIPPED before remaining  
selections are allowed. Sets all other fields to  
default values and allows MPU to process  
equipment alarms.  
UNEQUIPPED  
No communication with MPU.  
Unit Service State  
Unit Protect State  
Toggle IS (In-Service)  
Places the unit in service and allows equipment OOS  
alarm reporting by the MPU. Must be set to IS  
for reporting of equipment alarms.  
OOS (Out-Of-Service)  
Removes unit from service and stops equipment  
alarm reporting by the MPU.  
Toggle PROTECTED  
UNPROTECTED  
Designates that equipment APS is available.  
Designates that equipment APS is not available.  
UNPROTECTED  
(continued)  
2-97  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-530  
Page 3 of 3  
Table 530-1. ODS2 Configuration Fields, continued  
OPTIONS DESCRIPTION  
FIELD  
TYPE  
DEFAULT  
T2 Service State  
Toggle Leave this field at OOS at this time to avoid undesirable reporting of alarms. OOS  
Select IS after completing the remaining configurations.  
8  
BER Alarm  
Threshold  
Toggle Set to OFF or set between The average Bit Error Ratios of both the  
10  
6  
10  
10 and 10  
incoming optical signals are monitored by the  
ODS2. By monitoring BERs, the ODS2 is  
capable of triggering a minor alarm when any of  
the monitored signals degrades below the BER  
threshold level.  
4  
6  
BER Switch  
Threshold  
Toggle Set between 10 and 10  
10  
This sets the threshold at which the APS will be 10  
executed.  
Provision  
Toggle YES  
Brings up T1 default settings and allows  
configuration changes.  
NO  
(set for each T1)  
T1 Service State  
NO  
Facility not provisioned.  
Toggle Leave this field at OOS at this time to avoid undesirable reporting of alarms. OOS  
Select IS after completing the remaining configurations.  
Line Code  
Toggle AMI  
B8ZS  
Alternate Mark Inversion  
AMI  
(set for each T1)  
Circuit Identifier  
Bipolar Eight-Zero Substitution  
Input  
Enter up to 20 characters  
or leave blank.  
Use alphanumeric characters; embedded  
hyphens are allowed.  
None  
(set for each T1)  
Remote Pulse  
Equalization  
Toggle 0133 ft., 133226 ft.,  
226399 ft., 399533 ft.,  
533655 ft., or NOT  
APPL.  
The DS1 signal output provides standard DSX 0133 ft.  
signal levels which can be compensated for at  
various distances (i.e., cable length).  
Remote Frame  
Format  
Fixed  
Locked at NOT APPL.  
NOT APPL  
NOT APPL  
Remote PPS (Path  
Protection Switch)  
Threshold  
Fixed  
Locked at NOT APPL.  
T2 Service State  
Toggle IS (In-Service)  
Places facility in service and allows T2 alarm  
reporting by the MPU.  
OOS  
OOS  
OOS (Out-Of-Service)  
Removes facility from service and stops T2  
alarm reporting by the MPU.  
T1 Service State (set Toggle IS (In-Service)  
for each T1)  
Places facility in service and allows T1 alarm  
reporting by the MPU.  
OOS (Out-Of-Service)  
Removes facility from service and stops T1  
alarm reporting by the MPU.  
2-98  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-531  
Page 1 of 7  
HLX CONFIGURATION  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for using this menu to view or edit the  
configuration for each HLX module in the chassis. This menu can also be used to equip,  
provision, assign thresholds, and assign service state.  
Note: A togglefield type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the Rkey to view and select the  
previous option. An inputfield type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A fixedfield is locked, and cannot be changed  
by the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the Rkey to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message Configuration SuccessfulPress Any  
Key To Continueappears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys or number keys to select Unit Configuration from the Main Menu. Press  
Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys or number keys to select HLX Configuration from the Unit  
Configuration menu. Press Enter or Return. The HLX Configuration menu is shown in  
Figure 531-1.  
3. Select HLX Unit Configuration from the HLX Configuration menu. Press Enter or Return.  
The HLX Unit Configuration menu is shown in Figure 531-2.  
4. Starting at the top of Table 531-1 and working your way to the bottom, configure the  
HLXC for the group and slot selected.  
5. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
6. Repeat Steps 4 through 5 for each HLXC module installed in the chassis.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-99  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-531  
Page 2 of 7  
HLX CONFIGURATION  
1. HLX Unit Configuration  
2. Loopback Configuration  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
Figure 531-1. HLX Configuration Menu  
HLX UNIT CONFIGURATION  
6661-A  
Group: 6  
Slot: 1  
Circuit ID:  
Unit Equip State : EQUIPPED  
Unit Service State: IS  
Loop Power Setting: ENABLED  
Loop 2 Operation : ENABLED  
Half AIS Feature : ENABLED  
HDSL Service State: IS  
T1 Provision  
: YES  
T1 Service State : OOS  
T1 Framing Format : AUTO-UNFRAMED  
T1 BER Threshold : 1E-7  
HLXC T1 Line Code : NOT APPL  
HDSL BER Threshold: 1E-7  
HDSL SNR Threshold: +5  
HDSL PA Threshold : +33  
dB  
dB  
HLXC DSX-1 EQ  
HLXR T1 Line Code : AUTO-AMI  
: NOT APPL  
Network DS1 Source: NOT APPL  
Network Keep Alive: AIS  
HLXR LBO Setting : UNIT SWITCH  
HLXR Simplex Power: NOT APPL  
DS0 Channel:  
(B = blocked)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Blocked Channel Pattern: 11111111  
Remote HSKP Labels: HSKP1: RMT-HSKP1  
HSKP2: RMPT-HSKP2  
User Notes  
:
HLXC Switch Settings - DSX-1 EQ  
HLXR Switch Settings - Simplex Power : NOT APPL  
: NOT APPL  
Loop Power: NOT APPL  
Loop 2 Op : NOT APPL  
LBO : 0.0 db  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
9818-A  
Figure 531-2. HLXC Unit Configuration Screen  
2-100  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-531  
Page 3 of 7  
Table 531-1. HLXC Configuration Fields  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
Group  
Slot  
Toggle  
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7  
Specifies the modules group number designated  
1
1
on the chassis.  
Toggle  
Input  
1, 2, 3, or 4  
Specifies the modules slot number within the  
group number designated on the chassis.  
Circuit Identifier  
Unit Equip State  
Enter up to 20  
characters.  
This represents the customers circuit ID. The first Blank  
character must be alpha or numeric; middle  
characters can be alpha, numeric, or hyphens; and  
the last character must be either alpha or numeric.  
Note: This field can be configured only after the  
T1 Provision field (described below) is set to YES.  
Toggle  
Equipped  
Establishes communication with MPU. Module  
must be set to EQUIPPED before remaining  
selections are allowed.  
UNEQUIPPED  
UNEQUIPPED  
No communication with MPU.  
Unit Service State  
T1 Provision  
Toggle  
Toggle  
Leave this field at OOS at this time to avoid undesirable reporting of alarms. Set this field to  
IS after completing the configuration of the remaining fields.  
YES  
Brings up T1 default settings and allows  
configuration changes.  
NO  
NO  
No configuration changes allowed.  
T1 Service State  
Toggle  
Toggle  
Leave this field at OOS at this time to avoid undesirable reporting of alarms. Set this field to  
IS after completing the configuration of the remaining fields.  
T1 Framing Format  
AUTO  
The system automatically detects and establishes  
the current frame format (UNFRAMED, FT  
ONLY, SF, or ESF). It then displays AUTO-" and  
the frame format.  
AUTO  
UNFRAMED  
Ft ONLY  
SF  
Unframed data pattern.  
Used for SLC framing.  
Super Frame  
ESF  
Extended Super Frame  
-3  
-9  
-7  
T1 BER Threshold  
Toggle  
From 10 to 10  
The average Bit Error Ratios of the incoming DS1 10  
signals are monitored by the HLXC. By  
monitoring BERs, the HLXC is capable of  
triggering an alarm when any of the monitored  
signals degrades below the BER threshold level.  
HLXC T1 Line Code Fixed  
HLXC DSX-1 EQ* Fixed  
Locked at NOT APPL.  
Locked at NOT APPL.  
*Note: HLXC and HLXR Switch Settings (HLXC DSX-1 EQ, HLXR LBO, Loop Power, Loop 2 Operation, and HLXR Simplex  
Power) of the module being configured are displayed at the bottom of the screen.  
(continued)  
2-101  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-531  
Page 4 of 7  
Table 531-1. HLXC Configuration Fields, continued  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
Alternate Mark Inversion  
DEFAULT  
AMI  
HLXR T1 Line Code Toggle  
AMI  
B8ZS  
Bipolar Eight-Zero Substitution  
AUTO  
Specifies that the T1 line code transmitted by the  
HLXR will match the line code received by the  
HLXR.  
HLXR LBO Setting* Toggle  
Loop Power Setting* Toggle  
UNIT SWITCH  
Defaults to the Line Buildout hardware  
configuration settings on the HLXR.  
Version C HLXC:  
UNIT SWITCH  
0.0 dB, 7.5 dB, 15.0 Sets the LBO in decibels for the HLXR.  
dB, or 22.5 dB  
Version E and  
Version D HLXC:  
0.0 dB  
UNIT SWITCH  
Defaults to the Loop Power hardware  
Version C HLXC:  
UNIT SWITCH  
Version E and  
Version D HLXC:  
ENABLED  
configuration settings on the Version C HLXC  
only. Refer to DLP 516 for more information  
about the Version C HLXCs unit switch.  
ENABLED  
When loop powering is on and an HRX is not  
connected to the HLXC, 130 VDC span power is  
supplied over the HDSL loops by the HLXC.  
When loop powering is on and an HRX is  
connected to the HLXC, 130 VDC power is  
supplied over the HDSL loops. ENABLED must  
be selected if an HRX is used.  
DISABLED  
No loop power is supplied. A D1 HLXR is the  
only HLXR with a local powering option. All  
other HLXR modules must be loop powered.  
Loop 2 Operation*  
Toggle  
UNIT SWITCH  
ENABLED  
Defaults to the Loop 2 hardware configuration  
settings on the Version C HLXC.  
Version C HLXC:  
UNIT SWITCH  
Channels 1 - 12 are transmitted on Loop 1 and  
channels 13 - 24 are transmitted on Loop 2.  
Version E and  
Version D HLXC:  
ENABLED  
DISABLED  
Single-loop operation is enabled by blocking 12 of  
the 24 DS0 channels (13 - 24) within the DS1  
signal. Single-loop operation is used primarily  
when only one loop is available to provide service.  
*Note: HLXC and HLXR Switch Settings (HLXC DSX-1 EQ, HLXR LBO, Loop Power, Loop 2 Operation, and HLXR Simplex  
Power) of the module being configured are displayed at the bottom of the screen.  
Note: The Version D and later HLXC module can be provisioned to provide fractional T1 service by deactivating one of the  
HDSL loops (Loop 2) or by selectively blocking specified channels. See the DS0 Channel and Blocked Channel Pattern fields.  
(continued)  
2-102  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-531  
Page 5 of 7  
Table 531-1. HLXC Configuration Fields, continued  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
ENABLED  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
Half AIS Feature  
Toggle  
This selection activates the Half AIS mode. An  
Alarm Indication Signal (all 1s) is generated on  
the outgoing DS1 path only when both HDSL  
loops are in a LOSW (Loss of Synch Word) state.  
In Half AIS mode when only one HDSL loop is in  
a LOSW state, the transmitted DS1 signal will  
continue to the payload containing transparent  
data in the 12 channels related to the operating  
loop. An all 1s pattern will fill the remaining 12  
channels associated with the loop in the LOSW  
state.  
DISABLED  
DISABLED  
This selection activates the Full AIS mode. An  
AIS signal is generated on the outgoing DS1 path  
whenever either one or both HDSL loops are in a  
LOSW state.  
HDSL Service State  
Toggle  
Toggle  
IS (In-Service)  
Allows HDSL alarms to be reported to the MPU,  
and enables HDSL PM data collection. Must be set  
to IS for reporting of equipment alarms.  
OOS  
OOS (Out-Of-  
Service)  
No HDSL alarms are reported to the MPU.  
-7  
HDSL BER  
Threshold  
Enter a number from The average Bit Error Ratios of the incoming  
10  
-4  
-9  
10 to 10  
HDSL signals are monitored by the HLXC. By  
monitoring BERs, the HLXC is capable of  
triggering a minor alarm when any of the  
monitored signals degrades below the BER  
threshold level.  
HDSL SNR  
Threshold  
Toggle  
Enter a number from The lowest Signal-to-Noise Ratio allowed on the  
+5 dB  
10 dB to  
HDSL loop before an alarm is triggered.  
+30 dB  
HDSL PA Threshold Toggle  
Network DS1 Source Toggle  
Enter a number from The highest Pulse Attenuation value allowed on  
+33 dB  
+1 dB to  
+40 dB  
the HDSL loop before an alarm is triggered.  
NRZ  
This tells the Craft that the network DS1 source is NRZ  
at the backplane from the DS3 MUX.  
BIPOLAR  
This tells the Craft that network DS1 source is at  
the Extender Card interface. If you select this  
option when you are not using an Extender Card,  
you will cut off the DS1 signal. See Section 4 of  
this manual for information about the Extender  
Card.  
(continued)  
2-103  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-531  
Page 6 of 7  
Table 531-1. HLXC Configuration Fields, continued  
OPTIONS DESCRIPTION  
FIELD  
TYPE  
DEFAULT  
Network Keep Alive Toggle  
D2 HLXR only: AIS If the system detects a LOS (Loss of Signal) from AIS  
the customer, an AIS or customer disconnect  
indication (DS1 Idle Code) is sent to the network.  
An AIS is sent if UNFRAMED is selected in the  
T1 Framing Format field. A DS1 Idle Code is sent  
if a framed format (Ft, SF or ESF) is selected in  
the T1 Framing Format field.  
All other HLXRs:  
AIS  
If the system detects a LOS (Loss of Signal) from  
the customer, an AIS is sent to the network.  
LOOPBACK  
DS1 CUTOFF  
UNIT SWITCH  
If the system detects a LOS from the customer, the  
signal is automatically looped back towards the  
network.  
If the system detects a LOS from the customer, the  
signal is cut off and no pattern is transmitted to the  
network.  
HLXR Simplex  
Power* (D1/D2/D2A-  
SP/D3/ D3A HLXR  
only)  
Toggle  
Defaults to the simplex power hardware  
UNIT SWITCH  
(NOT APPL for  
configuration setting on the HLXR. Refer to the  
Soneplex Version D and Version E HLXR Remote D2A, D4, E4, F4,  
System Operation and Maintenance Manual, listed or G4 HLXR)  
under Related Publications at the beginning of this  
manual, for more information.  
ENABLED  
A 60 mA constant current is applied to the DS1  
terminals for powering NIDs or CSUs. Overrides  
the hardware setting on the HLXR.  
DISABLED  
Turns simplex power off. Overrides the hardware  
setting on the HLXR.  
DS0 Channel  
Input  
Enter Bfor DS0  
Blocking a channel causes the channel blocking  
Blank  
Channel blocking or pattern to be transmitted in both directions on the  
leave blank for  
normal operation for  
each of the 24 DS0  
channels.  
selected channel.  
Versions D, E, and G Input  
HLXC: Blocked  
Channel Pattern  
Enter an eight-bit  
Enter the pattern you want to use to block the  
Blank (Version C  
HLXC is fixed at  
an all 1s pattern  
and is not  
programmable code channels you selected in the DS0 Channel field.  
consisting of 1s and  
0s.  
configurable)  
Remote  
Input  
Enter up to 8  
alphanumeric  
characters.  
These fields can be edited to create customized  
labels. When a housekeeping alarm (door ajar, water  
on the floor, fire alarm, etc.) occurs, the name  
assigned is displayed in the condition column of the  
Alarm History and Active Alarms screens.  
Blank  
Housekeeping Labels  
*Note: HLXC and HLXR Switch Settings (HLXC DSX-1 EQ, HLXR LBO, Loop Power, Loop 2 Operation, and HLXR Simplex  
Power) of the module being configured are displayed at the bottom of the screen.  
(continued)  
2-104  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-531  
Page 7 of 7  
Table 531-1. HLXC Configuration Fields, continued  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
OOS  
Unit Service State  
Toggle  
IS (In-Service)  
Places the unit in service and allows equipment  
alarm reporting by the MPU. Must be set to IS for  
reporting of equipment alarms.  
OOS (Out-Of-  
Service)  
Removes unit from service and stops equipment  
alarm reporting by the MPU.  
T1 Service State  
Toggle  
Input  
IS (In-Service)  
Places facility in service and allows T1 alarm  
reporting by the MPU, and enables DS1 PM data  
collection.  
OOS  
OOS (Out-Of-  
Service)  
Removes facility from service and stops alarm  
reporting by the MPU.  
User Notes  
Enter up to 30  
alphanumeric  
characters.  
Enter additional information in the space provided. Blank  
Note: HLXC Switch and HLXR Switch Setting fields display the switch settings of the module being configured.  
2-105  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-532  
Page 1 of 3  
DLX CONFIGURATION  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for establishing initial configuration of DLX  
module(s) or view and/or edit the configurations for each DLX module in the Soneplex  
Broadband system. Equip, provision, assign thresholds as required, and assign service state.  
Note: A togglefield type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the Rkey to view and select the  
previous option. An inputfield type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A fixedfield is locked, and cannot be changed  
by the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the Rkey to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message Configuration SuccessfulPress Any  
Key To Continueappears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys or number keys to select Unit Configuration from the Main Menu. Press  
Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select DLX Configuration from the Unit Configuration menu. Press  
Enter or Return. A DLX Configuration menu is shown in Figure 532-1.  
3. Starting at the top of Table 532-1 and working your way to the bottom, configure the DLX.  
4. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
5. Repeat Steps 3 and 4 for each DLX module installed in the chassis.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-106  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-532  
Page 2 of 3  
DLX CONFIGURATION  
Group: 5  
Slot: 1  
Unit Equip State: EQUIPPED  
Unit Service State: IS  
T1 Provision: YES  
T1 Service State: OOS  
T1 Line Code: AMI  
Pulse Equalization: 0-133 FT.  
T1 BER Threshold: 1E-7  
Loopback Timeout Period: 0  
Circuit ID:  
minutes  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6126-C  
Figure 532-1. DLX Configuration Screen  
Table 532-1. DLX Configuration Fields  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
Group  
Toggle  
Specifies the modules group  
1
1
number designated on the chassis.  
Slot  
Toggle  
1, 2, 3, or 4  
Equipped  
Specifies the modules slot number  
designated on the chassis. Refer to  
TAD-106 (Access Identifier).  
Unit Equip State Toggle  
Unit Service State Toggle  
Establishes communication with  
MPU. Module must be set to  
EQUIPPED before remaining  
selections are allowed.  
UNEQUIPPED  
Unequipped  
No communication with MPU.  
IS (In-Service)  
Places the unit in service. This field OOS  
must be set to IS for reporting of  
equipment alarms.  
OOS (Out-Of-Service)  
Removes unit from service and  
stops equipment alarm reporting by  
the MPU.  
(continued)  
2-107  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-532  
Page 3 of 3  
Table 533-1. DLX Configuration Fields, continued  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
T1 Provision  
Toggle  
YES  
NO  
Brings up T1 default settings and  
allows configuration changes.  
NO  
Prevents configuration settings.  
T1 Service State  
T1 Line Code  
Toggle  
Toggle  
Leave this field at OOS at this time to avoid undesirable reporting of alarms. Place the circuit In-  
Service after complete the remaining configurations.  
AMI  
Alternate Mark Inversion  
AMI  
B8ZS  
Bipolar Eight-Zero Substitution  
Pulse Equalization Toggle  
0133 ft., 133266 ft.,  
266399 ft., 399533 ft., or  
533655 ft.  
The DS1 signal output provides  
standard DSX signal levels which  
can be compensated for various  
distances.  
0133 ft.  
-7  
T1 BER  
Toggle  
Input  
T1 BER Threshold can be set between When the Bit Error Rate threshold 10  
-3  
-9  
Threshold  
10 and 10  
.
is exceeded, an alarm is triggered.  
Loopback  
Enter a number from 0 to 255.  
This field represents the number of 30  
minutes that the loopback remains  
in effect before reverting to the  
normal (non-loopback) state.  
Setting the loopback time-out  
period to 0 disables the time-out  
feature.  
Timeout Period  
Circuit Identifier Input  
Up to 20 characters.  
This represents the customers  
circuit ID. The first and last  
characters must be alpha or  
numeric; middle characters can be  
alpha, numeric or hyphens.  
None  
T1 Service State  
Toggle  
IS (In-Service)  
Allows T1 alarms to be reported to OOS  
the MPU.  
OOS (Out-Of-Service)  
Prevents T1 alarms from being  
reported to the MPU.  
2-108  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-533  
Page 1 of 5  
RLXIOR CONFIGURATION  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for configuring the RLXIOR module. The  
RLXIOR configuration process assumes that the MPU is installed and the Craft Interface is  
operating. Configure each RLXIOR module in the Soneplex Broadband/Loop Extender system.  
Equip, provision, assign thresholds as required, and assign service state.  
Note: A togglefield type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the Rkey to view and select the  
previous option. An inputfield type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A fixedfield is locked, and cannot be changed  
by the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the Rkey to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Log on to the Craft Interface. The Main Menu appears.  
2. Use the arrow keys or number keys to select Unit Configuration from the Main Menu. Press  
Enter or Return.  
3. Use the arrow keys to select RLX Configuration from the Unit Configuration menu. Press  
Enter or Return. The RLX Configuration screen appears, as shown in Figure 533-1.  
Note: The RLXIOR is displayed as RLXin the Craft Interface menus and screens.  
4. Starting at the top of Table 533-1 and working your way to the bottom, configure the  
RLXIOR.  
5. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
6. Repeat Steps 4 and 5 for each RLXIOR module installed in the chassis.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-109  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-533  
Page 2 of 5  
RLX CONFIGURATION  
Group: 1  
Slot: 1  
Circuit ID:  
Unit Equip State : EQUIPPED  
Unit Service State: OOS  
Pulse Equalization  
LBO Setting  
Programmable Loopback  
NID Loopback  
: NOT APPL  
: UNIT SWITCH  
: DISABLED  
: ENABLED  
T1 Provision  
: YES  
T1 Service State : OOS  
Line Code  
Framing Format  
Network DS1 Source: NRZ  
BER Threshold : 1E-7  
Span Power Setting: ENABLED  
: AMI  
: AUTO  
Loopback Activation Code : 1101001111010011  
Loopback Deactivate Code : 1001001110010011  
Lpbk Timeout Disable Code: 1101010111010110  
Loopback Timeout Period : 0  
Network Keep Alive : AIS  
minutes  
DS0 Channel  
(B = blocked)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Unit Switch Settings: Pulse Equalization: NOT APPL  
NID: DISABLED  
Span Power: DISABLED  
LBO: 7.5 dB  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
11783-A  
Figure 533-1. RLX Configuration Screen (Broadband Chassis)  
Note: The Unit Service State field default is UNEQUIPPED and the T1 Provision field  
default is NO. When the Unit Service State field is set to EQUIPPED and the T1  
Provision field is set to YES, this screen shows all other field defaults, as above.  
Table 533-1. RLXIOR Configuration Fields  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT*  
Group  
Slot  
Toggle  
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7  
(groups 6 and 7 are not  
available in the 19-inch  
LEC chassis)  
Specifies the modules group number  
1
1
designated on the chassis.  
Toggle  
Input  
1, 2, 3, or 4  
Specifies the modules slot number in the  
group designated on the chassis.  
Circuit Identifier  
Enter up to 20 characters This represents the customers circuit ID.  
The first and last characters must be alpha or  
numeric; middle characters can be alpha,  
numeric, or hyphens.  
Blank  
Unit Equip State  
Toggle  
Equipped  
Establishes communication with the MPU.  
Module must be set to EQUIPPED before  
remaining selections are allowed.  
UNEQUIPPED  
Unequipped  
No communication with the MPU.  
*Note: The RLXIOR configuration field default values shown in this manual are valid for a system with an MPU installed.  
(continued)  
2-110  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-533  
Page 3 of 5  
Table 533-1. RLXIOR Configuration Fields, continued  
OPTIONS DESCRIPTION  
FIELD  
TYPE  
DEFAULT*  
Unit Service State  
Toggle  
Leave this field at OOS at this time to avoid undesirable reporting of alarms. Set this field to IS  
after completing the configuration of the remaining fields.  
T1 Provision  
Toggle  
YES  
Brings up T1 default settings and allows NO  
configuration changes.  
NO  
No configuration changes allowed.  
T1 Service State  
Line Code  
Toggle  
Toggle  
Leave this field at OOS at this time to avoid undesirable reporting of alarms. Set this field to IS  
after completing the configuration of the remaining fields, and after configuring the Unit Service  
State field.  
AUTO  
When the RLX line code is set to AUTO, AMI  
the module senses the line code and  
switches from AMI to B8ZS if an encoded  
signal is detected. After switching to  
B8ZS, the RLX stays locked in this line  
code until an LOS is detected at both DS1  
inputs.  
AMI  
Alternate Mark Inversion  
B8ZS  
AUTO  
Bipolar Eight-Zero Substitution  
Framing Format  
Toggle  
The system automatically detects,  
establishes, and displays AUTO-NR-”  
and the correct frame format  
AUTO  
(UNFRAMED, FT ONLY, SF, or ESF).  
UNFRAMED  
Ft ONLY  
SF  
Unframed data pattern  
Used for SLC framing  
Super Frame  
ESF  
Extended Super Frame  
Network DS1  
Source  
Toggle  
NRZ  
This tells the Craft that the network DS1  
source is at the backplane.  
NRZ (Broadband chassis  
only)  
BIPOLAR  
This tells the Craft that the network DS1  
BIPOLAR (locked field  
source is at the extender card interface. If in Loop Extender  
this option is selected and there is no  
extender card, the DS1 signal is cut off. In  
the Loop Extender chassis, this field is  
locked at BIPOLAR.  
chassis only)  
-3  
-9  
-7  
BER Threshold  
Toggle  
Range of 10 to 10  
The average Bit Error Ratios of both the  
incoming DS1 signals are monitored by  
the RLX. By monitoring BERs, the RLX  
is capable of triggering a minor alarm  
when any of the monitored signals  
10  
degrades below the BER threshold level.  
*Note: The RLXIOR configuration field default values shown in this manual are valid for a system with an MPU installed.  
(continued)  
2-111  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-533  
Page 4 of 5  
Table 533-1. RLXIOR Configuration Fields, continued  
FIELD  
Span Power  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT*  
ENABLED  
Toggle  
UNIT SWITCH  
Stops span power on the RLXIOR.  
Setting**  
ENABLED  
Enables span power using the on-board  
switch settings (130V or 130V). The  
default switch setting is 130V.  
DISABLED  
Stops span power on the RLXIOR.  
Pulse  
Toggle  
UNIT SWITCH  
Selecting this option on the RLXIOR  
UNIT SWITCH (Loop  
Extender chassis only)  
Equalization**  
creates a setting of 0133 ft.  
0133 ft., 133266 ft.,  
The DS1 signal output provides standard NOT APPL (locked field  
266399 ft., 399533 ft., DSX signal levels which can be  
in Broadband chassis  
only)  
or 533655 ft.  
compensated for various distances.  
LBO Setting**  
Toggle  
Toggle  
Toggle  
UNIT SWITCH  
Selecting this option on the RLXIOR  
creates a setting of 0.0 dB.  
UNIT SWITCH  
0.0 dB, 7.5 dB, 15.0 dB, Sets the LBO in decibels.  
or 22.5 dB  
Programmable  
Loopback  
ENABLED  
Enables response to programmable  
DISABLED  
loopback codes.  
DISABLED  
UNIT SWITCH  
Disables response to programmable  
loopback codes.  
NID Loopback**  
Disables loop-up response to NID arming ENABLED  
code. The loopback armed state transitions  
to "Armed" when the NID arming code is  
received.  
ENABLED  
DISABLED  
Enables response to NID loopback codes.  
Disables loop-up response to NID arming  
code. The loopback armed state transitions  
to "Armed" when the NID arming code is  
received.  
*Note: The RLXIOR configuration field default values shown in this manual are valid for systems with an MPU installed.  
**Note: Although unit switch settings (Pulse Equalization, Span Power, NID Loopback, and LBO) are shown at the bottom of the  
configuration screen, none of the displays are meaningful for the RLXIOR. First, there are no on-board switches for Pulse  
Equalization, NID Loopback, and LBO. In addition, although the RLXIOR has an on-board Line Power switch, the Span Power  
unit switch setting display is locked at DISABLED.  
(continued)  
2-112  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-533  
Page 5 of 5  
Table 533-1. RLXIOR Configuration Fields, continued  
OPTIONS DESCRIPTION  
FIELD  
Loopback  
TYPE  
Input  
DEFAULT*  
16 binary characters (0s These codes can be set to any 16-bit  
and 1s) must be entered. binary value except: all 0s, all 1s, or a  
value that is already used in another 16-bit  
code.  
1101 0011 1101 0011  
Activation Code  
The Loopback Activation Code signal is  
sent inband. RLX units go to loopup state  
when they are in armed state. Loopup is  
activated for selected units. Detection time  
is 3 secs.  
Loopback  
Input  
Input  
The signal is sent inband. Units in loopup 1001 0011 1001 0011  
state go back to armed state. Detection  
time is 5 secs.  
Deactivate Code  
Lpbk Timeout  
Disable Code  
This disables loopup time-out. Active  
loopbacks stay up until deactivation or  
disarm (NID Loop Down) code is  
received. Detection time is 3 secs.  
1101 0101 1101 0110  
Loopback Timeout Input  
Period  
Enter a number from 0 to This represents the minutes the loopback 0 minutes  
255.  
remains in effect before reverting to the  
non-loopback state. Setting the loopback  
time out period to 0 disables the time out  
feature.  
Network Keep  
Alive  
Toggle  
AIS  
If the system detects an LOS (Loss of  
Signal) from the customer, an AIS is sent  
to the network.  
AIS  
DS1 CUTOFF  
If the system detects an LOS from the  
customer, the signal is cut off and no  
signal is transmitted to the network.  
DS0 Channel  
Toggle  
Toggle  
B(for DS0 Channel  
blocking) or blank (for  
normal operation) for  
each of the 24 DS0  
channels.  
Blocking a channel causes the blocking  
pattern (FFhex or 7Fhex) set up via the  
onboard DIP switch to be transmitted in  
both directions.  
Blank  
OOS  
Unit Service State  
IS (In-Service)  
Places the unit in service and allows  
equipment alarm reporting by the MPU.  
Must be set to IS for reporting of  
equipment alarms.  
OOS (Out-Of-Service)  
IS (In-Service)  
Removes unit from service and stops  
equipment alarm reporting by the MPU.  
T1 Service State  
Toggle  
Places facility in service and allows T1  
alarm reporting by the MPU.  
OOS  
OOS (Out-Of-Service)  
Removes facility from service and stops  
alarm reporting by the MPU.  
*Note: The RLXIOR configuration field default values shown in this manual are valid for systems with an MPU installed.  
2-113  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-534  
Page 1 of 6  
RLX CONFIGURATION  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for establishing initial configuration of Version  
A RLX and Version B RLX (B1 RLX and B2 RLX+) modules, viewing, and/or editing the  
configurations for each RLX module in the Soneplex Broadband system.  
Note: A togglefield type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the Rkey to view and select the  
previous option. An inputfield type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A fixedfield is locked, and cannot be changed  
by the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the Rkey to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message Configuration SuccessfulPress Any  
Key To Continueappears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys or number keys to select Unit Configuration from the Main Menu. Press  
Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select RLX Configuration from the Unit Configuration menu. Press  
Enter or Return. An RLX Configuration menu is shown in Figure 534-1.  
3. Starting at the top of Table 534-1 and working your way to the bottom, configure the RLX  
fields for the group and slot selected.  
4. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
5. Repeat Steps 3 and 4 for each RLX module installed in the chassis.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-114  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-534  
Page 2 of 6  
RLX CONFIGURATION  
Group: 1  
Slot: 1  
Circuit ID:  
Unit Equip State : EQUIPPED  
Unit Service State: OOS  
Pulse Equalization  
LBO Setting  
Programmable Loopback  
NID Loopback  
: NOT APPL  
: UNIT SWITCH  
: DISABLED  
T1 Provision  
: YES  
T1 Service State : OOS  
: UNIT SWITCH  
Line Code  
Framing Format  
Network DS1 Source: NRZ  
BER Threshold : 1E-7  
Span Power Setting: UNIT SWITCH  
: AUTO  
: AUTO  
Loopback Activation Code : 1101001111010011  
Loopback Deactivate Code : 1001001110010011  
Lpbk Timeout Disable Code: 1101010111010110  
Loopback Timeout Period : 0  
Network Keep Alive : AIS  
minutes  
DS0 Channel  
(B = blocked)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
Unit Switch Settings: Pulse Equalization: NOT APPL  
NID: DISABLED  
Span Power: DISABLED  
LBO: 7.5 dB  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6127-C  
Figure 534-1. RLX Configuration Screen  
Table 534-1. RLX Configuration Fields  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
Group  
Slot  
Toggle  
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7  
Specifies the modules group number  
1
(groups 6 and 7 are not designated on the chassis.  
available in the 19-  
inch chassis)  
Toggle  
Input  
1, 2, 3, or 4  
Specifies the modules slot number  
1
designated on the chassis.  
Circuit Identifier  
Enter up to 20  
characters  
This represents the customers circuit ID.  
The first and last characters must be alpha  
or numeric; middle characters can be alpha,  
numeric, or hyphens.  
Blank  
Unit Equip State  
Toggle  
Equipped  
Establishes communication with MPU.  
Module must be set to EQUIPPED before  
remaining selections are allowed.  
UNEQUIPPED  
Unequipped  
No communication with MPU.  
(continued)  
2-115  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-534  
Page 3 of 6  
Table 534-1. RLX Configuration Fields, continued  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
Unit Service State  
Toggle  
IS (In-Service)  
Places the unit in service and allows  
equipment alarm reporting by the MPU.  
Must be set to IS for reporting of equipment  
alarms.  
OOS  
OOS (Out-Of-Service) Removes unit from service and stops  
equipment alarm reporting by the MPU.  
T1 Provision  
Toggle  
YES  
Brings up T1 default settings and allows  
configuration changes.  
NO  
NO  
No configuration changes allowed.  
T1 Service State  
Line Code  
Toggle  
Toggle  
Leave this field at OOS at this time to avoid undesirable reporting of alarms. Set this field to IS  
after completing the configuration of the remaining fields.  
AUTO  
When the RLX line code is set to AUTO,  
the module senses the line code and  
AMI  
switches from AMI to B8ZS if an encoded  
signal is detected. After switching to B8ZS,  
the RLX stays locked in this line code until  
an LOS is detected at both DS1 inputs.  
AMI  
Alternate Mark Inversion  
B8ZS  
AUTO  
Bipolar Eight-Zero Substitution  
Framing Format  
Toggle  
The system automatically detects,  
establishes, and displays AUTO-NR-and  
the correct frame format (UNFRAMED, FT  
ONLY, SF, or ESF).  
AUTO  
UNFRAMED  
Ft ONLY  
SF  
Unframed data pattern  
Used for SLC framing  
Super Frame  
ESF  
Extended Super Frame  
Network DS1 Source Toggle  
NRZ  
This tells the Craft that the network DS1  
source is at the backplane from the DS3  
MUX.  
NRZ  
BIPOLAR  
This tells the Craft that the network DS1  
source is at the bipolar DS1 interface. If  
you select this option when you are in a  
Broadband chassis, you will cut off the DS1  
signal. This option is used in the Loop  
Extender system. See Section 4 of this  
manual for information about the Extender  
Card.  
(continued)  
2-116  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-534  
Page 4 of 6  
Table 534-1. RLX Configuration Fields, continued  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
-3  
-9  
-7  
10  
BER Threshold  
Toggle  
Range of 10 to 10  
The average Bit Error Ratios of both the  
incoming DS1 signals are monitored by the  
RLX. By monitoring BERs, the RLX is  
capable of triggering a minor alarm when  
any of the monitored signals degrades  
below the BER threshold level.  
Span Power Setting* Toggle  
UNIT SWITCH†  
Defaults to the span power hardware  
Version A only: UNIT  
configuration (DIP SWITCH) setting on the SWITCH  
Version A RLX only.  
ENABLED  
Allows span power on the Version B RLX. Version B only:  
To activate this selection, its jumper must  
be set to either 130V or 130V as shown  
in Figure 525-2 or  
ENABLED  
Figure 525-3.  
DISABLED  
Stops span power on the Version B RLX.  
Pulse Equalization*  
Fixed  
Locked at NOT APPL.  
UNIT SWITCH Defaults to the hardware configuration (DIP Version A only: UNIT  
LBO Setting*†  
Toggle  
SWITCH) LBO setting on the Version A  
RLX.  
SWITCH  
0.0 dB, 7.5 dB, 15.0  
dB, or 22.5 dB  
Version A only: Overrides the hardware  
configuration (DIP SWITCH) setting. Sets  
the LBO in decibels.  
Version B only: 0.0 dB  
Version B only: Sets the LBO in decibels.  
Programmable  
Loopback  
Toggle  
ENABLED  
DISABLED  
Enables response to programmable  
loopback codes and overrides hardware  
configuration settings.  
DISABLED  
Disables response to programmable  
loopback codes and overrides hardware  
configuration settings.  
*Note: Unit switch settings (Pulse Equalization, Span Power, NID, and LBO) are shown on the bottom of the configuration screen.  
Note: The UNIT SWITCH option appears on screen for both RLX types, but is only functional for Version A.  
(continued)  
2-117  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-534  
Page 5 of 6  
Table 534-1. RLX Configuration Fields, continued  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
NID Loopback*†  
Toggle  
UNIT SWITCH  
Selects NID setting (either enabled [default] Version A only:  
or disabled) on the Version A RLX. When UNIT SWITCH  
the Version A is provisioned to function  
Version B only:  
like an NID, it supports inband and out-of-  
DISABLE  
band loopback codes.  
ENABLE  
DISABLE  
Enables response to NID loopback codes  
and overrides hardware configuration  
settings.  
Disables response to NID loopback codes  
and overrides hardware configuration  
settings.  
Loopback Activation Input  
Code  
16 binary characters  
(0s and 1s) must be  
entered.  
These codes can be set to any 16-bit binary 1101 0011 1101 0011  
value except: all 0s, all 1s, or a value that is  
already used in another 16-bit code. The  
signal is sent inband. RLX units go to  
loopup state when they are in an armed  
state. Loopup is activated for selected units.  
Detection time is 3 secs.  
Loopback Deactivate Input  
Code  
The signal is sent inband. Units in loopup  
state go back to armed state. Detection time  
is 5 secs.  
1001 0011 1001 0011  
1101 0101 1101 0110  
Lpbk Timeout  
Disable Code  
Input  
This disables the loopup time-out. Active  
loopbacks stay up until deactivation or  
disarm code is received. Detection time is 3  
secs.  
Loopback Timeout  
Period  
Input  
Enter a number from 0 This represents the minutes the loopback  
30 minutes  
to 255  
remains in effect before reverting to the  
non-loopback state. Setting the loopback  
time out period to 0 disables the time out  
feature.  
Network Keep Alive Toggle  
AIS  
If the system detects a LOS (Loss of Signal) AIS  
from the customer, an AIS is sent to the  
network.  
DS1 CUTOFF  
If the system detects a LOS from the  
customer, the signal is cut off and no signal  
is transmitted to the network.  
*Note: Unit switch settings (Pulse Equalization, Span Power, NID, and LBO) are shown on the bottom of the configuration screen.  
Note: The UNIT SWITCH option appears on screen for both RLX types, but is only functional for Version A.  
(continued)  
2-118  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-534  
Page 6 of 6  
Table 534-1. RLX Configuration Fields, continued  
OPTIONS DESCRIPTION  
FIELD  
TYPE  
DEFAULT  
DS0 Channel  
Toggle  
B(for DS0 Channel Version A: blocking a channel causes all 1s Blank  
blocking) or blank (for pattern to be transmitted in both directions  
normal operation) for on the channel.  
each of the 24 DS0  
Version B: blocking a channel causes the  
channels.  
blocking pattern (FFhex or 7Fhex) set up  
via the onboard jumper to be transmitted in  
both directions.  
T1 Service State  
Toggle  
IS (In-Service)  
Places facility in service and allows T1  
alarm reporting by the MPU.  
OOS  
OOS (Out-Of-Service) Removes facility from service and stops  
alarm reporting by the MPU.  
2-119  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-535  
Page 1 of 2  
USER ACCOUNT EDITING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions to system administrators for editing user  
account names and passwords, and for establishing privilege levels to regulate user access to  
various menus.  
Note: A togglefield type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the Rkey to view and select the  
previous option. An inputfield type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A fixedfield is locked, and cannot be changed  
by the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the Rkey to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select System Administration from the Main Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Edit User Accounts from the System Administration menu.  
Press Enter or Return. An Edit User Accounts menu is shown in Figure 535-1.  
3. Move the cursor to the User Number field. The number 1appears. A number from 1 to  
25 can be selected. The Craft Interface database allows up to twenty-five users to be  
entered. Use the space bar to select the user number, stopping when no user name appears  
on the screen.  
4. Use the arrow keys to move the cursor to the User Name field. Enter the user name (i.e.,  
logon). The system allows a one character minimum and ten character maximum. Only  
ASCII alpha, numeric, or hyphen characters are allowed. Single word User Names in all  
upper or lower case are easiest to remember. If there is already a user name assigned, a new  
user name can be entered replacing the existing user name. This field is case-sensitive.  
5. Use the arrow keys to move the cursor to the Password field. A maximum of ten characters  
can be entered in this field. A minimum of two characters with one character being a  
number is required. Only ASCII alpha, numeric, or hyphen characters are allowed. At the  
Password field, type the password. If there is already a password assigned, a new password  
can be entered replacing the existing password. This field is case-sensitive.  
2-120  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-535  
Page 2 of 2  
6. Use the arrow keys to move the cursor to the Privilege Level field. Use the space bar to  
select the privilege level. The lowest security level is 1, and the highest level is 5.  
Users assigned Level 5 have access to all menu selections; Level 5 is assigned to the  
system administrator.  
Level 3 is often assigned to the operating technician; these users have access to Levels  
1, 2, and 3.  
Level 2 is normally assigned to a local technician; these users have access to Levels 1  
and 2.  
Users assigned Level 1 have access to only those menus assigned a Level 1.  
7. Use the arrow keys to move to the Expiration Period field. Type in a number (0 to 999) to  
represent how many days remain before the password expires. If zero is selected, the  
password has no expiration period and the Number of Days Left field will display N/A."  
8. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
EDIT USER ACCOUNTS  
User Number  
User Name  
Password  
: 1  
: SONEPLEX  
: SONEPLEX1  
Privilege Level : 5  
Expiration Period: 0  
Number Days Left : N/A  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6156-A  
Figure 535-1. Edit User Account Screen  
2-121  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-536  
Page 1 of 2  
MENU SECURITY EDITING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions to system administrators for assigning or  
changing access user privilege levels to the Craft Interface menus.  
Note: A togglefield type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the Rkey to view and select the  
previous option. An inputfield type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A fixedfield is locked, and cannot be changed  
by the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the Rkey to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select System Administration from the Main Menu. Press Enter or  
Return.  
2. Select Edit Menu Security from the System Administration menu. Press Enter or Return.  
An Edit Menu Security screen (with default settings) appears as shown in Figure 536-1.  
3. Use the arrow keys to move the cursor to the Privilege toggle field. Use the space bar to  
select the privilege level (1 to 5). The lowest security level is 1; the highest level is 5.  
Users assigned Level 5 have access to all menu selections; Level 5 is assigned to the  
system administrator.  
Level 3 is often assigned to the operating technician; users have access to Levels 1, 2,  
and 3.  
Level 2 is normally assigned to a local technician; users have access to Levels 1 and 2.  
Users assigned Level 1 have access to only those menus assigned a Level 1.  
4. Repeat Step 3 for each Main Menu Selection that you wish to change.  
Note: Disregard the QLX Alarm Levels and QLX Configuration selections. The MPU  
software installed is used with either the Soneplex Broadband system or the Soneplex  
Loop Extender. QLX modules are not used in the Broadband chassis.  
5. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-122  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-536  
Page 2 of 2  
EDIT MENU SECURITY  
Menu or Command  
Privilege  
Menu or Command  
Privilege  
========================== =========  
============================== =========  
Clear Alarm History  
Set MPU Alarm Levels  
Set MUX Alarm Levels  
Set ODS2 Alarm Levels  
Set QLX Alarm Levels  
Set HLX Alarm Levels  
Set RLX Alarm Levels  
Set DLX Alarm Levels  
MUX Configuration  
ODS2 Configuration  
QLX Configuration  
HLX Configuration  
RLX Configuration  
DLX Configuration  
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
5
Edit Menu Security  
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
5
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
System TID/Time/Date  
Serial Port Configuration  
X.25 Configuration  
Shelf Housekeeping Alarms  
Force/APS Commands  
Reset/LED Test Commands  
Execute ACO  
Loopback Status/Commands  
Upload Configuration Data  
Download Configuration Data :  
Download Application Software:  
DS1 Perf. Mon. Configuration :  
HDSL Perf. Mon. Configuration:  
Edit User Accounts  
Test Access Unit Commands  
:
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
14854-A  
Figure 536-1. Edit Menu Security Screen (with Defaults)  
2-123  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-537  
Page 1 of 2  
FORCE/APS COMMANDS  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for using manual (forced switching) and  
automatic protection switching commands with the DS3 MUX and ODS2 modules. Executing  
one of the Force commands forces the working or protect module online. Executing the Enable  
APS or Disable APS command enables or disables Automatic Protection Switching (APS).  
Note: A togglefield type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the Rkey to view and select the  
previous option. An inputfield type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A fixedfield is locked, and cannot be changed  
by the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the Rkey to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
Note: Commands can be initiated on more than one unit by using the arrow keys to  
move to each unit and pressing the space bar to select each unit.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select System Maintenance from the Main Menu. Press Enter or  
Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Force/APS Commands from the System Maintenance Menu.  
Press Enter or Return. A Force/APS Command screen is shown in Figure 537-1.  
3. Use the arrow keys to move to the Command field. Use the space bar to select blank space  
(which means make no changes), FORCE TO WORKING, FORCE TO PROTECT,  
Enable APS, or Disable APS for each ODS2 pair and DS3 MUX pair installed in chassis.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
Note: Status will only appear for those units that have switching capability and are  
configured as protected.  
4. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-124  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-537  
Page 2 of 2  
FORCE / APS COMMANDS  
Online Unit APS / Lockout Status Command  
=========== ==================== ========================  
MUX (MXW/MXP)  
:
DS2 Group 1  
DS2 Group 2  
DS2 Group 3  
DS2 Group 4  
DS2 Group 5  
DS2 Group 6  
DS2 Group 7  
: WORKING  
ENABLED / UNLOCKED  
:
:
:
:
:
:
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6663-B  
Figure 537-1. Force/APS Commands Screen  
2-125  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-538  
Page 1 of 2  
RESET/LED TEST COMMANDS  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for performing a software reset and  
reinitialization, or to test the indicators on selected modules. Resets and LED Tests cannot be  
performed at the same time.  
Note: A togglefield type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the Rkey to view and select the  
previous option. An inputfield type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A fixedfield is locked, and cannot be changed  
by the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the Rkey to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
Note: Commands can be initiated on more than one module by using the arrow keys to  
move to each module and pressing the space bar to select each module.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select System Maintenance from the Main Menu. Press Enter or  
Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Reset/LED Test Commands from the System Maintenance  
menu. Press Enter or Return. A Reset/indicator Test Commands screen is shown in  
Figure 538-1.  
3. Use the arrow keys to move to the desired modules Group-Slot selection field.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
To perform an LED test, use the space bar to select L. The LED test turns all the  
indicators yellow on the module(s) selected. A yellow indicator verifies that the module  
is functional.  
To perform a Reset, use the space bar to select R. Resets performed through the Craft  
Interface are soft. A soft reset on the MPU causes a system restart and logs off all  
current users on all ports. A soft reset on the DS3 MUX, ODS2, HLXC, DLX, and RLX  
modules allows the current configuration to be left in place, but the collection of data is  
stopped for several seconds. Any soft reset will not affect traffic.  
2-126  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-538  
Page 2 of 2  
4. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return. If Reset is selected, a pop-up appears as  
shown below:  
Are You Sure? (y/n)  
Press Y for yes or N for no.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
RESET / LED TEST  
Low Speed Units (Group-Slot)  
=======================================================  
M
P
U
=
M M  
1 -  
2 -  
3 -  
4 -  
5 -  
6 -  
7 -  
X X ------- ------- ------- ------- ------- ------- -------  
W P 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4  
=== ======= ======= ======= ======= ======= ======= =======  
.
R
R
.
.
.
.
(Legend: L = Perform LED Test, R = Execute Unit Reset)  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6664-D  
Figure 538-1. Reset/LED Test Screen  
2-127  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-539  
Page 1 of 1  
ACO (ALARM CUT-OFF) COMMAND  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for silencing currently active audible alarms.  
Any new alarms will cause the audible alarm relay to be activated again and the ACO state  
canceled.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select System Maintenance from the Main Menu. Press Enter or  
Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Execute ACO (Alarm Cut-Off) from the System Maintenance  
Menu.  
3. Press Enter or Return to activate the ACO.  
4. The following message appears across the screen and is shown in Figure 539-1.  
ACO Executed  
Press any key to continue  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE  
1. Force/APS Commands  
2. Reset/LED Test Commands  
3. Execute ACO (Alarm Cut-Off)  
4. Loopback Status/Commands  
5. Di  
6. Di  
7. Up  
8. Te  
ACO Executed  
Press Any Key To Continue  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6157-A  
Figure 539-1. ACO Executed Message  
2-128  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-540  
Page 1 of 1  
INVENTORY DISPLAY  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for displaying inventory information for the  
modules installed in the Soneplex Broadband chassis and modules installed at the remote  
locations. The inventory displayed is current at the time the request is made. A valid inventory  
display may not be available for up to a minute after the initial MPU startup.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information about moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select System Maintenance from the Main Menu. Press Enter or  
Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Display Inventory from the System Maintenance Menu. Press  
Enter or Return. The Inventory Status screen is shown in Figure 540-1.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
INVENTORY STATUS  
TID: ADC  
Unit  
Identifier  
Part  
Number  
ADC Catalog Serial  
Number Number  
Date S/W  
Code Version Code  
CLEI  
===================== ========== ============ ========== ==== ======= ==========  
MPU W/ BOOT CODE  
MPU APPLICATION S/W  
2.0  
5.0  
DS3MUX WORKING  
PROTECT  
NO DATA PRESENT  
NO DATA PRESENT  
LIU-1-1 LOCAL  
REMOTE  
LIU-1-2 LOCAL  
REMOTE  
LIU-1-3 LOCAL  
REMOTE  
LIU-1-4 LOCAL  
NO DATA PRESENT  
NO DATA PRESENT  
NO DATA PRESENT  
NO DATA PRESENT  
NO DATA PRESENT  
NO DATA PRESENT  
NO DATA PRESENT  
Page 1 of 6  
Press CONTROL-A for assistance  
6766-B  
Figure 540-1. Inventory Status Screen (Typical)  
2-129  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-541  
Page 1 of 16  
LOOPBACK STATUS/COMMANDS  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for displaying the currently active loopbacks for  
all circuits in the system, and for enabling/disabling loopbacks.  
Caution: Do not perform a DS3 loopback when the Soneplex Broadband chassis is  
connected to a DS3 CAM unit in the Soneplex CCAS system.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the “R” key to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space of the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message “Configuration Successful… Press Any Key  
To Continue” appears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information about moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow or number keys to select System Maintenance from the Main Menu. Press  
Enter or Return. The System Maintenance menu is shown in Figure 541-1.  
2. Use the arrow or number keys to select Loopback Status/Commands from the System  
Maintenance Menu. Press Enter or Return. The Loopback Status/Commands menu is  
shown in Figure 541-2.  
3. Use the arrow or number keys to select High Speed Loopback Status/Commands or Low  
Speed Loopback Status/Commands, then press Enter or Return. The High Speed Loopback  
Status/Commands screen appears, as shown in Figure 541-3. The Low Speed Loopback  
Status/Commands screen appears, as shown in Figure 541-4.  
4. Low Speed only: move to the Group toggle field. Select group number 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.  
5. Low Speed only: move to the DS1# toggle field. Select DS1 number 1, 2, 3, or 4.  
6. Use the arrow keys to move to one of the Local, Repeater, Repeater1, Repeater2, or  
Remote Loopback command toggle fields.  
7. Select ACT NET, ACT CUST, SEND LPBK (at Local field only), or DEACTIVATE at each  
field. Press Enter or Return. (Refer to Table 541-1 for loopback toggle field options.) A blank  
field indicates no selection.  
2-130  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-541  
Page 2 of 16  
Note: The ACT CUST and ACT NET options create customer and network loopbacks  
on the HLXC and HLXR cards. The SEND LPBK option does not apply to loopbacks on  
the local HLXC or HLXR cards. Instead, the SEND LPBK option sends a request out to  
the DS3 MUX and into the network to request that a loopback be established on the  
associated DS1 facility at the other end of the network connection. This request is  
denoted graphically by the text “<LPBK RQ” that appears on loopback screens.  
The corresponding DS1 on the other side of the network connection should respond to this  
request by establishing a loopback on the corresponding remote unit. The receipt of this  
request via the DS3 network interface is denoted graphically by the text “LPBK RQ>” that  
appears on loopback screens.  
Note: The SEND LPBK option is only available in the Soneplex Broadband system. It  
can only be executed from the Local command toggle field on the Loopback  
Status/Commands screen when the DS1 Loopback Mode field on the DS3 MUX  
Configuration screen is configured as C-Bit parity.  
Reference: DLP-529 DS3 MUX Configuration  
Note: The “DEACTIVATE” command can be performed at any field that does not  
display “N/A”, and will deactivate all loopbacks. You must deactivate the currently  
active loopback to activate another loopback.  
Note: Only applicable loopback actions for the unit will be displayed.  
8. The following message appears:  
Modifying LOOPBACK status…  
Are You Sure? (y/n)  
9. Enable your selection by pressing Y for yes or cancel your selection by pressing N for no.  
When you press Y, the screen will disappear for a few seconds. The screen will then  
display the currently active loopback.  
Note: The Programmable Loopback Armed State read-only field displays either  
ARMING DISABLED or ARMED. [loopback arming TAP]  
Reference: DLP-573 HLX Loopback Configuration  
Note: At the MPU 5.2 Craft Interface when both loops on any HDSL loop segment are  
down, no loopbacks at units downstream of the condition may be activated. The  
Loopback screen will show “N/A” under the name of any affected unit’s column (i.e.,  
LOCAL, REPEATER, REPEATER1, REPEATER2, or REMOTE). HDSL loop  
segments that may be affected include the loops between:  
the HLXC and the HLXR (no repeater)  
the HLXC and the HRX (one repeater)  
the HRX and the HLXR (one repeater)  
the HLXC and the HRX1 (two repeaters)  
2-131  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-541  
Page 3 of 16  
the HRX1 and the HRX2 (two repeaters)  
the HXR2 and the HLXR (two repeaters)  
For example, if an HDSL loop failure occurs on both loops between the HRX and the  
HLXR (one repeater), the REMOTE column will show “N/A”.  
When both loops on an HDSL segment go down and a loopback is already in progress at  
one of the affected units, the loopback will continue to appear as if it is still in progress  
on the screen, although it will no longer function on the loops. However, the loopback  
will still need to be deactivated before another loopback can be initiated.  
For descriptions of alarms arising from fault conditions (such as HDSL loop failures),  
refer to TAP-101 (Alarm Troubleshooting).  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-132  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-541  
Page 4 of 16  
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE  
1. Force/APS Commands  
2. Reset/LED Test Commands  
3. Execute ACO (Alarm Cut-Off)  
4. Loopback Status/Commands  
5. Display Inventory  
6. Display Circuit IDs  
7. Upload/Download Commands  
8. Test Access Unit Commands  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
5323-A  
Figure 541-1. System Maintenance Menu  
Loopback Status/Commands  
1. High Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
2. Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6132-A  
Figure 541-2. Loopback Status/Commands Menu  
2-133  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-541  
Page 5 of 16  
DS3 MUX LOOPBACK  
SELECTION FIELD  
High Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Unit Location -  
LOCAL  
===========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback :  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
DS3MUX  
+---------+  
|
|
----------------->|-------->|----------------->  
|
|
|
|
|
|
NETWORK DS3  
DEMUX  
<-----------------|<--------|<-----------------  
|fac term|  
+---------+  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6665-C  
Note: Do not perform a DS3 loopback when the Soneplex Broadband chassis  
is connected to a DS3 CAM unit in the Soneplex CCAS system.  
Figure 541-3. High Speed (DS3 MUX) Loopback Status/Commands Screen  
HLXC LOOPBACK  
SELECTION FIELD  
HRX LOOPBACK  
SELECTION FIELD  
HLXR LOOPBACK  
SELECTION FIELD  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 1 DS1#: 4  
Unit Location - LOCAL  
REPEATER  
REMOTE  
===========  
===========  
===========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
HLXC  
HRX1  
HLXR  
+---------+  
+---------+  
+---------+  
|
|
|
|
|
|
-------------->|-------->|-------->|-------->|-------->|-------->|------------->  
NETWORK  
DS1  
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
| CUSTOMER  
| HDSL  
|
| HDSL  
|
|
|
DS1  
<--------------|<--------|<--------|<--------|<--------|<--------|<-------------  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
Programmable Loopback Armed State: ARMING DISABLED  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
11379-A  
Figure 541-4. Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands Screen  
2-134  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-541  
Page 6 of 16  
Table 541-1. Loopback Selection Field Options  
FIELD  
DS3 MUX (HIGH SPEED)  
Local DS3 MUX  
HDSL SYSTEMS (LOW SPEED)  
UNIT TYPE  
LOOPBACK TYPE  
OPTION  
SHOWN IN…  
Network Loopback at the DS3 MUX  
ACT NET  
Figure 541-5  
Local  
HLXC  
Customer Loopback at the HLXC  
Network Loopback at the HLXC  
Send Loopback at the HLXC Module  
Customer Loopback at the HLXR  
Network Loopback at the HLXR  
ACT CUST  
ACT NET  
Figure 541-6a  
Figure 541-6b  
Figure 541-6c  
Figure 541-7a  
Figure 541-7b  
Local  
HLXC  
HLXR  
SEND LPBK*  
ACT CUST  
ACT NET  
Remote  
HDSL SYSTEM WITH ONE HRX (LOW SPEED)  
Repeater  
HRX1  
Customer Loopback at the HRX  
Network Loopback at the HRX  
ACT CUST  
ACT NET  
Figure 541-8a  
Figure 541-8b  
HDSL SYSTEM WITH TWO HRXS (LOW SPEED)  
Repeater 1 HRX1  
Customer Loopback at the HRX1  
ACT CUST  
ACT NET  
ACT CUST  
ACT NET  
Figure 541-9a  
Figure 541-9b  
not shown  
Network Loopback at the HRX1  
Customer Loopback at the HRX2  
Network Loopback at the HRX2  
Repeater 2 HRX2  
not shown  
FIBER OPTIC SYSTEM WITH ODS2 AND QLX MODULES (LOW SPEED)  
Local  
ODS2  
QLX  
Customer Loopback at the ODS2 Module  
Network Loopback at the Remote QLX  
Send Loopback at the ODS2 Module  
ACT CUST  
ACT NET  
Figure 541-10a  
Figure 541-10b  
Figure 541-10c  
Remote  
Local  
ODS2  
SEND LPBK*  
T1 SYSTEM WITH DLX MODULE (LOW SPEED)  
Local  
Local  
DLX  
DLX  
Customer Loopback at the DLX  
Network Loopback at the DLX  
Send Loopback at the DLX Module  
ACT CUST  
ACT NET  
Figure 541-11a  
Figure 541-11b  
Figure 541-11c  
SEND LPBK*  
T1 SYSTEM WITH RLX MODULE (LOW SPEED)  
Local  
RLX  
Customer Loopback at the RLX  
Network Loopback at the RLX  
Send Loopback at the RLX Module  
ACT CUST  
ACT NET  
Figure 541-12a  
Figure 541-12b  
Figure 541-12c  
Local  
RLX  
SEND LPBK*  
* The SEND LPBK option is only available in the Soneplex Broadband System at the Local command toggle  
field on the Loopback Status/Commands screen when the DS1 Loopback Mode field on the DS3 MUX  
Configuration screen is configured as C-Bit parity.  
Note: When a customer (CPE) loopback is in progress, the network output signal is returned to the network as a  
keep-alive for network equipment. However, when a network loopback is in progress, an unframed all 1s signal  
(AIS) is transmitted to the customer interface.  
2-135  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-541  
Page 7 of 16  
High Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Unit Location -  
LOCAL  
===========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback :  
ACT NET  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
DS3MUX  
+---------+  
|
|
----------------->|----+  
|----------------->  
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
NETWORK DS3  
|
|
DEMUX  
<-----------------|<---+  
|<-----------------  
|fac term|  
+---------+  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6666-C  
Note: Do not perform a DS3 loopback when the Soneplex Broadband chassis  
is connected to a DS3 CAM unit in the Soneplex CCAS system.  
Figure 541-5. DS3 MUX Network Loopback Screen  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 4  
DS1#: 1  
Unit Location - LOCAL  
==========  
REPEATER  
==========  
REMOTE  
==========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
N/A  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
HLXC  
NONE  
HLXR  
+---------+  
+---------+  
|
|
|
|
-------------->|--+  
+->|---------------------------->|---------|------------->  
NETWORK  
DS1  
| |  
| |  
| |  
| |  
| |  
| |  
|
|
|
| CUSTOMER  
HDSL  
|
|
DS1  
<--------------|<-+  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
+--|<----------------------------|<--------|<-------------  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
Programmable Loopback Armed State: ARMING DISABLED  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
11381-A  
Figure 541-6a. HLXC Customer Loopback Screen  
2-136  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-541  
Page 8 of 16  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 4 DS1#: 1  
Unit Location - LOCAL  
==========  
REPEATER  
==========  
REMOTE  
==========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
N/A  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
HLXC  
NONE  
HLXR  
+---------+  
+---------+  
|
|
|
|
AIS  
+->|---------------------------->|---------|------------->  
-------------->|--+  
NETWORK  
DS1  
| |  
| |  
| |  
|
|
|
|
|
|
| CUSTOMER  
HDSL  
|
|
DS1  
<--------------|<-+  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
+--|<----------------------------|<--------|<-------------  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
Programmable Loopback Armed State: ARMING DISABLED  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
11382-A  
Figure 541-6b. HLXC Network Loopback Screen  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 1  
DS1#: 4  
Location - LOCAL  
==========  
REPEATER1  
==========  
REPEATER2  
==========  
REMOTE  
==========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
STATUS:  
Unit Type: HLXC  
+--------+  
HRX1  
+--------+  
HRX2  
+--------+  
HLXR  
+--------+  
LPBK RQ> |  
|
|
|
|
|
|
|AIS  
-------->|------->|------>|--------|------>|------->|------>|--+ +->|----->  
NETWORK |  
|
|
|
|
|
| |  
| HDSL | |  
| | |  
| CUST  
| DS1  
|
DS1  
|
|
| HDSL |  
|
| HDSL |  
|
|
|
<--------|<-------|<------|<-------|<------|<-------|<------|--+-----|<-----  
<LPBK RQ |net cust|  
+--------+  
|net cust|  
+--------+  
|net cust|  
+--------+  
|net cust|  
+--------+  
Programmable Loopback Armed State: UNARMED  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
11406-A  
Note: The SEND LPBK command can be executed with 0, 1, or 2 HRXs.  
Figure 541-6c. HLXC Send Loopback Screen  
2-137  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-541  
Page 9 of 16  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 4 DS1#: 1  
Unit Location - LOCAL  
==========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
REPEATER  
==========  
N/A  
REMOTE  
==========  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
HLXC  
NONE  
HLXR  
+---------+  
+---------+  
|
|
|
|
-------------->|-------->|---------------------------->|--+  
+->|------------->  
| | CUSTOMER  
NETWORK  
DS1  
|
|
|
|
|
|
| |  
| |  
| |  
HDSL  
| |  
| |  
DS1  
<--------------|<--------|<----------------------------|<-+  
+--|<-------------  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
Programmable Loopback Armed State: ARMING DISABLED  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
11383-A  
Figure 541-7a. HLXR Customer Loopback Screen  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 6  
DS1#: 1  
Unit Location - LOCAL  
==========  
REPEATER  
==========  
REMOTE  
==========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
N/A  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
HLXC  
NONE  
HLXR  
+---------+  
+---------+  
|
|
|
|AIS  
+->|------------->  
| | CUSTOMER  
-------------->|-------->|---------------------------->|--+  
NETWORK  
DS1  
|
|
|
|
|
|
| |  
| |  
| |  
HDSL  
| |  
| |  
DS1  
<--------------|<--------|<----------------------------|<-+  
+--|<-------------  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
Programmable Loopback Armed State: ARMING DISABLED  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
9491-D  
Figure 541-7b. HLXR Network Loopback Screen  
2-138  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-541  
Page 10 of 16  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 4 DS1#: 1  
Unit Location - LOCAL  
==========  
REPEATER  
==========  
REMOTE  
==========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
HLXC  
HRX  
HLXR  
+---------+  
+---------+  
+---------+  
|
|
|
|
|
|
-------------->|-------->|-------->|--+  
+->|-------->|---------|------------->  
NETWORK  
DS1  
|
|
|
|
| |  
| |  
| |  
| |  
| | HDSL  
| |  
|
|
|
| CUSTOMER  
| HDSL  
|
|
|
DS1  
<--------------|<--------|<--------|<-+  
+--|<--------|<--------|<-------------  
|net cust|  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
+---------+  
Programmable Loopback Armed State: ARMING DISABLED  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
9499-D  
Figure 541-8a. HRX Customer Loopback Screen (One HRX)  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 4  
DS1#: 1  
Unit Location - LOCAL  
==========  
REPEATER  
==========  
REMOTE  
==========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
HLXC  
HRX  
HLXR  
+---------+  
+---------+  
+---------+  
|
|
|
|
|
|
AIS  
+->|-------->|---------|------------->  
-------------->|-------->|-------->|--+  
NETWORK  
DS1  
|
|
|
|
| |  
| |  
| |  
|
|
|
|
| CUSTOMER  
| HDSL  
|
| HDSL  
|
|
|
DS1  
<--------------|<--------|<--------|<-+  
+--|<--------|<--------|<-------------  
|net cust|  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
+---------+  
Programmable Loopback Armed State: ARMING DISABLED  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
9500-C  
Figure 541-8b. HRX Network Loopback Screen (One HRX)  
2-139  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-541  
Page 11 of 16  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 1  
DS1#: 4  
Location - LOCAL  
==========  
REPEATER1  
==========  
REPEATER2  
==========  
REMOTE  
==========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
HLXC  
HRX1  
HRX2  
HLXR  
+--------+  
+--------+  
+--------+  
+--------+  
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
-------->|------->|------>|--+ +->|------>|--------|------>|------->|----->  
NETWORK |  
|
| | | |  
| HDSL | | | | HDSL |  
| | | |  
|
|
|
| CUST  
| DS1  
|
DS1  
|
|
| HDSL |  
|
|
|
|
<--------|<-------|<------|<-+ +--|<------|<-------|<------|<-------|<-----  
|net cust|  
+--------+  
|net cust|  
+--------+  
|net cust|  
+--------+  
|net cust|  
+--------+  
Programmable Loopback Armed State: ARMING DISABLED  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
11384-A  
Figure 541-9a. HRX1 Customer Loopback Screen (Two HRXs)  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 1  
DS1#: 4  
Location - LOCAL  
==========  
REPEATER1  
==========  
REPEATER2  
==========  
REMOTE  
==========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
HLXC  
HRX1  
HRX2  
HLXR  
+--------+  
+--------+  
+--------+  
+--------+  
|
|
|
AIS|  
|
|
|
|
-------->|------->|------>|--+ +->|------>|--------|------>|------->|----->  
NETWORK |  
|
| |  
| HDSL | |  
| |  
|
|
|
|
| CUST  
| DS1  
|
DS1  
|
|
| HDSL |  
|
| HDSL |  
|
|
|
|
<--------|<-------|<------|<-+ +--|<------|<-------|<------|<-------|<-----  
|net cust|  
+--------+  
|net cust|  
+--------+  
|net cust|  
+--------+  
|net cust|  
+--------+  
Programmable Loopback Armed State: ARMING DISABLED  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
11380-A  
Figure 541-9b. HRX1 Network Loopback Screen (Two HRXs)  
2-140  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-541  
Page 12 of 16  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 2 DS1#: 1  
Unit Location -  
LOCAL  
REPEATER  
REMOTE  
========  
=========  
========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
N/A  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
ODS2  
NONE  
QLX  
+---------+  
+---------+  
|
|
|
|
---------------> |--+ +->|-------------------------> |-------->|--------------->  
NETWORK  
DS1  
|
|
|
| |  
| |  
| |  
|
|
|
|
|
|
CUSTOMER  
DS1  
<--------------- |<-+ +--|<------------------------- |<--------|<---------------  
|net cust |  
+---------+  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
9698-A  
Figure 541-10a. ODS2 Customer Loopback  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 2  
DS1#: 1  
Unit Location - LOCAL  
==========  
REPEATER  
==========  
REMOTE  
==========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
N/A  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
ODS2  
NONE  
QLX  
+---------+  
+---------+  
|
|
|
| AIS  
-------------->|-------->|---------------------------->|--+  
+->|------------->  
| CUSTOMER  
NETWORK  
DS1  
|
|
|
|
|
|
| |  
| |  
| |  
|
|
DS1  
OPTICAL DS2  
<--------------|<--------|<----------------------------|<-+  
+--|<-------------  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
9496-C  
Figure 541-10b. Remote QLX Network Loopback Screen  
2-141  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-541  
Page 13 of 16  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 2 DS1#: 1  
Unit Location -  
LOCAL  
REPEATER  
REMOTE  
========  
=========  
========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
N/A  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
ODS2  
NONE  
QLX  
+---------+  
+---------+  
LPBK RQ>  
|
|
|
|
---------------->|-------->|------------------------->|-------->|--------------->  
NETWORK  
DS1  
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
CUSTOMER  
DS1  
OPTICAL DS2  
<----------------|<--------|<-------------------------|<--------|<--------------  
<LPBK RQ  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
14849-A  
Figure 541-10c. ODS2 SEND LPBK Screen  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 5  
DS1#: 1  
Unit Location -  
LOCAL  
REPEATER  
REMOTE  
========  
=========  
========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
N/A  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
DLX  
NONE  
NONE  
+---------+  
|
|
---------------> |--+ +->|---------------------------------------------------->  
NETWORK  
DS1  
|
|
|
| |  
| |  
| |  
CUSTOMER  
DS1  
<--------------- |<----+--|<---------------------------------------------------  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
9699-A  
Figure 541-11a. DLX Customer Loopback Screen  
2-142  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-541  
Page 14 of 16  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 5 DS1#: 1  
Unit Location -  
LOCAL  
REPEATER  
REMOTE  
========  
=========  
========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
N/A  
N/A  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
DLX  
NONE  
NONE  
+---------+  
|AIS  
---------------> |--+ +->|---------------------------------------------------->  
|
NETWORK  
DS1  
| |  
| |  
| |  
|
|
|
CUSTOMER  
DS1  
<--------------- |<-+ +--|<---------------------------------------------------  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
9700-A  
Figure 541-11b. DLX Network Loopback Screen  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 7  
DS1#: 3  
Unit Location -  
LOCAL  
REPEATER  
REMOTE  
========  
=========  
========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
N/A  
N/A  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
DLX  
NONE  
NONE  
+---------+  
|AIS  
+->|---------------------------------------------------->  
LPBK RQ>  
---------------->|--+  
|
NETWORK  
DS1  
| |  
| |  
| |  
|
|
|
CUSTOMER  
DS1  
<----------------|<-+  
<LPBK RQ |net cust|  
+---------+  
+--|<----------------------------------------------------  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
14848-A  
Figure 541-11c. DLX SEND LPBK Screen  
2-143  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-541  
Page 15 of 16  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 1 DS1#: 1  
Unit Location - LOCAL  
==========  
REPEATER  
==========  
REMOTE  
==========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
N/A  
N/A  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
RLX  
NONE  
NONE  
+---------+  
|
|
-------------->|--+  
+->|----------------------------------------------------->  
NETWORK  
DS1  
|
|
|
| |  
| |  
| |  
CUSTOMER  
DS1  
AIS  
<--------------|<-+  
+--|<-----------------------------------------------------  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
Programmable Loopback Armed State: ARMING DISABLED  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
9493-C  
Figure 541-12a. RLX Customer Loopback Screen  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 1  
DS1#: 1  
Unit Location - LOCAL  
==========  
REPEATER  
==========  
REMOTE  
==========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
N/A  
N/A  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
RLX  
NONE  
NONE  
+---------+  
|
|
AIS  
-------------->|--+ +-->|----------------------------------------------------->  
NETWORK  
DS1  
| |  
| |  
| |  
|
|
|
CUSTOMER  
DS1  
<--------------|<-+ +---|<-----------------------------------------------------  
|net cust|  
+---------+  
Programmable Loopback Armed State: ARMING DISABLED  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
9494-B  
Figure 541-12b. RLX Network Loopback Screen  
2-144  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-541  
Page 16 of 16  
Low Speed Loopback Status/Commands  
Group: 5 DS1#: 1  
Unit Location -  
LOCAL  
REPEATER  
REMOTE  
========  
=========  
========  
COMMANDS:  
Loopback:  
N/A  
N/A  
STATUS:  
Unit Type:  
RLX  
NONE  
NONE  
+---------+  
|AIS  
+->|---------------------------------------------------->  
LPBK RQ>  
---------------->|--+  
|
NETWORK  
DS1  
| |  
| |  
| |  
|
|
|
CUSTOMER  
DS1  
<----------------|<-+  
<LPBK RQ |net cust|  
+---------+  
+--|<----------------------------------------------------  
Programmable Loopback Armed State: ARMING DISABLED  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
14850-A  
Figure 541-12c. RLX SEND LPBK Screen  
2-145  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-542  
Page 1 of 4  
ACTIVE ALARMS DISPLAY  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for displaying only the currently active alarms  
for all circuits in the system.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information about moving around and editing fields.  
Note: Pressing the “R” key clears the screen and displays only the current alarm status.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Alarms from the Main Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Display Active Alarms from the Alarms menu. Press Enter or  
Return. A Display Active Alarms screen is shown in Figure 542-1.  
3. A maximum of 112 entries is displayed. If the list is too long to fit on one screen, use the  
Up/Down keys to scroll through the entries one line at a time. Use the right arrow key to  
move down one screen at a time. Use the left arrow key to move up one screen at a time.  
Pressing CONTROL-R queries the database for all currently active alarms and a new list is  
displayed.  
The first column (Access Identifier) (AID) identifies an entity in the Soneplex Broadband  
system to which the alarm condition pertains. Different alarm conditions  
in the Soneplex Broadband system result in different types of AIDs.  
The second column (Locn) displays NEND, FEND, REPC, or REPR indicating the location  
of the alarm. Figure 542-2 (T1 HLXC/HRX/HLXR NEND and FEND locations), Figure  
542-3 (HDSL HLXC/HRX/HLXR NEND and FEND Locations), Figure 542-4 (DLX  
NEND locations), Figure 542-5, (ODS2 NEND locations), and Figure 542-6 (RLX NEND  
and FEND Locations) show FEND, NEND, REPC, and REPR locations and descriptions  
for HLXC/HRX/HLXR, DLX, ODS2, and RLX systems.  
The third column (Circuit Identifier) displays the circuit or facility name assigned  
in the configuration menu. This is also the circuit in trouble.  
The fourth column (Condition) displays the alarm condition present on the circuit.  
Reference: TAP-101 Alarm Troubleshooting  
The fifth column (Status) displays CR (Critical), MJ (Major), MN (Minor), or EV (Event),  
indicating the degree of the alarm.  
The sixth column (ACO) indicates whether the Alarm Cut-Off has been activated  
(YES or NO) for a given alarm.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-146  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-542  
Page 2 of 4  
ACTIVE ALARMS  
Legend:  
Access ID=Identifier[-]Shelf-Grp-Slot[-Site(1=Lcl,2=Rmt) | -Loop(1=Lp 1,2=Lp 2)]  
Access ID  
Locn Circuit ID  
Condition  
Status ACO  
---------------- ---- -------------------- ---------------- ------ ---  
T2-1-3-1  
T2-1-3-1  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
FEND  
FEND  
FEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
FEND  
FEND  
FEND  
OPTICAL LOS  
OPTICAL LOF  
RECOVERY  
LOF  
T-BERP  
T-SNR  
LOF  
T-BERP  
T-SNR  
RECOVERY  
LOF  
T-BERP  
T-SNR  
LOF  
T-BERP  
T-SNR  
MJ  
MJ  
MN  
MJ  
MN  
EV  
MJ  
MN  
EV  
MN  
MJ  
MN  
EV  
MJ  
MN  
EV  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
HDSL-1-7-1-1  
HDSL-1-7-1-1  
HDSL-1-7-1-1  
HDSL-1-7-1-1  
HDSL-1-7-1-1  
HDSL-1-7-1-1  
HDSL-1-7-1-1  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
Page 1 of 1  
Press CONTROL-A for assistance  
6675-A  
Figure 542-1. Active Alarms Screen (Sample)  
LOCAL  
REMOTE  
(SITE = -1)  
(SITE = -2)  
DS1  
DS1  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 2  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 2  
DS1  
A
FEND  
NEND  
NEND  
DS1  
FEND  
B
HLXC  
HRX  
HLXR  
TO NETWORK  
KEY  
TO CUSTOMER  
NEND means "PM information collected directly from incoming T1 signals, both at local and remote sites."  
FEND means "ESF PRM information collected at the opposite ends of spans from the affected circuit and  
returned to the system via the ESF Datalink, both at local and remote sites".The framing format must be  
ESF in order for FEND information to be displayed.  
Note: For Site 1, FEND information is at A; for Site 2, FEND information is at B.  
10263-A  
Figure 542-2. T1 HLXC/HRX/HLXR NEND and FEND Locations  
2-147  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-542  
Page 3 of 4  
CRP1  
XCVR  
RRP1  
XCVR  
CRP2  
XCVR  
RRP2  
XCVR  
NEND  
FEND  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 2  
LOOP 1  
HLXC  
HRX1  
HRX2  
HLXR  
LOOP 2  
LOOP 2  
XCVR  
CRP1  
XCVR  
RRP1  
XCVR  
CRP2  
XCVR  
RRP2  
NEND  
TO NETWORK/MUX  
FEND  
TO CUSTOMER  
KEY  
NEND means "at the HLXC, looking toward the customer (HLXR)."  
FEND means "at the HLXR, looking toward the network (HLXC)."  
CRP1 means "at the central office side of the HRX1, looking toward the network (HLXC)."  
RRP1 means "at the remote (CPE) side of the HRX1, looking toward the customer (HRX2/HLXR)."  
CRP2 means "at the central office side of the HRX2, looking toward the network (HRX1/HLXC)."  
RRP2 means "at the remote (CPE) side of the HRX2, looking toward the customer (HLXR)."  
CRP1 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 1 (TL1)  
RRP1 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 2 (TL1)  
CRP2 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 3 (TL1)  
RRP2 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 4 (TL1)  
NOTE: CRP2 and RRP2 are not present when there is no HRX2.  
11375-B  
Figure 542-3. HDSL HLXC/HRX/HLXR NEND and FEND Locations  
LOCAL  
REMOTE  
(SITE = -1)  
(SITE = -2)  
NEND  
DS1  
T1  
DS1  
DLX  
DSX  
DS1  
T1  
DS1  
NEND  
TO NETWORK  
TO CUSTOMER  
KEY  
NEND means "PM information collected directly from  
incoming T1 signals, both at local and remote sites".  
10455-A  
Figure 542-4. DLX NEND Locations  
2-148  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-542  
Page 4 of 4  
LOCAL  
REMOTE  
(SITE = -1)  
(SITE = -2)  
NEND  
DS1  
OPTICAL DS2  
DS1  
QLX  
OR  
ODS2  
QFLC  
OPTICAL DS2  
DS1  
DS1  
NEND  
TO CUSTOMER  
TO NETWORK  
KEY  
NEND means "PM information collected directly from  
incoming T1 signals, both at local and remote sites".  
10456-A  
Figure 542-5. ODS2 NEND Locations  
LOCAL  
REMOTE  
(SITE = -1)  
(SITE = -2)  
NEND  
DS1  
FEND  
DS1  
T1  
Span  
Repeater  
RLX  
DS1  
T1  
DS1  
FEND  
NEND  
TO NETWORK  
TO CUSTOMER  
KEY  
NEND means "PM information collected directly from incoming T1 signals, both at  
local and remote sites".  
FEND means "ESF PM information collected at the opposite end of spans from the  
affected circuit and returned to the system via ESF datalink".The framing format  
must be ESF in order for FEND information to be displayed.  
10265-A  
Figure 542-6. RLX NEND and FEND Locations  
2-149  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-543  
Page 1 of 1  
ALARM SUMMARY DISPLAY  
Summary: Use this command to display a summary of the current alarms for the Soneplex  
Broadband chassis selected.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information about moving around and editing fields.  
Note: Pressing the “R” key clears the screen and displays only the current alarm status.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Alarms from the Main Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Display Alarm Summary from the Alarms menu. Press Enter  
or Return. A Display Alarm Summary screen is shown in Figure 543-1.  
Note: Each time the shelf status changes, the screen is updated. When the screen is full,  
the oldest status line scrolls off the screen.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
ALARM SUMMARY  
Legend:  
---------  
- No Alarm  
* Alarm(s)  
L=Local Equipment  
F=Local Facility  
R=Remote Equipment/Facility  
M=Multiple  
H=Housekeeping  
Shelf  
=============  
H R P A  
C M M S E W C  
R J N K M R O  
Mux  
===  
M M  
X X  
W P  
= =  
Low Speed Units (Group-Slot)  
==================================  
1-  
2-  
3-  
4-  
5-  
6-  
7-  
---- ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- ----  
1234 1234 1234 1234 1234 1234 1234  
==== ==== ==== ==== ==== ==== ====  
Date  
Time  
======== ======== = = = = = = =  
01/04/95 04:29:23 - * - - - * *  
L
-
-
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6676-B  
Figure 543-1. Alarm Summary Screen (Typical)  
2-150  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-544  
Page 1 of 4  
ALARM HISTORY DISPLAY  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for displaying both active and cleared alarms  
stored in the alarm history. Each alarm declaration or alarm clearing creates a separate message  
in the history buffer. (However, Event level alarms do not show a clearing message.)  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information about moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Display Alarm History from the Alarms menu. Press Enter or  
Return. An Alarm History screen is shown in Figure 544-1.  
2. At the selection prompt Press Enter or Return. Both the active and cleared alarms appear as  
shown in Figure 544-1.  
3. Up to a maximum of 112 messages can be displayed from this history buffer. The messages  
are displayed in reverse chronological order, starting with the most recent. If the list is too  
long to fit on one screen, use the up/down keys to scroll through the entries one line at a  
time. Use the right arrow key to move down one screen at a time. Use the left arrow key to  
move up one screen at a time. Press CONTROL-R to refresh screen and poll the system for  
the 112 most current alarm occurrences.  
The first (Date) and second (Time) columns on the screen display the date and time  
respectively of the alarms stored in the history file.  
The third column (Access ID) identifies an entity in the Soneplex Broadband system to which  
the alarm condition pertains. Different alarm conditions result in different types of AIDs.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
The fourth column (Locn) displays NEND, FEND, REPC, or REPR indicating the location  
of the alarm. Figure 544-2 (T1 HLXC/HRX/HLXR NEND and FEND locations), Figure  
544-3 (HDSL HLXC/HRX/HLXR NEND and FEND Locations), Figure 544-4 (DLX  
NEND locations), Figure 544-5, (ODS2 NEND locations), and Figure 544-6 (RLX NEND  
and FEND Locations) show FEND, NEND, REPC, and REPR locations and descriptions  
for HLXC/HRX/HLXR, DLX, ODS2, and RLX systems.  
The sixth column (Circuit Identifier) displays the circuit or facility name assigned in the  
configuration menu.  
The seventh column (Condition) displays the alarm condition present on the circuit.  
Reference: TAP-101 Alarm Troubleshooting  
The eighth column (St or Status) displays CR (critical alarm), MJ (major alarm), MN  
(minor alarm), EV (event), or CL (alarm has cleared).  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-151  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-544  
Page 2 of 4  
ALARM HISTORY  
Legend:  
Access ID=Identifier[-]Shelf-Grp-Slot[-Site(1=Lcl,2=Rmt) | -Loop(1=Lp 1,2=Lp 2)]  
Date  
Time  
Access ID  
Locn Circuit ID  
Condition  
St  
-------- -------- ---------------- ---- -------------------- ---------------- --  
01/03/95 22:37:00 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/95 22:37:00 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/95 22:36:57 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/95 22:36:57 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/95 22:36:52 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/95 22:36:52 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/95 22:36:48 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/95 22:36:48 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/95 22:36:48 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/95 22:36:48 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/95 22:36:36 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/95 22:36:36 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/95 22:36:34 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/95 22:36:34 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/95 22:36:32 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/95 22:36:25 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/95 22:36:25 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
FEND  
FEND  
NEND  
NEND  
FEND  
FEND  
FEND  
NEND  
FEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
LOF  
LOF  
LOF  
LOF  
LOF  
LOF  
LOF  
RECOVERY  
LOF  
RECOVERY  
RECOVERY  
RECOVERY  
RECOVERY  
RECOVERY  
DC CONTINUITY  
RECOVERY  
RECOVERY  
CL  
CL  
CL  
CL  
MJ  
MJ  
CL  
CL  
CL  
CL  
MN  
MN  
CL  
CL  
CL  
MN  
MN  
Page 1 of 2  
Press CONTROL-A for assistance  
6677-A  
Figure 544-1. Alarm History Screen (Typical)  
LOCAL  
REMOTE  
(SITE = -1)  
(SITE = -2)  
DS1  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 2  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 2  
DS1  
A
FEND  
NEND  
NEND  
DS1  
FEND  
B
HLXC  
HRX  
HLXR  
DS1  
TO NETWORK  
KEY  
TO CUSTOMER  
NEND means "PM information collected directly from incoming T1 signals, both at local and remote sites."  
FEND means "ESF PRM information collected at the opposite ends of spans from the affected circuit and  
returned to the system via the ESF Datalink, both at local and remote sites".The framing format must be  
ESF in order for FEND information to be displayed.  
Note: For Site 1, FEND information is at A; for Site 2, FEND information is at B.  
10263-A  
Figure 544-2. T1 NEND and FEND Locations  
2-152  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-544  
Page 3 of 4  
CRP1  
XCVR  
RRP1  
XCVR  
CRP2  
XCVR  
RRP2  
XCVR  
NEND  
FEND  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 2  
LOOP 1  
HLXC  
HRX1  
HRX2  
HLXR  
LOOP 2  
LOOP 2  
XCVR  
CRP1  
XCVR  
RRP1  
XCVR  
CRP2  
XCVR  
RRP2  
NEND  
TO NETWORK/MUX  
FEND  
TO CUSTOMER  
KEY  
NEND means "at the HLXC, looking toward the customer (HLXR)."  
FEND means "at the HLXR, looking toward the network (HLXC)."  
CRP1 means "at the central office side of the HRX1, looking toward the network (HLXC)."  
RRP1 means "at the remote (CPE) side of the HRX1, looking toward the customer (HRX2/HLXR)."  
CRP2 means "at the central office side of the HRX2, looking toward the network (HRX1/HLXC)."  
RRP2 means "at the remote (CPE) side of the HRX2, looking toward the customer (HLXR)."  
CRP1 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 1 (TL1)  
RRP1 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 2 (TL1)  
CRP2 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 3 (TL1)  
RRP2 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 4 (TL1)  
NOTE: CRP2 and RRP2 are not present when there is no HRX2.  
11375-B  
Figure 544-3. HDSL NEND and FEND Locations  
LOCAL  
REMOTE  
(SITE = -1)  
(SITE = -2)  
NEND  
DS1  
T1  
DS1  
DLX  
DSX  
DS1  
T1  
DS1  
NEND  
TO NETWORK  
TO CUSTOMER  
KEY  
NEND means "PM information collected directly from  
incoming T1 signals, both at local and remote sites".  
10455-A  
Figure 544-4. DLX NEND Locations  
2-153  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-544  
Page 4 of 4  
LOCAL  
(SITE = -1)  
NEND  
REMOTE  
(SITE = -2)  
OPTICAL DS2  
DS1  
DS1  
DS1  
QLX  
OR  
QFLC  
ODS2  
OPTICAL DS2  
DS1  
NEND  
TO CUSTOMER  
TO NETWORK  
KEY  
NEND means "PM information collected directly from  
incoming T1 signals, both at local and remote sites".  
10456-A  
Figure 544-5. ODS2 NEND Locations  
LOCAL  
REMOTE  
(SITE = -1)  
(SITE = -2)  
NEND  
DS1  
FEND  
DS1  
T1  
Span  
Repeater  
RLX  
DS1  
T1  
DS1  
FEND  
NEND  
TO NETWORK  
TO CUSTOMER  
KEY  
NEND means "PM information collected directly from incoming T1 signals, both at  
local and remote sites".  
FEND means "ESF PM information collected at the opposite end of spans from the  
affected circuit and returned to the system via ESF datalink".The framing format  
must be ESF in order for FEND information to be displayed.  
10265-A  
Figure 544-6. RLX NEND and FEND Locations  
2-154  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-545  
Page 1 of 2  
SHELF STATUS DISPLAY  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for viewing the status of all the modules  
installed in the selected Soneplex Broadband chassis.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information about moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Display Status from the Main Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Display Shelf Status from the Display Status menu. Press  
Enter or Return. A Shelf Status screen is shown in Figure 545-1. Refer to Figure 545-2 for a  
help screen that displays a key to the Shelf Status screen.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
SHELF STATUS  
Low Speed Units (Group-Slot)  
Critical  
Shelf  
=======================================================  
1 - 2 - 3 - 4 - 5 - 6 - 7 -  
T M M  
Alarm:  
A X X ------- ------- ------- ------- ------- ------- -------  
U W P 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4  
= === ======= ======= ======= ======= ======= ======= =======  
Unit Type  
Unit Present:  
Equip State :  
Online  
Alarm(s)  
:
R + + R  
* * * *  
E E P E  
*
O
*
U
O
*
E
D
*
E
H
H
*
E
*
U
:
:
In Service :  
*
Facility  
=== ======= ======= ======= ======= ======= ======= =======  
In Service :  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
===============  
HSKP Alarm(s):  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
14870-A  
Note: A '*' in the 'Unit Present' field means that module is present  
Figure 545-1. Shelf Status Screen (Typical)  
2-155  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-545  
Page 2 of 2  
HELP SCREEN - press any key to return to MENU  
On MENU:  
Unit Type:  
Equip State:  
E - Equipped  
M - MUX  
+ - MUX-PLUS  
X - MUX-ENHANCED  
O - ODS2  
U - Unequipped  
P - Protected  
H - HLX  
R - RLX  
D - DLX  
TAU Unit Type  
T - TAU  
Q - QLX  
R - RTAU  
Control-P - Jump to previous menu  
Control-T - Jump to Main Menu  
Control-R - Refresh this current menu  
Control-A - Display this help screen  
Control-D - Terminate user session (logout)  
14855-A  
Figure 545-2. Help Screen  
2-156  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-546  
Page 1 of 2  
DS3 MUX STATUS DISPLAY  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for displaying the status of the working and  
protect Soneplex DS3 MUX modules installed in the chassis.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information about moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Display Status from the Main Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys or number keys to select Display MUX Status from the Display Status  
menu (Figure 546-1). Press Enter or Return. A detailed Display Status screen is shown in  
Figure 546-2.  
Note: DS3 RX Status displays are OK, LOS, OOF, Yellow, AIS, Idle, M13, or C-Bit.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
DISPLAY STATUS  
1. Display Shelf Status  
2. Display MUX Status  
3. Display ODS2 Status  
4. Display QLX Status  
5. Display HLX Status  
6. Display DLX Status  
7. Display RLX Status  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
9447-A  
Figure 546-1. Display Status Menu  
2-157  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-546  
Page 2 of 2  
DS3MUX STATUS  
Working Protect  
------- -------  
Unit Online  
Board Fail  
Mate Comm Fail  
RX DS3 Lpbk  
DS3 RX Status  
: YES  
: NO  
: NO  
: NO  
: OK  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
OK  
DS3 Framing Format:  
M13  
APS Status  
:
ENABLED  
APS Lockout  
:
NO  
Splitter Present :  
TAU Present  
YES  
YES  
:
Group : - 1 -  
- 2 -  
- 3 -  
- 4 -  
- 5 -  
- 6 -  
- 7 -  
Slot : 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4  
======= ======= ======= ======= ======= ======= =======  
RX DS1 Lpbk : N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N N  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6679-B  
Figure 546-2. DS3 MUX Status Screen  
2-158  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-547  
Page 1 of 1  
ODS2 MODULE STATUS DISPLAY  
Summary: Use this command to display the status of the working and protect Soneplex ODS2  
modules installed in the selected chassis.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information about moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Display Status from the Main Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Display ODS2 Status from the Display Status menu. Press  
Enter or Return. A Display ODS2 Status screen is shown in Figure 547-1.  
3. Move to the Group toggle field. Select group number 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
ODS2 STATUS  
Group: 3  
LOCAL  
REMOTE  
Working  
-------  
Protect  
-------  
Working  
-------  
Protect  
-------  
Unit Online Status: ONLINE  
HSKP1/HSKP2  
Optical Status  
Optical Comm Fail :  
:
:
N/A  
LOS  
NO  
N/A  
Laser Degrade  
Mate Comm Fail  
Config Mismatch  
:
:
:
NO  
N/A  
NO  
Version Mismatch :  
Board Fail  
Optical BER Alarm :  
NO  
NO  
NO  
:
APS Status  
APS Lockout  
:
:
ENABLED  
NO  
DS1 Number  
: 1 2 3 4  
=======  
1 2 3 4  
=======  
1 2 3 4  
=======  
1 2 3 4  
=======  
DS1 Online Status : Y Y Y Y  
DS1 Lpbk Active  
Receive DS1 LOS  
Receive DS1 AIS  
: N N N N  
: - - - -  
: - - - -  
6140-B  
Figure 547-1. ODS2 Status Screen  
2-159  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-548  
Page 1 of 5  
HLX AND HRX STATUS DISPLAY  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for displaying the status of the HLX modules  
installed in the central office chassis, the associated HLX modules at the remote end of the  
circuit, and the HRX modules.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information about moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Display HLX Status from the Display Status menu. Press Enter  
or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select HLX Status from the Display Status menu. Press Enter or  
Return. Refer to Table 548-1 for descriptions of status screens, and status locations  
displayed on the screens.  
3. Move to the Group toggle field. Select group number 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
4. Move to the Slot toggle field. Select slot number 1, 2, 3, or 4.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
Table 548-1. Status Locations  
HLXC/HLXR  
MPU SOFTWARE  
STATUS  
SCREEN  
SCREEN  
FIGURE  
STATUS  
LOCATIONS  
STATUS LOCATION  
DESCRIPTIONS  
SYSTEM TYPE VERSION  
No HRX  
V5.1  
V5.1  
HLX Status Figure 548-1 N/A  
None  
One HRX  
HLX/HRX Figure 548-2 C-SIDE,  
Figure 548-4  
Status  
HLX/HRX Figure 548-3 CRP1, RRP1, Figure 548-5  
Status CRP2, RRP2  
R-SIDE  
One or two  
HRXs  
V5.2  
Note: If one or no HRX is present in a two-repeater system, or no HRX is present in a one-repeater  
system, the screens will show “N/A” in the related HRX column.  
2-160  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-548  
Page 2 of 5  
Table 548-2. HLX and HRX Status Field Displays  
STATUS FIELD: MODULE  
DISPLAY  
DESCRIPTION  
DS1 Loopback  
ACTIVE,  
INACTIVE  
A loopback is active or has been deactivated at  
the HLXC, HRX, or HLXR.  
DS1 LOS  
YES, NO  
A loss of signal has occurred at the HLXC, HRX,  
or HLXR.  
DS1 Line Code  
DS1 Frame Format  
AMI, B8ZS, AUTO,  
N/A  
See DLP-531 for descriptions of related HLX  
configuration fields.  
UNFRAMED,  
Ft ONLY,  
ESF,  
See DLP-531 for descriptions of related HLX  
configuration fields.  
SF, N/A  
AUTO  
Loop Reversal  
HSKP1/HSKP2  
PWR1/PWR2  
YES, NO, N/A  
YES, NO, N/A  
YES, NO, N/A  
A loop reversal has occurred at the HLXC, HRX,  
or HLXR.  
Housekeeping alarms 1 and/or 2 have occurred at  
the HLXC, HRX, or HLXR.  
Power alarms 1 and/or 2 have occurred at the  
HLXC, HRX, or HLXR.  
STATUS FIELD: HDSL LOOPS DISPLAY  
DESCRIPTION  
(HDSL) Start-Up IP  
YES, NO, N/A  
MPU5.2 software or later: no HRXs or MPU 5.1  
software.  
NRM, DIS, LSW  
MPU 5.2 software or later: Normal, Disabled, or  
Loss of Synch Word at Loop 1 or Loop 2 at the  
HLXC or HLXR.  
Tip-Ring (T/R) Reversal  
SNR (Thresh) Exceeded  
YES, NO, N/A  
YES, NO, N/A  
See DLP-531 for descriptions of related HLX  
configuration fields.  
BER (Thresh) Exceeded  
Pulse Attn (dB)  
YES, NO, N/A  
See DLP-531 for descriptions of related HLX  
configuration fields.  
Range of +1 to +40  
Range of –10 to +30  
See DLP-531 for descriptions of related HLX  
configuration fields.  
SNR (margin dB)  
See DLP-531 for descriptions of related HLX  
configuration fields.  
2-161  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-548  
Page 3 of 5  
HLX/HRX STATUS  
Group: 1  
Slot: 2  
Circuit ID:  
HLXC  
HRX1  
===========  
HRX2  
===========  
N/A  
HLXR  
===========  
===========  
INACTIVE  
YES  
DS1 Loopback  
DS1 LOS  
DS1 Line Code  
:
:
:
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
INACTIVE  
YES  
AMI  
N/A  
NO  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
AMI  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
DS1 Frame Format :  
Loop Reversal  
HSKP1/HSKP2  
PWR1/PWR2  
:
:
:
NO  
NO  
N/A  
HLXC  
CRP1  
RRP1  
CRP2  
RRP2  
HLXR  
HDSL  
LP1 LP2 LP1 LP2 LP1 LP2 LP1 LP2 LP1 LP2 LP1 LP2  
=== === === === === === === === === === === ===  
NRM NRM N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A NRM NRM  
=============  
HDSL LP STAT:  
T/R Reversal:  
SNR Exceeded:  
BER Exceeded:  
Pulse Attn :  
SNR margin :  
N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A NO  
N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A NO  
+0  
+0 N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A  
+0  
+0  
+26 +26 N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A +24 +25  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
14858-A  
Note: The SNR and PA values are only updated when the HDSL loop is active. If the HDSL loop  
has never been activated, the SNR value will be set to 71, and the PA value will be set to 0.  
Figure 548-1. HLX Status Screen (MPU V5.3 Without an HRX)  
HLX/HRX STATUS  
Group: 1  
Slot: 2  
Circuit ID:  
HLXC  
HRX1  
===========  
INACTIVE  
N/A  
N/A  
HRX2  
===========  
N/A  
HLXR  
===========  
===========  
INACTIVE  
YES  
DS1 Loopback  
DS1 LOS  
DS1 Line Code  
:
:
:
INACTIVE  
YES  
AMI  
N/A  
NO  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
AMI  
N/A  
N/A  
DS1 Frame Format :  
N/A  
NO  
Loop Reversal  
HSKP1/HSKP2  
PWR1/PWR2  
:
:
:
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
NO  
NO  
HLXC  
CRP1  
RRP1  
CRP2  
RRP2  
HLXR  
HDSL  
LP1 LP2 LP1 LP2 LP1 LP2 LP1 LP2 LP1 LP2 LP1 LP2  
=== === === === === === === === === === === ===  
NRM NRM NRM NRM NRM NRM N/A N/A N/A N/A NRM NRM  
=============  
HDSL LP STAT:  
T/R Reversal:  
SNR Exceeded:  
BER Exceeded:  
Pulse Attn :  
SNR margin :  
N/A N/A NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
N/A N/A N/A N/A NO  
N/A N/A N/A N/A NO  
+0  
+0  
+0  
+0  
+0  
+0 N/A N/A N/A N/A  
+0  
+0  
+25 +25 +24 +24 +25 +25 N/A N/A N/A N/A +24 +24  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
14857-A  
Note: The SNR and PA values are only updated when the HDSL loop is active. If the HDSL loop  
has never been activated, the SNR value will be set to 71, and the PA value will be set to 0.  
Note: Figure 548-4 provides a key to the HRX status column headings shown in this figure.  
Figure 548-2. HLX/HRX Status Screen (MPU V5.3 With One HRX)  
2-162  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-548  
Page 4 of 5  
HLX/HRX STATUS  
Slot: 4 Circuit ID:  
HLXC HRX1  
Group: 1  
HRX2  
===========  
INACTIVE  
N/A  
HLXR  
===========  
INACTIVE  
YES  
===========  
INACTIVE  
YES  
===========  
INACTIVE  
N/A  
DS1 Loopback  
DS1 LOS  
DS1 Line Code  
:
:
:
AUTO-AMI  
AUTO-ESF  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
NO  
N/A  
N/A  
NO  
N/A  
AUTO-AMI  
AUTO-ESF  
YES  
N/A  
N/A  
DS1 Frame Format:  
Loop Reversal  
HSKP1/HSKP2  
PWR1/PWR2  
:
:
:
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
HLXC  
CRP1  
RRP1  
CRP2  
RRP2  
HLXR  
HDSL  
LP1 LP2 LP1 LP2 LP1 LP2 LP1 LP2 LP1 LP2 LP1 LP2  
==== ==== ==== ==== ==== ==== ==== ==== ==== ==== ==== ====  
NRM NRM NRM NRM NRM NRM NRM NRM NRM NRM NRM NRM  
==============  
HDSL IP STAT:  
T/R Reversal:  
SNR Exceeded:  
BER Exceeded:  
Pulse Attn :  
SNR margin :  
N/A N/A NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
N/A N/A NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
N/A N/A NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
+0  
+0  
+0  
+0  
+0  
+0  
+0  
+0  
+0  
+0  
+0  
+0  
+23 +23 +23 +23 +23 +23 +23 +23 +23 +23 +24 +24  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
11374-B  
Note: The SNR and PA values are only updated when the HDSL loop is active. If the HDSL loop has  
never been activated, the SNR value will be set to 71, and the PA value will be set to 0.  
Note: Figure 548-5 provides a key to the HRX status column headings shown in this figure.  
Figure 548-3. HLX/HRX Status Screen (MPU V5.3 With Two HRXs)  
REPR  
REPC  
NEND  
LOOP 1  
FEND  
LOOP 1  
XCVR  
XCVR  
HLXC  
HRX  
HLXR  
LOOP 2  
FEND  
LOOP 2  
NEND  
XCVR  
REPR  
XCVR  
REPC  
TO NETWORK  
TO CUSTOMER  
KEY  
NEND means "at the HLXC, looking toward the customer (HLXR)."  
FEND means "at the HLXR, looking toward the network (HLXC)."  
REPC means "at the HRX, looking toward the customer (HLXR)."  
REPR means "at the HRX, looking toward the network (HLXC). "  
REPR (PM Reports) = C-SIDE (Display Status) = LINE 1 (TL1)  
REPC (PM Reports) = R-SIDE (Display Status) = LINE 2 (TL1)  
9450-B  
Note: NEND and FEND are not reported in HLX/HRX Status screens  
Figure 548-4. HDSL HLXC/HLXR C-SIDE and R-SIDE Locations (MPU V5.1 With One HRX)  
2-163  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-548  
Page 5 of 5  
CRP1  
XCVR  
RRP1  
XCVR  
CRP2  
XCVR  
RRP2  
XCVR  
NEND  
FEND  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 2  
LOOP 1  
HLXC  
HRX1  
HRX2  
HLXR  
LOOP 2  
LOOP 2  
XCVR  
CRP1  
XCVR  
RRP1  
XCVR  
CRP2  
XCVR  
RRP2  
NEND  
TO NETWORK  
FEND  
TO CUSTOMER  
KEY  
NEND means "at the HLXC, looking toward the customer (HLXR)."  
FEND means "at the HLXR, looking toward the network (HLXC)."  
CRP1 means "at the central office side of the HRX1, looking toward the network (HRX2/HLXR)."  
RRP1 means "at the remote (CPE) side of the HRX1, looking toward the customer (HLXC)."  
CRP2 means "at the central office side of the HRX2, looking toward the network (HLXR)."  
RRP2 means "at the remote (CPE) side of the HRX2, looking toward the customer (HRX1/HLXC)."  
CRP1 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 1 (TL1)  
RRP1 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 2 (TL1)  
CRP2 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 3 (TL1)  
RRP2 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 4 (TL1)  
NOTE: CRP2 and RRP2 are not present when there is no HRX2.  
11375-A  
Note: NEND and FEND are not reported in HLX/HRX Status screens  
Figure 548-5. HDSL HLXC/HLXR CRP and RRP Locations (MPU V5.2 With Two HRXs)  
2-164  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-549  
Page 1 of 3  
SERIAL PORT CONFIGURATION  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for changing serial port configurations on the  
chassis to match the communications device parameters.  
Note: A “toggle” field type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the “R” key to view and select the  
previous option. An “input” field type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A “fixed” field is locked, and cannot be changed by  
the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the “R” key to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message “Configuration Successful…  
Press Any Key To Continue” appears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. From the Main Menu, use the arrow keys or number keys to select the System  
Configuration menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys or number keys to select Serial Port Configuration from the System  
Configuration menu. Press Enter or Return. A Serial Port Configuration screen is shown in  
Figure 549-1. The serial port defaults are listed Table 549-1.  
3. Use the arrow keys to move to the Craft Port Application toggle field. Use the space bar  
to select CRAFT, TBOS, TL1, or NONE.  
4. Move the cursor to the Port 1/2 Application toggle field. Use the space bar to select  
TBOS, CRAFT, TL1, or NONE. Selecting “TBOS” outputs TBOS to Port 1 (EIA-422)  
only. Selecting “CRAFT” or “TL1” outputs Craft or TL1 to Port 2 only. If Port 2 is  
configured for CRAFT, the Craft port on the front of the MPU can be configured for either  
TL1 or TBOS (EIA-232). At least one system port must be configured as Craft.  
5. Move the cursor to the Port 3 Application toggle field. Use the space bar to select X.25,  
TBOS, CRAFT, TL1, INTERNAL, or NONE. When X.25 is selected, all other fields in that  
category are shown as Not Applicable.  
Reference: DLP-558 X.25 Port Configuration  
6. Move the cursor to the Craft Port Baud Rate toggle field. Use the space bar to select  
1200, 2400, 4800, or 9600 Baud; or AUTO.  
2-165  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-549  
Page 2 of 3  
Note: The Craft port defaults to 9600 Baud. When AUTO is selected, pressing Enter or  
Return before logon will determine the communication speed (1200 19200 bps) for the  
session.  
7. Move the cursor to the Craft Port Parity toggle field. Use the space bar to select EVEN,  
ODD, or NONE.  
8. Move the cursor to the Craft Port Data Bits toggle field. Use the space bar to select 8 or 7.  
9. Move the cursor to the Craft Port Stop Bits toggle field. Use the space bar to select 1 or 2.  
10. Move the cursor to the Craft Port Flow Control toggle field. Use the space bar to select  
XON/XOFF or NONE. Craft Port defaults to NONE.  
Note: Some VT-100 terminal emulation programs for personal computers are not 100%  
VT-100 compatible, and irregularities in XON/XOFF flow control implementation may  
cause communication problems with the Soneplex MPU. If this occurs, configure the  
Flow Control field for the serial port in use to NONE. Before exiting the VT-100  
terminal emulation program, log off the Craft Interface.  
11. Move the cursor to the Craft Port Keyboard Timeout toggle field. After a specified  
period of keyboard inactivity, the user is logged off. Use the space bar to select 1, 5, 10, 15,  
30, or 45 minutes, 1 hr, or NONE. The time-out feature is active only after a port is  
configured as Craft, and takes effect only after you log off the Craft Interface and then  
logon again.  
12. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
13. Repeat Steps 6 through 12 for Port 1/2 and Port 3.  
14. If a serial port was defined for TBOS operation, move the cursor to the TBOS Mode toggle  
field and select EXPANDED (default) or COMPRESSED.  
15. If COMPRESSED TBOS mode was selected in Step 14, move the cursor to the Display 1  
Response Address input field. Set the address for TBOS compressed display 1 to any  
number from 0 through 7. The chassis will return TBOS Display 1 data when it receives a  
TBOS request for that address.  
16. If COMPRESSED TBOS mode was selected in Step 14, move the cursor to the Display 2  
Response Address input field. Set the address for TBOS compressed display 2 to any  
number from 0 through 7. The chassis will return TBOS Display 2 data when it receives a  
TBOS request for that address.  
Note: The Display 2 Response Address must be different from the Display 1 Response  
Address.  
17. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
2-166  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-549  
Page 3 of 3  
18. If you made changes to port configurations, log off and then log back on to the system to  
implement the changes.  
Reference: DLP-564 Craft Interface System Logoff  
Reference: DLP-526 Craft Interface System Logon  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
SERIAL PORT CONFIGURATION  
Port Label  
CRAFT  
PORT 1/2 PORT 3  
======== ======== ========  
Application  
Baud Rate  
Parity  
Data Bits  
Stop Bits  
Flow Control  
:
:
:
:
:
:
CRAFT  
9600  
NONE  
8
TBOS  
2400  
ODD  
8
2
NONE  
X.25  
NOT APPL  
NOT APPL  
NOT APPL  
NOT APPL  
NOT APPL  
1
NONE  
30 MIN  
Keyboard Timeout:  
NOT APPL NOT APPL  
TBOS CONFIGURATION  
TBOS Mode  
: EXPANDED  
Display 1 Response Address: NOT APPL  
Display 2 Response Address: NOT APPL  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6142-A  
Figure 549-1. Serial Port Configuration Screen  
Table 549-1. Serial Port Default Settings  
COMMUNICATION  
PARAMETER  
CRAFT PORT  
(DCE)  
PORT 1/2  
(DTE)  
PORT 3  
(DTE)  
Application  
Baud Rate  
CRAFT  
9600  
NONE  
8
TBOS  
2400  
X.25  
Not Applicable  
Not Applicable  
Not Applicable  
Not Applicable  
Not Applicable  
Not Applicable  
Parity  
ODD  
8
Data Bits  
Stop Bits  
1
2
Flow Control  
Keyboard Timeout  
NONE  
30 MIN  
NONE  
NOT APPL  
Note: For X.25 Port configuration, see DLP-558.  
2-167  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-550  
Page 1 of 2  
SHELF HOUSEKEEPING ALARM LABELS  
Summary: Use this selection to assign names to the housekeeping input alarm contacts. When a  
housekeeping alarm (door ajar, water on floor, fire alarm, etc.) occurs, the assigned name is  
displayed in the condition column of the Alarm History and Active Alarms screens. These  
conditions are also displayed in the related TL1 autonomous message.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the “R” key to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information about moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select System Configuration from the Main Menu. Press Enter or  
Return.  
2. Select Shelf Housekeeping Labels from the System Configuration menu. Press Enter or  
Return. A Shelf Housekeeping Labels screen is shown in Figure 550-1.  
3. Use the arrow keys to move to the Condition Label input fields. You may type over any  
existing alarm condition names or pressing the space bar to erase the text. Condition label  
names can be 1 to 16 characters in length. The first character must be an alpha character;  
middle characters can be alpha, numeric, or hyphens; and the last character must be either  
alpha or numeric.  
4. Assign the entry by pressing Enter or Return.  
5. Repeat Steps 3 through 4 for each alarm contact.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-168  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-550  
Page 2 of 2  
SHELF HOUSEKEEPING LABELS  
# Condition Label  
= ================  
1 HSKP1  
2 HSKP2  
3 HSKP3  
4 HSKP4  
5 HSKP5  
6 HSKP6  
7 HSKP7  
8 HSKP8  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6143-A  
Figure 550-1. Shelf Housekeeping Labels Screen  
2-169  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-551  
Page 1 of 3  
MPU SOFTWARE DOWNLOAD COMMAND  
Summary: This procedure is used to download the MPU software into an MPU module. This  
involves the transfer of two files. It requires 12 to 17 minutes to transfer both files, depending on  
the type of host computer and the communication program used.  
Caution: You must use a Version 5.X module with the Version 5.3 software.  
Caution: Perform a configuration upload first. Refer to DLP-554 (Configuration Data  
Upload Command) for more information.  
1. Log on to the Craft Interface.  
Reference: DLP-526 Craft Interface System Logon  
2. Select System Maintenance from the Main Menu using the arrow keys. Press Enter or  
Return. The System Maintenance menu displays, as shown in Figure 551-1.  
3. At the System Maintenance menu, select Upload/Download Commands. Press Enter or  
Return. The Upload/Download Commands menu displays, as shown in Figure 551-2.  
4. At the Upload/Download Commands Menu, select Execute Software Download. Press  
Enter or Return. The following message displays:  
Preparing to execute new software download...  
Are You Sure? (y/n)  
5. Begin the software download process by pressing Y for yes; or cancel the download  
process by pressing N for no.  
6. If you press Y, all indicators on the APU will be on and the MPU status indicator will flash  
yellow/green. The following message displays:  
Download In Progress  
Craft Logged Out  
Please Wait  
7. Start the program used to transfer the MPU application software from the host computer to  
the MPU.  
Note: You must use the XMODEM protocol to transfer files.  
2-170  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-551  
Page 2 of 3  
8. Enter "v50_dlp" source file name from the host computer and start the file transfer process.  
9. Enter the Version 5.3 MPU software source file name (mpu_5xxx.bin) from the host  
computer. Then start the file transfer process.  
10. During the download, observe the indicators on the MPU and APU modules. During the  
download, the MPU Status LED continually flashes green/yellow, and all APU indicators flash.  
11. If you cancel a download, repeat Step 7 and continue. If this fails, reset the MPU and restart  
this procedure from the beginning.  
Note: If the download is aborted and a "cancel" character is sent to the MPU, the MPU  
will reset for a new download attempt immediately. The cancel character is part of the  
XMODEM protocol supported by most software packages. If no cancel character is sent,  
wait two minutes before attempting another software download. The MPU takes two  
minutes to reset when no cancel character is sent.  
Note: If the new software has been loaded into the host computer, but the download  
process to the MPU has NOT been initiated, resetting the MPU allows the existing  
earlier version of Version 5 software to reboot. If the download has been initiated, the  
earlier version has been destroyed and a full download is necessary.  
12. As the Version 5.3 MPU software download proceeds, the software existing in the MPU  
module is replaced. When the download completes, the MPU automatically restarts and  
runs self-test diagnostics. The MPU status indicator lights green when the download  
completes successfully. Verify the MPU status indicator is green.  
If Yes, proceed to Step 13.  
If No, and the MPU status indicator is red, repeat Step 7 and continue.  
13. Affix the new version bar code sticker to the ejector tab of the MPU.  
14. Affix the "2X" sticker to the MPU faceplate, above and to the left of the "STATUS" LED,  
below the ADC logo.  
Note: For V5.2 or later software, this indicates the MPU recognizes and supports two  
HDSL repeaters.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-171  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-551  
Page 3 of 3  
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE  
1. Force/APS Commands  
2. Reset/LED Test Commands  
3. Execute ACO (Alarm Cut-Off)  
4. Loopback Status/Commands  
5. Display Inventory  
6. Display Circuit IDs  
7. Upload/Download Commands  
8. Test Access Unit Commands  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
5323-A  
Figure 551-1. System Maintenance Menu  
UPLOAD/DOWNLOAD COMMANDS  
1. Execute Configuration Data Upload  
2. Execute Configuration Data Download  
3. Execute Software Download  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
9449-A  
Figure 551-2. Upload/Download Commands Menu  
2-172  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-552  
Page 1 of 2  
ALARM/EVENT NOTIFICATION LEVEL SETTING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for filtering the alarm notification pop-up,  
based on the criticality of the alarm or event. When this feature is used, a beep is also heard each  
time the notification pop-up appears. Even with this feature disabled, all alarms and events are  
logged in the alarm database. The notification pop-up appears and the beep occurs any time an  
alarm occurs that is as critical or more critical than the level at which it is set.  
Note: A “toggle” field type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the “R” key to view and select the  
previous option. An “input” field type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A “fixed” field is locked, and cannot be changed by  
the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the “R” key to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message “Configuration Successful… Press Any Key  
To Continue” appears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Alarms from the Main Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Alarm/Event Notification Level from the Alarms menu. Press  
Enter or Return. An Alarm/Event Notification Level screen is shown in Figure 552-1.  
3. Use the space bar to scroll through the options, and stop at the selection you wish to enter.  
Select EVENT to allow notification of all alarms and events as they occur.  
Select MINOR to allow notification of all Minor, Major, and Critical alarms as they  
occur.  
Select MAJOR (the default) to allow notification of all Major and Critical alarms as  
they occur.  
Select CRITICAL to allow notification of all Critical alarms as they occur.  
Select DISABLED to disable the notification of all alarms and events as they occur.  
4. Assign the selection by pressing Enter or Return.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-173  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-552  
Page 2 of 2  
SET ALARM/EVENT NOTIFICATION LEVEL  
Level: MAJOR  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6144-A  
Figure 552-1. Alarm/Event Notification Level  
2-174  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-553  
Page 1 of 1  
DLX STATUS DISPLAY  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for displaying the status of the DLX modules  
installed in the selected chassis.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information about moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Display Status from the Main Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Display DLX Status from the Display Status menu. Press Enter  
or Return. A DLX Status screen is shown in Figure 553-1.  
3. Move to the Group toggle field. Select group number 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.  
4. Move to the Slot toggle field. Select slot number 1, 2, 3, or 4.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
DLX STATUS  
Group: 5  
Slot: 1  
Circuit ID:  
DS1 Lpbk Active: NO  
LOS: YES  
DS1 BER Thresh Exceeded: NO  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6145-B  
Figure 553-1. DLX Status Screen  
2-175  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-554  
Page 1 of 2  
CONFIGURATION DATA UPLOAD COMMAND  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for copying the current MPU configuration data  
to an external device (host computer) for transfer to another MPU. A host computer containing  
software that can emulate a VT-100 terminal and perform XMODEM file transfers is required.  
Use this command to save the current MPU configuration data before installing a new (i.e.,  
replacement) MPU in the chassis.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select System Maintenance from the Main Menu. Press Enter or  
Return. The System Maintenance menu is shown in Figure 554-1.  
2. At the System Maintenance menu, select Upload/Download Commands. Press Enter or  
Return. The Upload/Download Commands menu is shown in Figure 554-2.  
3. Use the arrow keys to select Execute Configuration Data Upload from the  
Upload/Download Commands menu. Press Enter or Return.  
4. The following message appears across the lower part of the screen.  
Preparing To Upload Configuration Data From MPU...  
Are You Sure? (y/n)  
5. Enable the Configuration Data Upload process by pressing Y for yes; or cancel upload by  
pressing N for no.  
6. On the host computer, start the program sequence that will transfer the data.  
Note: Files must be transferred using the XMODEM protocol.  
7. Enter a name for the file that will contain the MPU configuration data. Record the name  
assigned to the file and start the file transfer.  
Note: The file transfer will take several minutes. There are times during the transfer  
process when there are no signs of activity; this is normal.  
8. When upload is finished, control is passed back to the System Maintenance menu. Verify  
that no error message appears on the screen.  
If an error message does not appear, Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
If an error message does appears, press any key and repeat Steps 3 through 7.  
2-176  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-554  
Page 2 of 2  
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE  
1. Force/APS Commands  
2. Reset/LED Test Commands  
3. Execute ACO (Alarm Cut-Off)  
4. Loopback Status/Commands  
5. Display Inventory  
6. Display Circuit IDs  
7. Upload/Download Commands  
8. Test Access Unit Commands  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
5323-A  
Figure 554-1. System Maintenance Menu  
UPLOAD/DOWNLOAD COMMANDS  
1. Execute Configuration Data Upload  
2. Execute Configuration Data Download  
3. Execute Software Download  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
9449-A  
Figure 554-2. Upload/Download Commands Menu  
2-177  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-555  
Page 1 of 2  
CONFIGURATION DATA DOWNLOAD COMMAND  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for transferring MPU configuration data that  
was saved on an external device (host computer) back to an MPU. A host computer containing  
software that can emulate a VT-100 terminal and perform XMODEM file transfers is required.  
This procedure is used to transfer any saved MPU configuration data to a newly installed MPU.  
Caution: Any configuration database from an MPU with Version 3.1 or later software  
can be downloaded to an MPU with Version 5 software. When downloading to an MPU  
that is not running Version 5 software, the MPU software version of the source MPU  
must match the software version of the destination MPU.  
Caution: This process will modify configuration that could affect traffic. Be sure of what  
you are doing.  
Note: When 3.1 through 4.2 MPU software is loaded to a Version 5 system, the database  
is converted automatically. Parameters in Version 5 that are not in the previous version  
are left at default.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select System Maintenance from the Main Menu. Press Enter or  
Return. The System Maintenance menu is shown in Figure 555-1.  
2. At the System Maintenance menu, select Upload/Download Commands. Press Enter or  
Return. The Upload/Download Commands menu is shown in Figure 555-2.  
3. Use the arrow keys to select Execute Configuration Data Download from the  
Upload/Download Commands menu. Press Enter or Return. The following message  
appears across the lower part of the screen.  
Preparing To Download Configuration Data To MPU...  
Are You Sure? (y/n)  
4. Start the Configuration Data Download process by pressing Y for yes or cancel download  
by pressing N for no.  
5. On the host computer, start the program sequence that will transfer the data.  
Note: Files must be transferred using the XMODEM protocol.  
6. Enter the name of the file that contains the MPU configuration data and start the file  
transfer.  
Note: This transfer will take several minutes. During the transfer, some nonsense  
characters may appear at the top of your screen, but this is normal.  
2-178  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-555  
Page 2 of 2  
7. After a download is finished, a message appears to indicate whether the download was  
successful or unsuccessful.  
If successful, the MPU will reboot automatically to ensure that the configuration  
database takes effect. Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
If unsuccessful, repeat Steps 3 through 6.  
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE  
1. Force/APS Commands  
2. Reset/LED Test Commands  
3. Execute ACO (Alarm Cut-Off)  
4. Loopback Status/Commands  
5. Display Inventory  
6. Display Circuit IDs  
7. Upload/Download Commands  
8. Test Access Unit Commands  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
5323-A  
Figure 555-1. System Maintenance Menu  
UPLOAD/DOWNLOAD COMMANDS  
1. Execute Configuration Data Upload  
2. Execute Configuration Data Download  
3. Execute Software Download  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
9449-A  
Figure 555-2. Upload/Download Commands Menu  
2-179  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-556  
Page 1 of 3  
DS1 PM CONFIGURATION  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for assigning thresholds for each DS1 in the  
Soneplex Broadband system. You can also view or edit the DS1 Performance Monitoring  
configuration for each DS1 in the Soneplex Broadband system from this screen. Not all modules  
support Performance Monitoring.  
Note: A “toggle” field type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the “R” key to view and select the  
previous option. An “input” field type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A “fixed” field is locked, and cannot be changed by  
the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the “R” key to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message “Configuration Successful… Press Any Key  
To Continue” appears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Performance Monitoring from the Main Menu. Press Enter or  
Return. A Performance Monitoring menu appears.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select DS1 PM Configuration from the PM Configuration menu.  
Press Enter or Return. A DS1 PM Configuration screen is shown in Figure 556-1.  
3. Move to the Group toggle field. Select group number 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.  
4. Move to the Slot toggle field. Select slot number 1, 2, 3, or 4.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
5. Move to the Mon Type Threshold toggle fields. Enter the value for each field that you  
wish to change based on ranges and default values for each Mon Type listed in  
Table 556-1. Ranges are also listed at the bottom of the DS1 PM Configuration screen.  
Reference: TAP-102 Performance Monitoring Reports Description  
2-180  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-556  
Page 2 of 3  
6. Move to the Mon Type Alarms toggle fields. The following selections are possible:  
• Critical Allows notification of all Critical, Major, Minor, and Event alarms as they  
occur.  
• Major  
• Minor  
• Event  
Allows notification of all Major, Minor, and Event alarms as they occur.  
Allows notification of all Minor and Event alarms as they occur.  
Allows notification of all events as they occur.  
Reference: TAP-101 Alarm Troubleshooting  
7. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
8. Repeat Steps 3 through 7 for each applicable DS1 signal in the chassis.  
Note: Pressing CONTROL-C and confirming with the Y key removes all threshold  
values and alarm level information from the database for the group and slot selected.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
DS1 PERFORMANCE MONITORING CONFIGURATION  
Group: 1 Circuit: 1 Circuit ID:  
15 MINUTE  
MON ============== ================  
TYPE THRSH ALM LVL THRSH ALM LVL  
==== ===== ======== ======= ========  
FCP 5 EVENT 480 EVENT  
CVL 13340 EVENT 133400 EVENT  
DAILY  
15 MINUTE  
============== ================  
THRSH ALM LVL THRSH ALM LVL  
DAILY  
MON  
TYPE  
======== ===== ======== ======= ========  
AISSP  
10  
5
65  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
100  
480  
648  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
FCP-FE  
ESL-FE  
CVP-FE  
ESP-FE  
ESL 65  
SESL 10  
LOSS 10  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
648  
100  
100  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
13340 EVENT  
133400 EVENT  
65  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
648  
100  
100  
100  
100  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
CVP 13340 EVENT  
133400 EVENT  
SESP-FE 10  
UASP-FE 10  
CSSP-FE 10  
SEFSP-FE 10  
ESP 65  
SESP 10  
UASP 10  
SASP 10  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
648  
100  
100  
100  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
CVs PER SESL: 1544 CVs PER SESP: 330 CVs PER SESP-FE: 330  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance, CONTROL-C To Clear All PM Counts  
6146-B  
* Indicates valid range of values for selected field. See Table 556-1.  
Figure 556-1. DS1 PM Configuration Screen  
2-181  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-556  
Page 3 of 3  
Table 556-1. DS1 Threshold-Crossing Defaults and Range Values  
LINE/PATH (NEND) THRESHOLDS  
15-MINUTE  
15-MINUTE  
DEFAULT  
DAILY VALID  
RANGE  
MON TYPE  
FCP  
VALID RANGE  
DAILY DEFAULT  
5
13340  
65  
1 to 5  
480  
133400  
648  
1 to 480  
1 to 1048575  
1 to 65535  
1 to 4095  
CVL  
1 to 16383  
1 to 900  
ESL  
SESL  
LOSS  
CVP  
10  
1 to 63  
100  
10  
1 to 63  
100  
1 to 4095  
13340  
65  
1 to 16383  
1 to 900  
133400  
648  
1 to 1048575  
1 to 65535  
1 to 4095  
ESP  
SESP  
UASP  
SASP  
AISSP  
10  
1 to 63  
100  
10  
1 to 63  
100  
1 to 4095  
10  
1 to 63  
100  
1 to 4095  
10  
1 to 63  
100  
1 to 4095  
LINE/PATH (FEND) THRESHOLDS  
15-MINUTE  
DEFAULT  
15-MINUTE  
DAILY VALID  
RANGE  
MON TYPE  
FCP-FE  
VALID RANGE  
1 to 5  
DAILY DEFAULT  
5
65  
480  
648  
1 to 480  
1 to 65535  
1 to 1048575  
1 to 65535  
1 to 4095  
1 to 4095  
1 to 4095  
1 to 4095  
ESL-FE  
1 to 63  
CVP-FE  
ESP-FE  
13340  
65  
1 to 16383  
1 to 900  
1 to 63  
133400  
100  
SESP-FE  
UASP-FE  
CSS-FE  
10  
100  
10  
1 to 63  
100  
10  
1 to 63  
100  
SEFSP-FE  
10  
1 to 63  
100  
INTERNAL PARAMETER THRESHOLDS  
MON TYPE  
DEFAULT  
1544  
320  
VALID RANGE  
CVs per SESL  
CVs per SESP  
1544 to 8000  
320 to 333  
320 to 333  
CVs per SESP-FE  
320  
Note: refer to TAP-102 for Mon Type descriptions.  
2-182  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-557  
Page 1 of 3  
HDSL PM CONFIGURATION  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for assigning thresholds for each HDSL facility  
in the Soneplex Broadband system. You can also view or edit the HDSL Performance  
Monitoring configuration for each HDSL facility in the Soneplex Broadband system from this  
screen.  
Note: A “toggle” field type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the “R” key to view and select the  
previous option. An “input” field type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A “fixed” field is locked, and cannot be changed by  
the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the “R” key to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message “Configuration Successful…  
Press Any Key To Continue” appears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Performance Monitoring from the Main Menu. Press Enter or  
Return. A Performance Monitoring selection menu appears.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select HDSL PM Configuration from the PM Configuration menu. Press  
Enter or Return. An HDSL PM Configuration menu is shown in Figure 557-1.  
3. Move to the Group toggle field. Select group number 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.  
4. Move to the Slot toggle field. Select slot number 1, 2, 3, or 4.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
5. Move to the Mon Type Threshold toggle fields. Enter the value for each field that you wish to  
change based on ranges and default values for each Mon Type listed in Table 557-1. Ranges are  
also listed on the HDSL PM Configuration screen.  
Reference: TAP-102 Performance Monitoring Reports Description  
2-183  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-557  
Page 2 of 3  
6. Move to the Mon Type Alarms toggle fields. The following selections are possible:  
Critical Allows notification of all Critical alarms as they occur.  
Major  
Minor  
Event  
Allows notification of all Major and Critical alarms as they occur.  
Allows notification of all Minor, Major, and Critical alarms as they occur.  
Allows notification of all alarms and events as they occur.  
Reference: TAP-101 Alarm Troubleshooting  
7. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
8. Repeat Steps 3 through 7 for each HDSL facility in the chassis.  
Note: Pressing CONTROL-C and confirming with Y removes all threshold values and  
alarm level information from the database for the group and slot selected.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
HDSL PERFORMANCE MONITORING CONFIGURATION  
Group: 6 Circuit: 1 Circuit ID:  
15 MINUTE  
DAILY  
=================== ===================  
MONTYPE THRESHOLD ALM LEVEL THRESHOLD ALM LEVEL  
======= ========= ========= ========= =========  
FCP  
CVP  
ESP  
SESP  
SEFSP  
5
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
480  
67579  
648  
100  
100  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
EVENT  
6893  
65  
10  
10  
CVs PER SES: 165  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance, CONTROL-C To Clear All PM Counts  
6147-B  
Figure 557-1. HDSL PM Configuration Screen (Typical)  
2-184  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-557  
Page 3 of 3  
Table 557-1. HDSL Threshold-Crossing Default and Range Values  
PATH THRESHOLDS (ALL LOCATIONS)  
15-MINUTE  
15-MINUTE  
DAILY  
DAILY VALID  
RANGE  
MON TYPE  
FCP  
DEFAULT  
VALID RANGE  
DEFAULT  
5
6893  
65  
1 to 5  
480  
67579  
648  
1 to 480  
1 to 1048575  
1 to 65535  
1 to 65535  
1 to 65535  
CVP  
1 to 65535  
ESP  
1 to 900  
1 to 900  
SESP  
SEFSP  
10  
100  
10  
1 to 900  
100  
INTERNAL PARAMETER THRESHOLDS  
DEFAULT  
MON TYPE  
VALID RANGE  
CVs per SES  
165  
165 to 167  
Note: refer to TAP-102 for Mon Type descriptions.  
2-185  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-558  
Page 1 of 3  
X.25 PORT CONFIGURATION  
Summary: Use this procedure to set several parameters that must be set before using the X.25  
interface. Table 558-1, Table 558-2, and Table 558-3 outline the X.25 interface parameters and  
detailed technical specifications that are supported by the Soneplex Broadband system.  
Data Link Layer LAPB Parameters  
The Soneplex Broadband system data link layer uses the standard Link Access Procedure Balanced  
(LAPB) protocol. Parameters supported, set values, configurable options, and defaults are shown in  
Table 558-1.  
Network Layer X.25 Packet Parameters  
The Soneplex Broadband system now supports three Virtual Circuits, including two Permanent  
Virtual Circuits (PVCs) (each assigned to a separate TL1 or Craft interface), and one Switched  
Virtual Circuit (SVC). The X.25 interface operates only on Port 3. The PVC ID default  
assignments are shown in Table 558-2.  
Other Network Parameters  
Other supported network parameters, set values, configurable options, and defaults are shown in  
Table 558-3.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the “R” key to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) by pressing an arrow key and then the Enter or Return key once; or 2) by  
pressing the Enter or Return key twice after all selections and entries are made in the  
screen but before leaving the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select System Configuration from the Main Menu. Press Enter or  
Return.  
2. Select X.25 Configuration and press Enter or Return. An X.25 Configuration screen is  
shown in Figure 558-1.  
3. Use the arrow keys to move to each toggle field, and the space bar to make each selection.  
X.25 Configuration field defaults and options are listed in Tables 558-1, 558-2, and 558-3.  
2-186  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-558  
Page 2 of 3  
4. Repeat Step 3 for each field that you wish to change.  
5. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
6. Momentarily press RESET on the MPU front panel, or perform a soft reset, in order to re-  
initialize the X.25 configurations.  
Reference: DLP-519 MPU Replacement and Testing  
Reference: DLP-538 Reset/LED Test Commands  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
Table 558-1. Data Link Layer LAPB Parameters  
SET  
CONFIGURABLE  
DEFAULT  
DATA LINK PARAMETER  
Address Field Assignment *  
Modulo  
VALUE  
RANGE  
DTE, DCE (A=1, B=3)  
DTE (A=3, B=1)  
8
Window Size (K) *  
1 to 7 frames  
1080, 2104 bits  
2 - 16  
7
2104  
7
Frame Size (Bits per I frame) *  
N2 (retransmission count) *  
T1 (retry timer) *  
2 to 20 seconds  
3 seconds  
T2 (response delay timer)  
T3 (not supported)  
0.3 seconds  
T4 (not supported)  
* These are user-programmable parameters through the Craft Interface.  
Table 558-2. Virtual Circuit Default Assignments  
VIRTUAL  
CIRCUIT  
CIRCUIT  
TYPE  
LOGICAL  
CHANNEL #  
APPLICATION  
TL1  
1
2
3
PVC  
PVC  
SVC  
1
2
Craft  
N/A  
N/A  
Note: Autonomous messages are always sent except when  
inhibited by the TL1 INH-MSG command.  
2-187  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-558  
Page 3 of 3  
Table 558-3. Network Layer X.25 Packet Parameters  
SET  
CONFIGURABLE  
DEFAULT  
NETWORK PARAMETER  
PVC Logical Channel # *  
Modulo  
VALUE  
RANGE  
1 - 255  
See Table 558-2  
8
Packet Size *  
128, 256 octets  
1 - 7  
128  
2
Window Size *  
M bit Support  
Yes  
Q bit Support (not supported)  
D bit Support *  
No, Yes  
Yes  
Keyboard Time-Out  
N/A for TL1; 0 minute,  
1 minute, 5 minute,  
30 minute  
10 minute, 15 minute,  
30 minute, 45 minute, 1 hour  
SVC Craft Address  
SVC TL1 Address  
Up to 15 contiguous  
digits, each 0 to 9 or blank  
(blank)  
(blank)  
Up to 15 contiguous digits,  
each 0 to 9 or blank  
* These are user programmable parameters through the Craft Interface.  
X.25 CONFIGURATION  
Data Link (LAPB) Parameters  
======================================================  
Address Field Assignment: DTE  
Window Size: 7  
N2: 7  
T1: 3 seconds  
Frame Size: 2104 bits  
Network Layer Parameters  
========================================  
Virtual Circuit -  
1
2
3
====== ====== ======  
Circuit Type: PVC  
Logical Channel: 1  
Application: TL1  
PVC  
2
CRAFT  
128  
2
SVC  
N/A  
N/A  
128  
2
Packet Size: 128  
Window Size: 2  
D-bit Support: YES  
Keyboard Timeout: N/A  
YES  
YES  
30 MIN 30 MIN  
SVC Craft Address:  
SVC TL1 Address:  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6148-D  
Figure 558-1. X.25 Port Configuration (with Default Settings)  
2-188  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-559  
Page 1 of 2  
MPU ALARM LEVEL SETTING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for setting MPU Alarm Levels.  
Note: A “toggle” field type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the “R” key to view and select the  
previous option. An “input” field type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A “fixed” field is locked, and cannot be changed by  
the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the “R” key to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message “Configuration Successful…  
Press Any Key To Continue” appears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Alarms from the Main Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Set Alarm Levels from the Alarms menu. Press Enter or  
Return.  
3. Select Set MPU Alarm Levels from the Set Alarm Levels Menu. Press Enter or Return. An  
MPU Alarm Levels screen with default values is shown in Figure 559-1.  
4. At the Equipment/Shelf Alarms toggle fields, select CRITICAL (CR), MAJOR (MJ),  
MINOR (MN), EVENT (EV) or NOT RPTD (not reported) for each field that you wish to  
change.  
Note: Abbreviations of the alarm field options (except NOT RPTD) will appear in the  
Active Alarms and Alarm History screens. In addition, what options you select at any  
alarm level setting screen will determine whether you will be notified of the alarm.  
Reference: DLP-552 Alarm/Event Notification Level Setting  
5. Move to the External Alarms toggle fields. Select CRITICAL, MAJOR, MINOR, EVENT  
or NOT RPTD for each field that you wish to change.  
Reference: TAP-101 Alarm Troubleshooting  
6. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-189  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-559  
Page 2 of 2  
MPU ALARM LEVELS  
Equipment/Shelf Alarms  
===============================================  
CGA : CRITICAL GRP MISMATCH: MINOR  
POWER : MAJOR  
APU FAIL : MAJOR  
External Alarms  
===============================================  
HSKP1  
HSKP2  
HSKP3  
HSKP4  
: MINOR  
: MINOR  
: MINOR  
: MINOR  
HSKP5  
HSKP6  
HSKP7  
HSKP8  
: MINOR  
: MINOR  
: MINOR  
: MINOR  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6149-C  
Figure 559-1. MPU Alarm Levels (with Default Settings)  
2-190  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-560  
Page 1 of 2  
DS3 MUX ALARM LEVEL SETTING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for setting DS3 MUX Alarm Levels.  
Note: A “toggle” field type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the “R” key to view and select the  
previous option. An “input” field type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A “fixed” field is locked, and cannot be changed by  
the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the “R” key to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message “Configuration Successful… Press Any Key  
To Continue” appears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Alarms from the Main Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Set Alarm Levels from the Alarms menu. Press Enter or Return.  
3. Select Set MUX Alarm Levels from the Set Alarm Levels menu. Press Enter or Return. A  
DS3 MUX Alarm Levels screen is shown in Figure 560-1.  
4. At the Equipment Alarms toggle fields, select CRITICAL (CR), MAJOR (MJ), MINOR  
(MN), EVENT (EV) or NOT RPTD (not reported) for each field that you wish to change.  
Note: Abbreviations of the alarm field options (except NOT RPTD) will appear in the  
Active Alarms and Alarm History screens. In addition, what options you select at any  
alarm level setting screen will determine whether you will be notified of the alarm.  
Reference: DLP-552  
Alarm/Event Notification Level Setting  
5. Move to the MUX Facility Alarms toggle fields. Select CRITICAL, MAJOR, MINOR, or  
EVENT for each field that you wish to change.  
Note: Default values are shown in Table 560-1.  
Reference: TAP-101 Alarm Troubleshooting  
6. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-191  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-560  
Page 2 of 2  
DS3MUX ALARM LEVELS  
Equipment Alarms  
===========================  
BOARD FAIL  
COMM FAIL  
: MAJOR  
: MAJOR  
PROTECT COMM FAIL: MINOR  
MUX Facility Alarms  
===========================  
FORCE TO WORKING : MINOR  
FORCE TO PROTECT : MINOR  
APS LIMIT  
DS3 LOS  
DS3 LOF  
DS3 AIS  
DS3 YELLOW  
DS3 IDLE  
: MINOR  
: MAJOR  
: MAJOR  
: MAJOR  
: MINOR  
: MINOR  
DS3 LOOPED BACK : MINOR  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6682-B  
Figure 560-1. DS3 MUX Alarm Levels  
Table 560-1. DS3 MUX Alarm Level Defaults  
EQUIPMENT ALARMS  
ALARM TYPE DEFAULT  
CONDITION  
ONLINE  
Major  
Major  
Minor  
OFFLINE  
Minor  
Minor  
Event  
BOARD FAIL  
COMM FAIL  
PROTECT COMM FAIL  
DS3 FACILITY ALARMS  
ALARM TYPE DEFAULT  
CONDITION  
ONLINE  
OFFLINE  
Event  
Event  
Event  
Minor  
Minor  
Minor  
Event  
Event  
Event  
FORCE TO WORKING  
FORCE TO PROTECT  
APS LIMIT  
Minor  
Minor  
Minor  
Major  
Major  
Major  
Minor  
Minor  
Minor  
DS3 LOS  
DS3 LOF  
DS3 AIS  
DS3 YELLOW  
DS3 IDLE  
DS3 LOOPED BACK  
2-192  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-561  
Page 1 of 3  
ODS2 MODULE ALARM LEVEL SETTING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for setting ODS2 Alarm Levels.  
Note: A “toggle” field type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the “R” key to view and select the  
previous option. An “input” field type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A “fixed” field is locked, and cannot be changed by  
the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the “R” key to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message “Configuration Successful…  
Press Any Key To Continue” appears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Alarms from the Main Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Set Alarm Levels from the Alarms menu. Press Enter or  
Return.  
3. Select Set ODS2 Alarm Levels from the Set Alarm Levels Menu. Press Enter or Return. An  
ODS2 Alarm Levels screen is shown in Figure 561-1.  
4. Move to the Group toggle field. Select group number 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
5. Move to the Equipment Alarms toggle fields. Select CRITICAL (CR), MAJOR (MJ),  
MINOR (MN), EVENT (EV) or NOT RPTD (not reported) for each field that you wish to  
change.  
Note: Abbreviations of the alarm field options (except NOT RPTD) will appear in the  
Active Alarms and Alarm History screens. In addition, what options you select at any  
alarm level setting screen will determine whether you will be notified of the alarm.  
Reference: DLP-552 Alarm/Event Notification Level Setting  
6. Move to the DS2 Facility Alarms toggle fields. Select CRITICAL, MAJOR, MINOR,  
EVENT, or NOT RPTD for each field that you wish to change.  
2-193  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-561  
Page 2 of 3  
7. Move to the DS1 Facility Alarms toggle fields. Select CRITICAL, MAJOR, MINOR,  
EVENT, or NOT RPTD for each field that you wish to change.  
Reference: TAP-101 Alarm Troubleshooting  
Note: Default values are listed in Table 561-1.  
8. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure..  
ODS2 ALARM LEVELS  
Group: 3  
Equipment Alarms  
==============================================================  
BOARD FAIL  
COMM FAIL  
CONFIG MISMATCH: MINOR  
HSKP1 : MINOR  
: MAJOR  
: MAJOR  
PROTECT COMM FAIL: MINOR  
REMOTE COMM FAIL : MINOR  
VERSION MISMATCH : MINOR  
HSKP2  
: MINOR  
DS2 Facility Alarms  
==============================================================  
APS LIMIT  
: MINOR  
OPTICAL LOF  
OPTICAL LOS  
T-BER  
: MAJOR  
: MAJOR  
: MINOR  
FORCE TO WORK : MINOR  
FORCE TO PROT : MINOR  
LASER DEGRADE : MINOR  
DS1 Facility Alarms  
DS1 #1  
DS1 #2  
DS1 #3  
DS1 #4  
======================== ========= ========= ========= =======  
LOOPED BACK  
RECEIVE LOS  
TRANSMIT EXZ  
RECEIVE AIS  
:
:
:
:
MINOR  
MAJOR  
MINOR  
EVENT  
MINOR  
MAJOR  
MINOR  
EVENT  
MINOR  
MAJOR  
MINOR  
EVENT  
MINOR  
MAJOR  
MINOR  
EVENT  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6152-C  
Figure 561-1. ODS2 Alarm Levels Screen  
2-194  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-561  
Page 3 of 3  
Table 561-1. ODS2 Alarm Level Defaults  
EQUIPMENT ALARMS  
ALARM TYPE DEFAULT  
CONDITION  
ONLINE  
Major  
Major  
Minor  
Minor  
Minor  
Minor  
Minor  
OFFLINE  
Minor  
Minor  
Event  
Event  
Event  
Event  
Event  
BOARD FAIL  
COMM FAIL  
CONFIG MISMATCH  
HSKP1  
PROTECT COMM FAIL  
OPTICAL COMM FAIL  
VERSION MISMATCH  
DS2 FACILITY ALARMS  
ALARM TYPE DEFAULT  
CONDITION  
ONLINE  
Minor  
Minor  
Minor  
Minor  
Major  
Major  
Minor  
OFFLINE  
Event  
Event  
Event  
Event  
Minor  
Minor  
Event  
APS LIMIT  
FORCE TO WORK  
FORCE TO PROT  
LASER DEGRADE  
OPTICAL LOF  
OPTICAL LOS  
T-BER  
DS1 FACILITY ALARMS  
ALARM TYPE DEFAULT  
CONDITION  
ONLINE  
Minor  
Major  
Major  
OFFLINE  
Event  
LOOPED BACK  
RECEIVE LOS  
TRANSMIT LOS  
Minor  
Minor  
2-195  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-562  
Page 1 of 3  
HLX ALARM LEVEL SETTING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for setting HLX Alarm Levels.  
Note: A “toggle” field type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the “R” key to view and select the  
previous option. An “input” field type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A “fixed” field is locked, and cannot be changed by  
the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the “R” key to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message “Configuration Successful…  
Press Any Key To Continue” appears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Alarms from the Main Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Set Alarm Levels from the Alarms menu. Press Enter or  
Return.  
3. Select Set HLX Alarm Levels from the Set Alarm Levels Menu. Press Enter or Return. An  
HLX Alarm Levels screen is shown in Figure 562-1.  
4. Move to the Group toggle field. Select group number 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.  
5. Move to the Slot toggle field. Select slot number 1, 2, 3, or 4.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
6. Move to the Equipment Alarms toggle fields. Select CRITICAL (CR), MAJOR (MJ),  
MINOR (MN), EVENT (EV) or NOT RPTD (not reported) for each field that you wish to  
change.  
Note: Abbreviations of the alarm field options (except NOT RPTD) will appear in the  
Active Alarms and Alarm History screens. In addition, what options you select at any  
alarm level setting screen will determine whether you will be notified of the alarm.  
Reference: DLP-552 Alarm/Event Notification Level Setting  
7. Move to the DS1 Facility Alarms toggle fields. Select CRITICAL, MAJOR, MINOR,  
EVENT, or NOT RPTD for each field that you wish to change.  
2-196  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-562  
Page 2 of 3  
8. Move to the HDSL Facility Alarms toggle fields. Select CRITICAL, MAJOR, MINOR,  
EVENT, or NOT RPTD for each field that you wish to change.  
Reference: TAP-101 Alarm Troubleshooting  
9. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
HLX ALARM LEVELS  
Group: 6  
Slot: 1  
Equipment Alarms  
=============================================================================  
COMM FAIL  
LOOP REVERSAL  
TP/RNG REVERSAL : EVENT  
: MAJOR  
: EVENT  
HSKP1  
HSKP2  
: MINOR  
: MINOR  
PRIMARY POWER  
SECONDARY POWER : MAJOR  
VERSION MISMATCH: MAJOR  
: MAJOR  
DS1 Facility Alarms  
=============================================================================  
AIS  
: EVENT  
LOF  
LOS  
: MAJOR  
: MAJOR  
T-BERL  
YELLOW  
: MINOR  
: EVENT  
CUSTOMER LOOPBACK: MINOR  
NETWORK LOOPBACK : MINOR  
HDSL Facility Alarms  
=============================================================================  
DC CONTINUITY  
LOF FE  
LOF NE  
: MAJOR  
: MAJOR  
: MAJOR  
: MINOR  
T-BERP FE: MINOR  
T-BERP NE: MINOR  
T-PA FE : EVENT  
T-PA NE : EVENT  
T-SNR FE  
T-SNR NE  
: EVENT  
: EVENT  
RECOVERY  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6153-C  
Figure 562-1. HLX Alarm Levels Screen (with Default Values)  
2-197  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-562  
Page 3 of 3  
Table 562-1. HLX Alarm Level Defaults  
EQUIPMENT ALARMS  
ALARM TYPE DEFAULT  
CONDITION  
COMM FAIL  
Major  
Minor  
Minor  
Event  
Event  
Major  
Major  
HSKP1  
HSKP2  
LOOP REVERSAL  
TP/RNG REVERSAL  
PRIMARY POWER  
SECONDARY POWER  
DS1 FACILITY ALARMS  
CONDITION  
AIS  
ALARM TYPE DEFAULT  
Event  
LOOPBACK  
LOF  
Minor  
Major  
LOS  
Major  
T-BERL  
YELLOW  
Minor  
Event  
HDSL FACILITY ALARMS  
CONDITION  
DC CONTINUITY  
LOF FE  
ALARM TYPE DEFAULT  
Major  
Major  
LOF NE  
Major  
RECOVERY  
T-BERP FE  
T-BERP NE  
T-PA FE  
Minor  
Minor  
Minor  
Event  
T-PA NE  
Event  
T-SNR FE  
T-SNR NE  
Event  
Event  
2-198  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-563  
Page 1 of 2  
DLX ALARM LEVEL SETTING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for setting DLX Alarm Levels.  
Note: A “toggle” field type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the “R” key to view and select the  
previous option. An “input” field type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A “fixed” field is locked, and cannot be changed by  
the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the “R” key to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message “Configuration Successful…  
Press Any Key To Continue” appears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select Alarms from the Main Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Set Alarm Levels from the Alarms menu. Press Enter or  
Return.  
3. Select Set DLX Alarm Levels from the Set Alarm Levels Menu. Press Enter or Return. A  
DLX Alarm Levels screen with default values is shown in Figure 563-1.  
4. Move to the Group toggle field. Select group number 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.  
5. Move to the Slot toggle field. Select slot number 1, 2, 3, or 4.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
6. Move to the Equipment Alarms toggle fields. Select CRITICAL (CR), MAJOR (MJ),  
MINOR (MN), EVENT (EV) or NOT RPTD (not reported) for each field that you wish to  
change.  
Note: Abbreviations of the alarm field options (except NOT RPTD) will appear in the  
Active Alarms and Alarm History screens. In addition, what options you select at any  
alarm level setting screen will determine whether you will be notified of the alarm.  
Reference: DLP-552 Alarm/Event Notification Level Setting  
2-199  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-563  
Page 2 of 2  
7. Move to the DS1 Facility Alarms toggle fields. Select CRITICAL, MAJOR, MINOR,  
EVENT, or NOT RPTD for each field that you wish to change.  
Reference: TAP-101 Alarm Troubleshooting  
8. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
DLX ALARM LEVELS  
Group: 5  
Slot: 1  
Equipment Alarms  
==========================  
COMM FAIL  
: MAJOR  
DS1 Facility Alarms  
==========================  
CUSTOMER LOOPBACK: MINOR  
NETWORK LOOPBACK : MINOR  
LOS  
T-BERL  
: MAJOR  
: MINOR  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6154-B  
Figure 563-1. DLX Alarm Level Defaults  
2-200  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-564  
Page 1 of 1  
CRAFT INTERFACE SYSTEM LOGOFF  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for logging off the Craft Interface system.  
1. Press CONTROL-D to log off.  
Note: You will be logged off automatically if a period of keyboard inactivity exceeds a  
threshold (default is 30 minutes). You can change this threshold at the Serial Port  
Configuration menu. The change will take effect the next time you log on the Craft  
Interface.  
2. If you are using a terminal, turn the power off. If using a host computer, exit the  
communications software, then turn the power off.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-201  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-565  
Page 1 of 3  
PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTS RETRIEVAL  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for retrieving DS1 and HDSL 15-Minute PM,  
Daily PM, and Summary PM reports. Performance Monitoring reports are based on the data  
contained in the MPU memory.  
1. Log on to the Craft Interface.  
Reference: DLP-526 Craft Interface System Logon  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Performance Monitoring from the Main Menu. Press Enter or  
Return. A Performance Monitoring menu is shown in Figure 565-1.  
3. Use the arrow keys to select PM Reports from the Performance Monitoring menu. Press  
Enter or Return. A Performance Monitoring Reports menu is shown in Figure 565-2.  
4. Select DS1 PM Reports or HDSL PM Reports from the Performance Monitoring Reports  
menu. A sample DS1 PM Reports selection screen is shown in Figure 565-3.  
5. Move to the Group toggle field. Select group number 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7.  
6. Move to the Circuit toggle field. Select slot number 1, 2, 3, or 4.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
7. If you selected DS1 PM Reports, move to the Site toggle field. Select LOCAL or  
REMOTE.  
8. If you selected HDSL PM Reports, move to the Loop toggle field. Select 1 or 2.  
9. Move to the Report Type toggle field. Select one of the following report types:  
15 Minute Performance Monitoring Report – This report displays the Mon Type PM  
data for the current 15 minute period and the previous thirty-two 15 minute periods.  
Daily Performance Monitoring Report – This report displays the Mon Type PM data  
for the current day and the previous seven 24 hour periods.  
Summary Performance Monitoring Report –This report displays the Mon Type PM  
data for the current 15 minute period, previous 15 minute period, current day, and  
previous day.  
10. Press Enter or Return to display the report.  
Note: At this time, the only output format available is on the screen.  
Reference: TAP-102 Performance Monitoring Reports Description  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-202  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-565  
Page 2 of 3  
PERFORMANCE MONITORING  
1. PM Configuration  
2. PM Reports  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
9448-A  
Figure 565-1. Performance Monitoring Menu  
PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTS  
1. DS1 PM Reports  
2. HDSL PM Reports  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
10389-A  
Figure 565-2. Performance Monitoring Reports Menu  
2-203  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-565  
Page 3 of 3  
DS1 PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTS  
Group: 6  
Circuit: 1  
Site: LOCAL  
Report Type: 15-MINUTE  
Circuit ID:  
Modify Fields Above To Select Desired Report, Then Press RETURN  
10391-A  
Figure 565-3. Sample DS1 Performance Monitoring Reports Selection Screen  
2-204  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-566  
Page 1 of 1  
CIRCUIT ID DISPLAY  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for displaying the Access ID (AID), Circuit ID,  
and the Unit Type for each module installed in the Soneplex Broadband chassis.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information about moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow keys to select System Maintenance from the Main Menu. Press Enter or  
Return.  
2. Use the arrow keys to select Display Circuit IDs from the System Maintenance menu. Press  
Enter or Return. A Display Circuit ID menu is shown in Figure 566-1.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
DISPLAY CIRCUIT ID MENU  
TID : ADC  
AID  
Circuit ID  
Unit Type  
AID  
Circuit ID  
Unit Type  
======= ==================== ========= ======= ==================== =========  
1-1-1-1  
1-1-2-1  
1-1-3-1  
1-1-4-1  
1-2-1-1  
1-2-2-1  
1-2-3-1  
1-2-4-1  
1-3-1-1  
1-3-2-1  
1-3-3-1  
1-3-4-1  
1-4-1-1  
1-4-2-1  
RLX  
1-4-3-1  
1-4-4-1  
1-5-1-1  
1-5-2-1  
1-5-3-1  
1-5-4-1  
1-6-1-1  
1-6-2-1  
1-6-3-1  
1-6-4-1  
1-7-1-1  
1-7-2-1  
1-7-3-1  
1-7-4-1  
NONE  
NONE  
DLX  
NONE  
NONE  
NONE  
HLX  
NONE  
NONE  
NONE  
HLX  
NONE  
NONE  
NONE  
NONE  
NONE  
NONE  
NONE  
NONE  
NONE  
NONE  
ODS2  
ODS2  
ODS2  
ODS2  
NONE  
NONE  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6155-B  
Figure 566-1. Display Circuit ID Screen  
2-205  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-567  
Page 1 of 2  
RLX (OR RXLIOR) TO REPEATER VOLTAGE AND CURRENT TEST  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for measuring DC voltage and DC current being  
supplied by the RLX or RLXIOR module to the T1 span repeater. The V+, V–, I+, and I– jacks  
provide monitor access to the voltage and current supplied to the repeater through the DS1 span.  
Measurements are taken at the test jacks on the RLX module front panel across a 10 ohm  
resistor.  
Measure DC Voltage  
1. Refer to Figure 567-1 for an RLX front panel drawing. Select –VDC on the VOM and, if so  
equipped, select a voltage scale of 0 to 200 volts.  
2. Insert the black test probe into the V– test jack, and insert the red test probe into the V+ test  
jack. Record the DC voltage for future reference.  
Measure DC Current  
3. Select –VDC on the VOM and, if so equipped, select the millivolt scale. The voltage in mV  
measured between the I+ and I– jack is equal to the current in mA.  
4. Insert the black test probe into the I– test jack, and insert the red test probe into the I+ test  
jack. The meter should read approximately –600 mV (60 mA).  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-206  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-567  
Page 2 of 2  
R
L
X
R
L
X
+
I
O
R
R
L
X
STAT  
STAT  
LPBK  
STAT  
LPBK  
LPBK  
ENBL  
LOS  
BER  
LOS  
BER  
LOS  
BER  
NET  
NET  
NET  
LOSW  
BER  
LOS  
BER  
LOS  
BER  
LINE  
LINE  
LINE  
V -  
V -  
V -  
I-  
I-  
I-  
I+  
V+  
V+  
I+  
I+  
V+  
RESET  
14864-A  
11784-A  
Version A2 RLX  
Version B RLX  
RLXIOR  
Figure 567-1. RLX Module Front Panel Layouts  
2-207  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-568  
Page 1 of 2  
VERSION C HLXC VOLTAGE TO HLXR TEST  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for measuring DC voltage and DC current being  
supplied by the Version C HLXC to the HLXR. The V+, V–, I+, and I– jacks provide monitor  
access to the voltage and current supplied to the HLXR through the HDSL span. These  
measurements are taken at the HLXC’s test jacks across a 10 Ohm resistor.  
Measure DC Voltage  
1. Select –VDC on the VOM and, if so equipped, select a voltage scale of 0 to 200 volts.  
2. Refer to Figure 568-1 for a front panel drawing of the HLXC. Insert the black test probe  
into the V– test jack, and insert the red test probe into the V+ test jack. A typical meter  
reading should be approximately 130 volts depending on the cable length in the loop.  
Measure DC Current  
3. Select –VDC on the VOM and, if so equipped, select the millivolt scale. The voltage in mV  
measured between the I+ and I– jack is equal to the current in mA.  
4. Insert the black test probe into the I– test jack, and insert the red test probe into the I+ test  
jack. The meter should typically read between –550 and –900 mV (55 to 90 mA).  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-208  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-568  
Page 2 of 2  
H
L
X
STAT  
RMT/  
HSKP  
LPBK  
LOS  
DS1  
BER  
CONT  
HDSL  
SNR  
LOSW  
BER  
L1  
L2  
LOSW  
BER  
V -  
I-  
I+  
V+  
6769-A  
Figure 568-1. Version C HLXC Module Front Panel  
2-209  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-569  
Page 1 of 1  
RLX-EQUIPPED CIRCUIT CROSS-CONNECTS  
Summary: RLX modules can be configured to supply span power over the DS1 pairs to power  
the repeater modules. To remove current from the pairs before making cross-connects, partially  
withdraw each RLX module from the chassis so that electrical contact with the rear connector is  
broken. Make necessary cross-connects, then re-install the RLX modules.  
Caution: Electronic modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before  
handling modules, wear an anti-static discharge wrist strap to prevent damage to  
electronic components. Place modules in anti-static packing material when transporting  
or storing. When working on modules, always place them on an approved anti-static mat  
that is electrically grounded.  
1. Open the chassis cover.  
2. Use the ejector at the bottom of each RLX front panel to carefully disengage the module  
from its connector.  
3. Partially withdraw each RLX module from its mounting slot to break electrical contact with  
the backplane connector.  
Note: The RLX can be configured to supply span power over the DS1 pairs to supply  
power to the repeater modules. Partially withdrawing the RLX ensures that current is not  
present when cross-connects are installed.  
4. At the central office, make necessary cross-connects at the Main Distribution Frame or  
other facility, in accordance with local practice.  
5. At the remote location, make necessary cross-connects at the remote distribution frame or  
other facility, in accordance with local practice.  
6. Insert the RLX modules into their mounting slots.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-210  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 1 of 18  
RTAU OPERATION  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for operating the Remote Test Access Unit  
(RTAU). The RTAU can be used to drop or insert DS1 signals either toward the network (DS3  
interface) or the customer interface (i.e., the DS1 distribution modules) for monitoring or  
intrusive testing.  
Note: A “toggle” field type means you can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or press the “R” key to view and select the previous option.  
An “input” field type means you must type an entry in the field according to the  
parameters described. A “fixed” field is locked, and cannot be changed by the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the “R” key to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits can be saved into the configuration database after each change is made in  
one of two ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter  
or Return twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving  
the screen. If the entries have been accepted, a message “Configuration Successful…  
Press Any Key To Continue” appears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
Note: Be sure to configure the line card to be tested before setting up test access.  
Note: The RTAU’s status can also be displayed using the Shelf Status screen, where the  
letter “R” in the TAU slot column means an RTAU is present.  
Reference: DLP-545 Shelf Status Display  
1. Refer to Figure 570-1. Check the RTAU front panel for the STATUS LED lighted green,  
indicating that the module is operating normally.  
2. Log on to the Craft Interface. The Main Menu screen appears.  
Reference: DLP-526 Craft Interface Logon  
3. Use the arrow or number keys to select System Maintenance from the Main Menu. Press  
Enter or Return. The System Maintenance screen appears, as shown in Figure 570-2.  
2-211  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 2 of 18  
RTAU  
STATUS  
B8ZS  
AMI  
LINE CODE  
INTRUSIVE  
TEST  
BIPOLAR  
ACCESS  
RX  
D
S
TX  
1
12693-A  
Figure 570-1. RTAU Front Panel  
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE  
1. Force/APS Commands  
2. Reset/LED Test Commands  
3. Execute ACO (Alarm Cut-Off)  
4. Loopback Status/Commands  
5. Display Inventory  
6. Display Circuit IDs  
7. Upload/Download Commands  
8. Test Access Unit Commands  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
5323-A  
Figure 570-2. System Maintenance Menu  
2-212  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 3 of 18  
4. Use the arrow or number keys to select Test Access Unit Commands. Press Enter or Return.  
The RTAU Configuration screen appears, as shown in Figure 570-3.  
RTAU CONFIGURATION  
1. RTAU Unit Configuration  
2. User Pattern Definition  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
14868-A  
Figure 570-3. RTAU Configuration Menu  
Note: The User Pattern Definition screen is not available for the MPU 5.3 release.  
5. Use the arrow or number keys to select RTAU Unit Configuration from the RTAU  
Configuration menu. Press Enter or Return. The 'RTAU Config' screen appears, as shown  
in Figure 570-4.  
Note: If the neither the RTAU or TAU are plugged into the chassis, the Test Access  
Unit Status/Commands screen, shown in Figure 570-5, can still be accessed from the  
System Maintenance menu. But in this case it cannot be configured.  
However, if the TAU is plugged into the chassis, the Test Access Unit Status/Commands  
screen can be configured after accessing it from the System Maintenance menu. Refer to  
the Soneplex Test Access Unit Installation Instructions, listed under Related Publications  
at the beginning of this manual, for more information about the TAU.  
6. To prepare the RTAU for operation, set the parameters shown on the 'RTAU Config'  
screen. Refer to Figures 570-6 through 570-14 for test diagrams and mode schematics.  
Refer to Table 570-1 for details regarding parameter options. Use the arrow keys to move  
from field to field. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
2-213  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 4 of 18  
7. To start a test, set the Measurement field to START. The RTAU waits for pattern sync or  
frame sync (for framed patterns) before beginning measurement (see Figure 570-15). After  
syncing, the test begins and the Measurement display changes to RUNNING.  
8. As a test progresses, the results are displayed on the RTAU Config screen, in the 'Error  
Counts' and 'Elapsed Time' columns.  
9. To terminate a test, set the Measurement field to STOP. Setting the Mode field to  
DISABLE also stops any measurements in progress and terminates the test.  
10. To end a test session and restore the tested circuit to normal operation, set the Mode field to  
DISABLE.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
RTAU CONFIG  
EQUIPMENT SETUP  
===============  
Current User  
Line Code  
: CRAFT  
: INTERNAL  
Test Circuit: 1-1  
Mode  
: DISABLE  
SIGNAL GENERATOR SETUP  
======================  
Pattern Type  
Frame Format  
Loop Code  
: QRS  
: UNFRAMED  
: NONE  
-------------------------------------  
---------------  
BIT ERROR SETUP  
Error Counts  
Status  
Elapsed Time  
===============  
Error Count  
============  
Data :  
======  
F Sync:  
============  
ES :  
: 0  
Error Rate  
Error Locn  
: OFF  
: N/A  
BPV :  
Frame:  
CRC :  
COFA :  
P Sync:  
EFS:  
RAI  
:
Test Timeout  
In Minutes  
: 60  
Measurement  
: STOP  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
14866-A  
Figure 570-4. RTAU Config Screen  
(Showing Defaults for Screen With Line Code Field Set to INTERNAL)  
2-214  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 5 of 18  
TEST ACCESS UNIT STATUS/COMMANDS  
Group: 1  
DS1#: 2  
Drop Direction  
==============  
Insert Direction  
================  
NONE  
Status  
:
NONE  
Command :  
TAU Present Status: NO  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
14851-A  
Figure 570-5. Test Access Unit Status/Commands Screen  
2-215  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 6 of 18  
Table 570-1. RTAU Configuration Fields  
FIELD  
EQUIPMENT SETUP FIELDS  
Current User Toggle  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
OVERVIEW: The Current User field can only be set to NONE or  
CRAFT from the Craft menu. If the Current User field is set to  
NONE, the Mode field is automatically set to DISABLE.  
However, to change this field to CRAFT, the Mode field must  
first be set to an option other than DISABLE. At that point, the  
Current User field is automatically set to CRAFT.  
NONE  
NONE  
The RTAU is not being used.  
CRAFT  
TL1  
The RTAU is being controlled via the Craft.  
The RTAU is being controlled via the TL1 interface. This  
option cannot be enabled from the Craft menu. When a  
“Connect Test Access T1” command is issued, the Current  
User field is automatically set to TL1.  
Line Code  
Toggle  
OVERVIEW: If external test equipment is being used, set the  
Line Code field to either AMI or B8ZS. (External test  
equipment required: T-Berd 211 DS1 test set or equivalent that  
can generate a T1 signal.) If the internal signal monitor and  
signal generator of the RTAU is being used, set the line code to  
INTERNAL. In addition, when an intrusive test mode is  
selected and the line code is set to INTERNAL, the signal  
generator “Pattern Type” field defaults to QRS to transmit an  
unframed QRSS signal.  
B8ZS  
INTERNAL  
B8ZS  
Disables RTAU front panel bantam jacks for test access.  
Selects internal TSG and SPD.  
Enables Bipolar Eight-Zero Substitution line code through  
the Craft Interface.  
AMI  
Enables Alternate Mark Inversion line code through the Craft  
Interface.  
Test Circuit  
Input  
1-1 thru 1-4,  
2-1 thru 2-4,  
3-1 thru 3-4,  
4-1 thru 4-4,  
5-1 thru 5-4,  
6-1 thru 6-4,  
7-1 thru7-4  
Group and slot number to be dropped by the DS3 MUX. The  
Test Circuit option can only be changed if the value set in  
the Mode field is DISABLE.  
1-1  
(continued)  
2-216  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 7 of 18  
Table 570-1. RTAU Configuration Fields, continued  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
EQUIPMENT SETUP FIELDS, continued  
Mode  
Toggle OVERVIEW: Valid access modes and the resulting configurations are shown in  
Figure 570-6 (RTAU Test Configuration Block Diagram),  
Figure 570-7 (MONF and MONE),  
DISABLE  
Figure 570-8 (SPLTB and SPLTA),  
Figure 570-9 (Typical Round-Robin Test Configuration),  
Figure 570-10 (Typical End Test Configuration),  
Figure 570-11 (SPLTF and SPLTE),  
Figure 570-12 (Typical Point-to-Point Test Configuration),  
Figure 570-13 (SPLTFL and SPLTEL), and  
Figure 570-14 (LOOPF and LOOPE).  
In addition, when the Mode field change is saved by pressing the Enter or Return  
key, the MPU will instruct the DS3 MUX to drop and insert the selected circuit.  
MONE  
MONF  
SPLTA  
Non-intrusive monitor access to the A pair.  
Non-intrusive monitor access to the B pair.  
SPLTA mode indicates a split in the A transmission path  
with a TSG (Test Signal Generator) connected in the F  
direction, and an SPD (Signal Presence Detector) connected  
to the signal from the E direction.  
SPLTB  
SPLTE  
SPLTB mode indicates a split in the B transmission path  
with a TSG connected in the E direction, and an SPD  
connected to the signal from the F direction.  
SPLTE mode indicates a split in both the A and B  
transmission paths. An SPD is connected to the line incoming  
from the E direction and a TSG is connected to the line  
outgoing to the E direction. The line outgoing in the F  
direction is connected to a QRSS source, and the line  
incoming from the E direction is terminated by the nominal  
characteristic impedance of the line.  
SPLTF  
SPLTF indicates a split in both the A and B transmission paths  
with a TSG connected to the line outgoing to the F direction,  
and an SPD connected to the line incoming from the F  
direction. The line outgoing in the E direction is connected to  
a QRSS source, and the line incoming from the E direction is  
terminated by the nominal characteristic impedance of the line.  
SPLTEL  
SPLTEL indicates a split in both the A and B paths and connects  
an SPD to the line incoming from the E direction and a TSG to  
the line outgoing in the E direction similar to SPLTE mode. The  
signal in the F direction is looped back.  
(continued)  
2-217  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 8 of 18  
Table 570-1. RTAU Configuration Fields, continued  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
EQUIPMENT SETUP FIELDS, continued  
Mode,  
Toggle SPLTFL  
SPLTFL indicates a split in both the A and B paths and  
connects an SPD to the line incoming from the F direction  
and a TSG to the line outgoing in the F direction similar to  
SPLTF mode. The signal in the E direction is looped back.  
continued  
LOOPE  
The LOOPE mode is a full split of both A and B  
transmissions paths. The incoming line in the E direction is  
connected to the SPD and this line is connected to the  
outgoing line in the E direction. The circuit will be looped in  
one direction. The outgoing line in the F direction (non-test  
direction) will be connected to a QRSS source and the line  
incoming from the F direction is terminated by the nominal  
characteristic impedance of the line.  
LOOPF  
The LOOPF mode is a full split of both A and B  
transmissions paths. The incoming line in the F direction is  
connected to the SPD and this line is connected to the  
outgoing line in the F direction. The circuit will be looped in  
one direction. The outgoing line in the E direction (non-test  
direction) will be connected to a QRSS source and the line  
incoming from the E direction is terminated by the nominal  
characteristic impedance of the line.  
DISABLE  
When DISABLE is selected, no monitor or split access can  
take place. Setting the Mode field to DISABLE also stops  
any measurement in progress, as if the Measurement field  
(described below) had been set to STOP.  
SIGNAL GENERATOR SETUP FIELDS  
Pattern Type Toggle  
OVERVIEW: If the desired pattern type is not available,  
select the User Code option to enter a pattern 32 bits or less.  
QRS  
20  
QRS  
Quasi-Random Signal. QRS (2 -1) is a 1,048,575-bit  
sequence generated by a 20-stage shift register with feedback  
taken from the 17th and 20th stages. The non-inverted output  
is taken from the 20th stage, and an output bit is forced to be  
a ‘1’ whenever the next 14 bits are all 0’s. QRS is typically  
used to verify continuity and to check circuit performance in  
the presence of traffic-like signals. QRS (Quasi-random  
Signal) is a signal repeated every 1 to 24 bits as specified by  
the OS (Operation System) application. QRS must conform  
to the description in Bellcore TR-NPL-000054.  
(continued)  
2-218  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 9 of 18  
Table 570-1. RTAU Configuration Fields, continued  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
SIGNAL GENERATOR SETUP FIELDS, continued  
15  
Pattern Type,  
continued  
Toggle 2^15-1  
2
-1 is a 32,767-bit, pseudo-random pattern that generates a  
maximum of 14 sequential 0’s and 15 sequential 1’s. The  
pattern provides a maximum number of 0’s allowed for  
framed, non-B8ZS testing. The pattern does not meet the  
minimum 1’s density requirement.  
23  
2^23-1  
2
-1 is a 8,388,607-bit. pseudo-random pattern that  
generates a maximum of 22 sequential 0’s and 23 sequential  
1’s. The pattern exceeds excess 0’s and does not meet the  
minimum 1’s density requirements for T1 applications.  
All Ones  
Test of T1 span line. The all-1’s pattern causes the span line  
repeater to consume the maximum amount of power. If the  
current powering the span line is low, transmission errors  
may occur due to the inter-symbol interference resulting  
from the inability of a weak repeater power supply to  
develop the energy necessary to support the transmission of a  
long sequence of 1’s.  
(Framed) All  
Used as a final confirmation that all network elements in a  
circuit are properly optioned with B8ZS for clear channel  
operation. The framed all 0’s pattern consisting of a frame bit  
followed by an all 0’s payload, will only be applied to circuit  
optioned with B8ZS for clear channel operation.  
Zeros  
3 in 24  
Used to determine the ability of network equipment to function  
properly when transporting signal sequences containing both a  
maximum of 15 consecutive 0’s during periods of minimum  
overall pulse density.  
• Unframed = 1000 1000 1000 0000  
0000 0000 1000 1000  
• Framed =  
0100 0100 0000 0000  
0000 0100 0100 1000  
2 in 8  
Used in conjunction with the 1-in-8 pattern. Useful when  
performing test to reveal the presence of incorrectly-optioned  
AMI or B8ZS equipment. Use of the 2-in-8 pattern will  
confirm the circuits ability to support error-free transmission.  
• Unframed = 0100 0010 0100 0010  
• Framed =  
0100 0010 0100 0010  
(continued)  
2-219  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 10 of 18  
Table 570-1. RTAU Configuration Fields, continued  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
SIGNAL GENERATOR SETUP FIELDS, continued  
Pattern Type,  
continued  
Toggle 1 in 8  
Containing strings of 7 sequential 0’s. It is used to determine  
the ability of a circuit to handle payload signals having  
minimum 1’s density. Use of this pattern often reveals the  
existence of timing recovery problem under conditions of  
low signal density.  
• Unframed = 1000 0000 1000 0000  
• Framed =  
0100 0000 0100 0000  
DALY  
Daly Pattern (Modified 55 Octet). This is useful for stressing the  
timing recovery circuits of line cards and the preamplifier/  
equalizer circuits of repeaters. The pattern stresses a circuit by  
introducing rapid transitions from long sequences of low density  
octets to high density octets, high density octets to low density  
octets, and rapid transitions. The pattern may be transmitted  
framed or unframed. When framed, the frame bit shall be inserted  
at the octet boundaries and will not overwrite the bits.  
User Code  
For user-defined patterns of 32 bits or less, set the Pattern Type  
field to User Code. The bits can be entered by typing a string  
of 0’s or 1’s in the bit field located to the right of the  
designated entry.  
Pattern Bits  
Display None  
only  
If the Pattern Type field is configured for User Code, pattern  
bits will be displayed to the right of the Pattern type field  
parameter. This field’s name is not shown on the screen. If no  
User Code is entered in the Pattern Type field, this field  
displays 32 dashes.  
None  
Frame Format  
Toggle UNFRAMED  
Unframed data pattern.  
UNFRAM  
ED  
Ft ONLY  
SF  
Used for SLC framing.  
Super Frame  
ESF  
Extended Super Frame  
(continued)  
2-220  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 11 of 18  
Table 570-1. RTAU Configuration Fields, continued  
OPTIONS DESCRIPTION  
SIGNAL GENERATOR SETUP FIELDS, continued  
Loop Code  
FIELD  
TYPE  
DEFAULT  
Toggle OVERVIEW: The Mode field must be set to a SPLT option before the Loop Code  
field can be configured. Loop codes will be transmitted until the RTAU detects a  
change in the signal being received. At that time, the pattern selected before the loop  
code was set will be transmitted. For example, when sending a Loop Up code, the  
RTAU will restore the original pattern after it receives the loop code it is transmitting,  
indicating that the circuit is looped up. Note that the Loop Code bits are displayed in  
the Loop Code bit field as each code is selected. This is provided as a convenience to  
the operator who may not know the name chosen for the loop code but does know  
the pattern.  
NONE  
Line Loop Up  
10000  
100  
Line Loop  
Down  
4-Bit Loop Up 1100  
4-Bit Loop  
Down  
1110  
5-Bit Loop Up 11000  
5-Bit Loop  
Down  
11100  
ESF CSU  
Loop Up  
0EFF (0000 1110 1111 1111)  
38FF (0011 1000 1111 1111)  
ESF CSU  
Loop Down  
ESF NI* Loop 12FF (0001 0010 1111 1111)  
Up  
ESF NI* Loop  
Down  
24FF (0010 0100 1111 1111)  
ESF CSU  
Payload Loop  
Up  
14FF (0001 0100 1111 1111)  
ESF CSU  
Payload Loop  
Down  
32FF (0011 0010 1111 1111)  
User Loop Up  
(toggle and  
input)  
Enter a 16-value expression using only 1’s, 0’s, or “-”. The  
bits can be entered by typing a string of 0’s or 1’s in the bit  
field located to the right of the designated entry.  
User Loop  
Down  
Enter a 16-value expression using only 1’s, 0’s, or “-”. The  
bits can be entered by typing a string of 0’s or 1’s in the bit  
field located to the right of the designated entry.  
NONE  
Disables any active loop code selected for this field. When  
NONE is selected, the Loop Code field displays 16 dashes.  
*Note: “NI” means Network Interface device.  
(continued)  
2-221  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 12 of 18  
Table 570-1. RTAU Configuration Fields, continued  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
BIT ERROR SETUP FIELDS  
OVERVIEW: Bit errors can be injected by the RTAU using the  
Bit Error Set Up fields. These sections are display-only fields that  
are only displayed when the line code setting is INTERNAL. The  
Status field always shows the current status if the line code is  
INTERNAL, but the Error Counts and Elapsed Time fields only  
show a value when a measurement is being made.  
Error Count  
Input  
Range of 0 to  
1544  
Select either Error Count or Error Rate for bit error setup. Both  
cannot be set at the same time. If single errors or a burst of  
errors is desired, set the Error Count field to the number of  
errors to insert. If the Error Count field is set, the number of  
errors will be transmitted each time the Enter key is pressed.  
0
Error Rate  
Error Locn  
Toggle OFF, 1E-3,  
1E-4, 1E-5,  
Select either Error Count or Error Rate for bit error setup. Both  
cannot be set at the same time. If a steady error rate is desired,  
set the Error Rate field, which indicates the rate bit or frame  
errors are injected.  
Off  
1E-6, 1E-7  
Toggle  
OVERVIEW: The Error Location field must be set to either  
PAYLOAD or FBE if the count or rate field is set. Pressing  
the Enter or Return key will cause the RTAU to send the  
errors.  
N/A  
N/A  
Indicates count is 0 and rate is off.  
Bit errors are injected.  
PAYLOAD  
FBE  
Frame Bit Error. Frame errors are injected.  
Eight-digit counter or blank.  
Error Counts –  
Data  
Display None  
only  
Blank  
Blank  
Blank  
Blank  
Blank  
Blank  
Blank  
Blank  
Error Counts –  
BPV  
Display None  
only  
Eight-digit counter or blank.  
Eight-digit counter or blank.  
Eight-digit counter or blank.  
Eight-digit counter or blank.  
* or blank  
Error Counts –  
Frame  
Display None  
only  
Error Counts –  
CRC  
Display None  
only  
Error Counts –  
COFA  
Display None  
only  
Status F Sync  
Status P Sync  
Status RAI  
Display None  
only  
Display None  
only  
* or blank  
Display None  
only  
* or blank  
(continued)  
2-222  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 13 of 18  
Table 570-1. RTAU Configuration Fields, continued  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
BIT ERROR SETUP FIELDS, continued  
Elapsed Time –  
ES  
Display None  
only  
Six-digit counter or blank.  
Blank  
Blank  
60  
Elapsed Time –  
EFS  
Display None  
only  
Six-digit counter or blank.  
Test Timeout in  
Minutes  
Input  
0 to 1440  
Timeout counter for test access. If the counter is set to a  
number higher than “0” and then reaches “0” during test, the  
Mode field will be set to DISABLE automatically. If the  
counter is set to “0”, the test timeout will be turned off, and  
the test will have unlimited time.  
Measurement  
Toggle  
OVERVIEW: Start a measurement by selecting START at the  
Measurement field. The RTAU will wait for pattern sync and  
frame sync for framed patterns before starting the measurement.  
After synching, the measurement display will change to  
RUNNING. Stop any measurement by selecting STOP. Refer to  
Figure 570-15 for an RTAU Config screen showing a test that is  
starting.  
STOP  
Note: If the Mode is set to MONE, MONF, LOOPE, or LOOPF,  
only frame sync is required before starting the measurement. If the  
pattern is not in sync, then the Data Error Counts will read “N/A”  
until pattern sync is established.  
START  
STOP  
Initiate measurement.  
Terminate measurement. Note: Setting the Mode field to  
DISABLE also stops any measurement in progress, as if the  
Measurement field had been set to STOP.  
RUNNING  
(display)  
Measurement active.  
Waiting on  
Sync  
Display None  
only  
This parameter is displayed to the right of the Measurement  
field when the Measurement field is set to START. The  
WAITING ON SYNC message is display only; it only shows  
up when the RTAU is waiting for either frame or pattern sync.  
Examine the status section to determine what sync is needed.  
Blank  
Mode  
Toggle DISABLE  
To end the test session, restore the tested circuit to normal  
operation by selecting DISABLE.  
DISABLE  
2-223  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 14 of 18  
MPU  
or  
SCU  
BIPOLAR  
ACCESS  
RTAU  
DS3 MUX  
RTAU  
FRONT  
PANEL  
DS1 TEST  
SET  
RX  
PATTERN GEN  
DETECTOR  
TX  
LINE  
CARD  
DS3  
EQUIPMENT  
CONTROLLER  
(OPTIONAL)  
A
B
DS1  
FACILITY  
14869-A  
MONITOR  
SPLIT  
Figure 570-6. RTAU Test Configuration Block Diagram  
EQUIPMENT (E)  
[NETWORK]  
FACILITY (F)  
[CUSTOMER]  
EQUIPMENT (E)  
[NETWORK]  
FACILITY (F)  
[CUSTOMER]  
DS3 MUX  
DS3 MUX  
A
B
CIRCUIT  
CIRCUIT  
UNDER TEST  
UNDER TEST  
B
A
MONF  
MONE  
SIGNAL  
SIGNAL  
PRESENCE  
DETECTOR  
PRESENCE  
DETECTOR  
RTAU  
RTAU  
11865-B  
Figure 570-7. MONF and MONE  
2-224  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 15 of 18  
EQUIPMENT (E)  
[NETWORK]  
FACILITY (F)  
[CUSTOMER]  
EQUIPMENT (E)  
[NETWORK]  
FACILITY (F)  
[CUSTOMER]  
DS3 MUX  
DS3 MUX  
CIRCUIT  
CIRCUIT  
UNDER TEST  
UNDER TEST  
SPLTB  
SPLTA  
SIGNAL  
SIGNAL  
PRESENCE  
DETECTOR  
PRESENCE  
DETECTOR  
A
B
A
B
RTAU  
RTAU  
TEST SIGNAL  
GENERATOR  
TEST SIGNAL  
GENERATOR  
11866-B  
Figure 570-8. SPLTB and SLPTA  
OFFICE A  
OFFICE Z  
INTEROFFICE  
FACILITY  
A END  
Z END  
RTAU  
A
RTAU  
A
E
F
F
E
INSERT:  
NETWORK  
DROP:  
CUSTOMER  
LOOPBACK  
LOOPBACK  
B
B
CPE  
CPE  
SPLTB  
A = "A" TRANSMISSION PATH  
B = "B" TRANSMISSION PATH  
E = EQUIPMENT (NETWORK)  
F = FACILITY (CUSTOMER)  
11867-B  
= SIGNAL PRESENCE DETECTOR  
= TEST SIGNAL GENERATOR  
OR UNFRAMED (QRS)  
Figure 570-9. Typical Round-Robin Test Configuration  
2-225  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 16 of 18  
OFFICE A  
INTEROFFICE  
FACILITY  
OFFICE Z  
A
A END  
Z END  
RTAU  
A
F
E
E
F
INSERT:  
NETWORK  
DROP:  
NETWORK  
LOOPBACK  
B
B
CPE  
CPE  
QRS  
SPLTE  
A = "A" TRANSMISSION PATH  
B = "B" TRANSMISSION PATH  
E = EQUIPMENT (NETWORK)  
F = FACILITY (CUSTOMER)  
= SIGNAL PRESENCE DETECTOR  
11868-B  
= TEST SIGNAL GENERATOR  
OR UNFRAMED (QRS)  
= TERMINATED SIGNAL  
Figure 570-10. Typical End Test Configuration  
EQUIPMENT (E)  
[NETWORK]  
FACILITY (F)  
[CUSTOMER]  
EQUIPMENT (E)  
[NETWORK]  
FACILITY (F)  
[CUSTOMER]  
DS3 MUX  
DS3 MUX  
A
A
B
B
CIRCUIT  
CIRCUIT  
UNDER TEST  
UNDER TEST  
SPLTF  
SPLTE  
SIGNAL  
PRESENCE  
DETECTOR  
TEST SIGNAL  
GENERATOR  
QRS  
QRS  
RTAU  
RTAU  
SIGNAL  
PRESENCE  
DETECTOR  
TEST SIGNAL  
GENERATOR  
11869-B  
Figure 570-11. SPLTF and SLPTE  
2-226  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 17 of 18  
OFFICE A  
RTAU  
A
INTEROFFICE  
FACILITY  
OFFICE Z  
A END  
Z END  
RTAU  
A
F
E
E
F
DROP:  
CUSTOMER  
DROP:  
NETWORK  
INSERT:  
CUSTOMER  
INSERT:  
NETWORK  
INSERT:  
CUSTOMER  
INSERT:  
NETWORK  
B
B
CPE  
CPE  
QRS  
QRS  
SPLTF  
SPLTE  
A = "A" TRANSMISSION PATH  
B = "B" TRANSMISSION PATH  
E = EQUIPMENT (NETWORK)  
F = FACILITY (CUSTOMER)  
= SIGNAL PRESENCE DETECTOR  
= TEST SIGNAL GENERATOR  
OR UNFRAMED (QRS)  
= TERMINATED SIGNAL  
11870-B  
Figure 570-12. Typical Point-to-Point Test Configuration  
EQUIPMENT (E)  
[NETWORK]  
FACILITY (F)  
[CUSTOMER]  
EQUIPMENT (E)  
[NETWORK]  
FACILITY (F)  
[CUSTOMER]  
DS3 MUX  
DS3 MUX  
A
A
B
B
CIRCUIT  
CIRCUIT  
UNDER TEST  
UNDER TEST  
SPLTFL  
SPLTEL  
SIGNAL  
TEST SIGNAL  
GENERATOR  
PRESENCE  
DETECTOR  
RTAU  
RTAU  
SIGNAL  
PRESENCE  
DETECTOR  
TEST SIGNAL  
GENERATOR  
11871-B  
Figure 570-13. SPLTFL and SPLTEL  
2-227  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-570  
Page 18 of 18  
EQUIPMENT (E)  
[NETWORK]  
FACILITY (F)  
[CUSTOMER]  
EQUIPMENT (E)  
[NETWORK]  
FACILITY (F)  
[CUSTOMER]  
DS3 MUX  
DS3 MUX  
A
A
B
B
CIRCUIT  
CIRCUIT  
UNDER TEST  
UNDER TEST  
LOOPF  
LOOPE  
SIGNAL  
SIGNAL  
PRESENCE  
DETECTOR  
PRESENCE  
DETECTOR  
QRS  
QRS  
RTAU  
RTAU  
11872-B  
Figure 570-14. LOOPF and LOOPE  
RTAU CONFIG  
EQUIPMENT SETUP  
===============  
Current User  
Line Code  
: CRAFT  
: INTERNAL  
Test Circuit: 1-2  
Mode  
: SPLTE  
SIGNAL GENERATOR SETUP  
======================  
Pattern Type  
Frame Format  
Loop Code  
: EFS  
: QRS  
: NONE  
-------------------------------------  
---------------  
BIT ERROR SETUP  
Error Counts  
Status  
Elapsed Time  
===============  
Error Count  
============  
Data :  
======  
F Sync:  
============  
ES :  
: 0  
Error Rate  
Error Locn  
: OFF  
: N/A  
BPV :  
Frame:  
CRC :  
COFA :  
P Sync:  
EFS:  
RAI  
:
Test Timeout  
In Minutes  
: 60  
Measurement  
: START  
WAITING ON SYNC  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
14867-A  
Figure 570-15. RTAU Configuration Screen (Starting a Measurement)  
2-228  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-571  
Page 1 of 2  
STREAKER INSTALLATION AND TESTING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for installation and testing of the Streaker module.  
Note: For a detailed description of Streaker (STK) module use, refer to Soneplex  
Streaker Module Installation Instructions, listed under Related Publications at the  
beginning of this manual.  
Caution: Because of the height of the battery holders, use care when sliding the module  
into the chassis. To prevent damage to the Streaker module or adjacent modules, insert the  
card straight into the chassis guides without bending or forcing the module into position.  
1. Remove the Streaker module from its protective packaging.  
2. Following the polarity markings on the battery holders, install four fresh AAA alkaline  
batteries in the battery holders on the PC board.  
3. Press the top of the voltage switch as shown in Figure 571-1 to select BATTERY (onboard)  
operation, or press the bottom to select –48 VOLT FEED. (Dropping resistors and a zener  
diode reduce the –48 VDC to approximately 6 VDC before it is applied to the indicators. In  
addition, the –48 VDC input line is protected by a 0.5 amp fuse on the PCB.)  
4. Align the card edges of the module with the mounting slot card guides, then slide the  
module into a chassis slot until it contacts the backplane connector.  
5. Use the ejector lever to seat the module in the connector. If difficulty is experienced when  
inserting or seating this module, remove the module and check that the batteries are  
properly seated in the holders; also check for other obstructions or misalignment in the  
chassis.  
6. Refer to Figure 571-2. When the module is seated, press the LMP TEST (lamp test)  
pushbutton switch; all front panel indicators should light yellow. If the indicators do not  
light, check that the batteries are installed properly or (if you have selected –48V) replace  
the module.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-229  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-571  
Page 2 of 2  
S
T
I
K
I
O
D
S
1
1
1
1
I
BATT  
–48V  
O
I
O
I
O
M
O
I
O
M
BATTERY  
HOLDERS  
D
S
O
O
4
M
P
D
S
VOLTAGE SWITCH  
5858-B  
Figure 571-1. Streaker Module  
S
T
K
T
R
L
I
IN  
N
E
T1  
R1  
T1  
R1  
OUT  
D
S
X
IN  
T
R
OUT  
IN  
LINE  
OUT  
OUT  
DSX  
IN  
-48  
GRD  
LMP  
TEST  
5852-D  
Figure 571-2. STK Front Panel  
2-230  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 Issue 4 June 2000 Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-572  
Page 1 of 1  
VERSION D (OR LATER) HLXC VOLTAGE TO HLXR TEST  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for measuring DC voltage and DC current being  
supplied by the Version D (or later) HLXC to the Version D (or later) HLXR. The V+, V–, I+,  
and I– jacks provide monitor access to the voltage and current supplied to the HDSL Repeater  
(HRX) (if present) and HLXR through the HDSL span. Current measurements are taken as the  
voltage drop across a 10 ohm resistor.  
Measure DC Voltage  
1. Select –VDC on the VOM and, if so equipped, select a voltage scale of 300 volts or higher.  
2. Refer to Figure 572-1. Insert the black test probe into the V– test jack, and insert the red  
test probe into the V+ test jack. A typical meter reading should be approximately 130 VDC  
(with no HRX present), or approximately 260 VDC (with HRX present).  
Measure DC Current  
Note: The current test is not available on the Version G module.  
3. Select –VDC on the VOM and, if so equipped, select the millivolt scale.  
4. Insert the black test probe into the I– test jack, and insert the red test probe into the I+ test  
jack. The millivolt reading divided by 10 is the DC current in milliamps.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
H
L
X
H
L
X
H
L
X
2X  
STAT  
STAT  
STAT  
RMT/  
HSKP  
RMT/  
HSKP  
RMT/  
HSKP  
LPBK  
LPBK  
LPBK  
LOS  
BER  
LOS  
BER  
DS1  
DS1  
LOS  
BER  
DS1  
CONT  
SNR  
LOSW  
BER  
CONT  
SNR  
LOSW  
BER  
HDSL  
L1  
HDSL  
L1  
CONT  
SNR  
H
D
LOSW  
BER  
L1  
S
LOSW  
BER  
L
LOSW  
LOSW  
BER  
L2  
L2  
L2  
I-  
BER  
2X  
V -  
V-  
I-  
V+  
V–  
V+  
I+  
I+  
V+  
6770-A  
11395-A  
12391-A  
Version D HLXC  
Version E HLXC  
Version G HLXC  
Figure 572-1. HLXC Module Front Panels  
2-231  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 Issue 4 June 2000 Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-573  
Page 1 of 6  
HLX LOOPBACK CONFIGURATION  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for viewing or editing the loopback  
configuration for HLXC modules.  
Note: A “toggle” field type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the  
next option that is described; or the user can press the “R” key to view and select the  
previous option. An “input” field type means the user must type an entry in the field  
according to the parameters described. A “fixed” field is locked, and cannot be changed by  
the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the  
complete field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the “R” key to  
reverse toggle through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is  
highlighted, type in the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two  
ways: 1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return  
twice after all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen.  
If the entries have been accepted, a message “Configuration Successful… Press Any Key  
To Continue” appears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Use the arrow or number keys to select Unit Configuration from the Main Menu. Press  
Enter or Return.  
2. Use the arrow or number keys to select HLX Configuration from the Unit Configuration  
menu. Press Enter or Return. The HLX Configuration menu is shown in Figure 573-1.  
3. Use the arrow or number keys to select Loopback Configuration from the HLX  
Configuration menu. Press Enter or Return. HLX Loopback Configuration screens are  
shown in Figure 573-2 (MPU V5.1 without an HRX), Figure 573-3 (MPU V5.1 with one  
HRX), and Figure 573-4 (MPU V5.2 with two HRXs).  
4. Starting at the top of Table 573-1 and working your way to the bottom, configure the HLX  
for the group and slot selected.  
5. Assign the selections by pressing Enter or Return.  
6. Repeat Steps 4 and 5 for each HLX module installed in the chassis.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-232  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 Issue 4 June 2000 Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-573  
Page 2 of 6  
HLX CONFIGURATION  
1. HLX Unit Configuration  
2. Loopback Configuration  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6765-A  
Figure 573-1. HLX Configuration Menu  
HLX LOOPBACK CONFIGURATION  
Group: 6  
Slot: 1  
Circuit ID:  
HLXC Activation Code  
HLXC Programmable Lpbk  
: 1101001111010011  
: DISABLED  
HLXR NID Loopback  
HLXR Activation Code  
HLXR Programmable Lpbk  
: UNIT SWITCH  
: 1100011101000010  
: DISABLED  
HRX Activation Code  
HRX Programmable Lpbk  
: NOT APPL  
: NOT APPL  
Common Deactivate Code  
: 1001001110010011  
Lpbk Timeout Disable Code: 1101010111010110  
Lpbk Timeout Period : 30 minutes  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6697-B  
Note: “Activation Code” is equivalent to “Programmable Code.”  
Figure 573-2. HLX Loopback Configuration Screen (MPU V5.1 Without an HRX)  
2-233  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 Issue 4 June 2000 Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-573  
Page 3 of 6  
HLX LOOPBACK CONFIGURATION  
Group: 6  
Slot: 1  
Circuit ID:  
HLXC Activation Code  
HLXC Programmable Lpbk  
: 1101001111010011  
: DISABLED  
HLXR NID Loopback  
HLXR Activation Code  
HLXR Programmable Lpbk  
: UNIT SWITCH  
: 1100011101000010  
: DISABLED  
HRX Activation Code  
HRX Programmable Lpbk  
: 1100011101000001  
: DISABLED  
Common Deactivate Code  
: 1001001110010011  
Lpbk Timeout Disable Code: 1101010111010110  
Lpbk Timeout Period : 30 minutes  
HLXR NID Loopback Switch Setting: ENABLED  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
8113-A  
Note: “Activation Code” is equivalent to “Programmable Code.”  
Figure 573-3. HLX Loopback Configuration Screen (MPU V5.1 With One HRX)  
HLX LOOPBACK CONFIGURATION  
Group: 5  
Slot: 1  
Circuit ID:  
HLXC Activation Code  
HLXC Programmable Lpbk  
: 1101001111010011  
: DISABLED  
ESF Inband Loopback  
HLXR NID Loopback  
HLXR Activation Code  
HLXR Programmable Lpbk  
: ENABLED  
: UNIT SWITCH  
: 1100011101000010  
: DISABLED  
HRX-1 Activation Code  
HRX-2 Activation Code  
: 1100011101000001  
: 1100011101000010  
HRX  
Programmable Lpbk : DISABLED  
Common Deactivate Code  
: 1001001110010011  
Lpbk Timeout Disable Code: 1101010111010110  
Lpbk Timeout Period : 30 minutes  
HLXR NID Loopback Switch Setting: ENABLED  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
11389-A  
Note: “Activation Code” is equivalent to “Programmable Code.”  
Figure 573-4. HLX Loopback Configuration Screen (MPU V5.2 With Two HRXs)  
2-234  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 Issue 4 June 2000 Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-573  
Page 4 of 6  
Table 573-1. HLX Loopback Configuration Fields  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
Group  
Toggle 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7  
Specifies the module’s group  
Blank  
number designated on the chassis.  
Slot  
Toggle 1, 2, 3, or 4  
Specifies the module’s slot number  
designated on the chassis.  
Blank  
Circuit ID  
Input  
Up to 20 characters.  
This represents the customer’s circuit Blank  
ID. The first and last characters must  
be alpha or numeric; middle  
characters can be alpha, numeric, or  
hyphens. Note: This field can be  
configured only after the T1  
Provision field (described in DLP-  
531) is set to YES.  
HLXC Activation  
Code  
Input  
16 binary characters (0’s  
and 1’s) must be entered.  
16-bit codes can be set to any 16-bit  
binary value except: all 0s, all 1s, or  
a value that is already used in another  
16-bit code. The signal is sent  
1101 0011 1101 0011  
(“Activation Code” is  
equivalent to  
“Programmable  
Code.”)  
inband. HDSL units go to loopup  
state when they are in armed state.  
Loopup is activated for selected  
units. Detection time is 3 secs.  
HLXC Programmable  
Lpbk  
Toggle ENABLED  
DISABLED  
Enables response to programmable  
loopback codes and overrides  
hardware configuration settings.  
MPU V5.1:  
DISABLED  
Disables response to programmable  
loopback codes and overrides  
hardware configuration settings.  
MPU V5.2:  
ENABLED  
ESF Inband Loopback  
Toggle ENABLED*  
DISABLED*  
N/A  
Version E HLXC: Enables ESF  
inband loopback.  
Version E HLXC:  
ENABLED  
Version E HLXC: Disables ESF  
inband loopback.  
Version D or earlier  
HLXC: N/A  
Version D or earlier HLXC only:  
this field cannot be configured.  
* In order for the ESF Inband Loopback field to be configured, some HLX Unit Configuration screen fields must be configured as  
follows: Unit Equip State = EQUIPPED, Unit Service State = IS, T1 Provision = YES, TI Service State = IS, and T1 Framing  
Format = ESF.  
(continued)  
2-235  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 Issue 4 June 2000 Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-573  
Page 5 of 6  
Table 573-1. HLX Loopback Configuration Fields, continued  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
HLXR NID Loopback  
Toggle UNIT SWITCH  
Version E HLXR only: Selects  
NID setting (enabled) for the  
HLXR.  
MPU V5.1:  
UNIT SWITCH  
MPU V5.2:  
Version D or earlier HLXR:  
ENABLED  
Selects NID setting (either enabled  
[default] or disabled) on the HLXR.  
When the HLXR is provisioned to  
function like an NID, it supports  
inband and out-of-band loopback  
codes.  
ENABLED  
DISABLED  
Enables response to NID loopback  
codes and overrides hardware  
configuration settings.  
Disables response to NID loopback  
codes and overrides hardware  
configuration settings.  
HLXR Activation  
Code  
Input  
16 binary characters (0’s  
and 1’s) must be entered.  
16-bit codes can be programmed to  
MPU V5.1:  
any 16-bit binary value except: all 0s, 1100 0111 0100 0010  
(“Activation Code” is  
equivalent to  
“Programmable  
Code.”)  
all 1s, or a value that is already used  
MPU V5.2:  
1100 0111 0101 0100  
in another 16-bit code. The signal is  
sent inband. HDSL units go to  
loopup state when they are in armed  
state. Loopup is activated for selected  
units. Detection time is 3 secs.  
HLXR Programmable  
Lpbk  
Toggle ENABLED  
DISABLED  
Enables response to programmable  
loopback codes and overrides  
hardware configuration settings.  
DISABLED  
Disables response to programmable  
loopback codes and overrides  
hardware configuration settings.  
One HRX in system  
only: HRX or HRX1  
Activation Code  
(“Activation Code” is  
equivalent to  
Input  
16 binary characters (0’s  
and 1’s) must be entered.  
16-bit codes can be programmed to  
any 16-bit binary value except: all 0s,  
all 1s, or a value that is already used  
in another 16-bit code. The signal is  
sent inband. HDSL units go to  
1100 0111 0100 0001  
No HRX: NOT APPL  
“Programmable  
Code.”)  
loopup state when they are in armed  
state. Loopup is activated for selected  
units. Detection time is 3 secs.  
(continued)  
2-236  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 Issue 4 June 2000 Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-573  
Page 6 of 6  
Table 573-1. HLX Loopback Configuration Fields, continued  
FIELD  
TYPE  
OPTIONS  
DESCRIPTION  
DEFAULT  
Second HRX in  
system only: HRX2  
Activation Code  
(“Activation Code” is  
equivalent to  
Input  
16 binary characters (0’s  
and 1’s) must be entered.  
16-bit codes can be programmed to  
any 16-bit binary value except: all 0s,  
all 1s, or a value that is already used  
in another 16-bit code. The signal is  
sent inband. HDSL units go to loopup  
state when they are in armed state.  
Loopup is activated for selected units.  
Detection time is 3 secs.  
1100 0111 0100 0010  
“Programmable  
Code.”)  
HRX in system only:  
HRX Programmable  
Lpbk  
Toggle ENABLED  
DISABLED  
Enables response to programmable  
loopback codes and overrides  
hardware configuration settings.  
MPU V5.1:  
DISABLED  
Disables response to programmable  
loopback codes and overrides  
hardware configuration settings.  
MPU V5.2:  
ENABLED  
No HRX: NOT APPL  
Common Deactivate  
Code  
Input  
Input  
16 binary characters (0’s  
16-bit codes can be set to any 16-bit  
binary value except: all 0s, all 1s, or a  
value that is already used in another  
16-bit code. The signal is sent inband.  
Units in loopup state go back to armed  
state. Detection time is 5 secs.  
1001 0011 1001 0011  
and 1’s) must be entered.  
Lpbk Timeout  
Disable Code  
16 binary characters (0’s  
and 1’s) must be entered.  
16-bit codes can be set to any 16-bit  
binary value except: all 0s, all 1s, or a  
value that is already used in another  
16-bit code. This disables loopup  
time-out. Active loopbacks stay up  
until deactivation or disarm code is  
received. Detection time is 3 secs.  
1101 0101 1101 0110  
Lpbk Timeout Period  
Input  
Enter a number from 0 to  
255  
This number represents the minutes  
that the loopback will remain in  
effect before reverting to the normal  
(non-loopback) state. Setting the  
loopback time-out period to 0 (zero)  
disables the time-out feature.  
30 minutes  
HLXR NID Loopback Display ENABLED or  
Switch Setting DISABLED  
This field reflects the condition of  
the NID enable/disable jumper wire  
on the HLXR edge card connector  
(pins 6 and 8). If no jumper wire is  
present between these pins, the  
display will show ENABLED. If a  
jumper wire is present between these  
pins, the display will shown  
None  
DISABLED. If the HLXR does not  
have an NID jumper wire option, the  
display will show ENABLED.  
2-237  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 Issue 4 June 2000 Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-574  
Page 1 of 1  
TAU INSTALLATION AND TESTING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for installing the Test Access Unit (TAU) in the  
chassis and verifying that it is functioning properly. The TAU requires no provisioning or  
periodic maintenance.  
Caution: Modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before handling  
any modules, ESD protection must always be used. An ESD grounding post is located on  
the chassis for connecting the ESD wrist band. Ensure that all modules removed from  
the equipment or not installed, are properly stored in anti-static packing material. When  
working with modules, always place the module on an electrically-grounded, approved,  
anti-static mat.  
Note: For information about installing and testing the TAU, which is used with MPU  
Software Version 5.3, refer to the Soneplex Test Access Unit Installation Instructions  
manual, listed under Related Publications at the beginning of this manual.  
1. Remove the TAU from its protective packaging.  
2. Insert the TAU into the full height chassis slot labeled TAU (as shown in Figure 574-1)  
until it reaches the backplane connector.  
3. Using the ejectors, fully seat the TAU in the chassis. A moderate amount of force may be  
required to properly seat the module in the backplane connector.  
4. Did the STATUS indicator light green?  
If Yes, you have completed this procedure.  
If No, replace the TAU and return to Step 1.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
APU  
HSP  
1-1 1-3 2-1 2-3 3-1 3-3 4-1 4-3 5-1 5-3 6-1 6-3 7-1 7-3  
HSW  
MXW MXP TAU  
CR  
MJ  
MN  
ACO  
PWR  
TAU  
HSKP  
RMT  
ALM  
STATUS  
LPBK  
STATUS  
LPBK  
D
I
S
P
R
M
T
LMPTST  
DS3 FAIL  
ENABLE  
ENABLE  
APU  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
ONLINE  
ONLINE  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
DS3 FAIL  
STATU
APS  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
APS  
LOCKOUT  
FORCE  
LMPTST/  
APS  
LMPTST/  
APS  
T  
RESET  
RESET  
MPU  
1-2 1-4 2-2 2-4 3-2 3-4 4-2 4-4 5-2 5-4 6-2 6-4 7-2 7-4  
5841-A  
TAU MODULE  
Figure 574-1. TAU Mounting Position in the Soneplex Broadband Chassis  
2-238  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 Issue 4 June 2000 Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-575  
Page 1 of 5  
TAU OPERATION  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for operating the Test Access Unit (TAU). The  
TAU can be used to drop or insert DS1 signals either toward the network (DS3 interface) or the  
customer interface (i.e., the DS1 distribution modules) for monitoring or intrusive testing.  
Note: For information about operating the TAU, refer to the Soneplex Test Access Unit  
Installation Instructions manual, listed under Related Publications at the beginning of this  
manual.)  
Note: A “toggle” field type means the user can press the space bar to view and select the next  
option that is described; or the user can press the “R” key to view and select the previous  
option. An “input” field type means the user must type an entry in the field according to the  
parameters described. A “fixed” field is locked, and cannot be changed by the user.  
Note: Edits can be made in the configuration database in one of two ways: 1) If the complete  
field is highlighted, use the space bar to toggle forward or the “R” key to reverse toggle  
through the options for that field. 2) If only the first space or the field is highlighted, type in  
the data that applies to that field.  
Note: Edits to the configuration database can be saved after each change in one of two ways:  
1) Press an arrow key and then Enter or Return once; or 2) Press Enter or Return twice after  
all selections and entries are made in the screen but before leaving the screen. If the entries  
have been accepted, a message “Configuration Successful…Press Any Key To Continue”  
appears on the screen.  
Note: Press CONTROL-A for help information on moving around and editing fields.  
1. Refer to Figure 575-1. Check that the STATUS indicator on the front panel of the TAU  
module is green, indicating that the module is operating normally.  
2. To drop a network or customer DS1 signal, connect a patch cord from the TX Bantam jack  
on the front panel of the TAU module to the monitoring equipment.  
Note: The DS3 MUX must be equipped to perform TAU commands.  
3. Use the arrow keys to select System Maintenance from the Main Menu. Press Enter or  
Return.  
4. Use the arrow keys to select Test Access Unit Status/Commands from the System  
Maintenance menu. Press Enter or Return. A Test Access Unit Status/Commands screen  
appears as shown in Figure 575-2. If a TAU module is installed and a Version B DS3 MUX  
module is in place to support it, the TAU Present Status field indicates YES.  
2-239  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 Issue 4 June 2000 Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-575  
Page 2 of 5  
5. Determine the Group number (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7) for the DS1 signal you wish to  
drop/monitor. At the Group prompt, select the group number.  
6. Determine the DS1 number (1 through 4) for the DS1 signal you wish to drop/monitor. At  
the DS1# prompt, select the DS1 signal.  
7. Use the arrow keys to move to the Drop Direction Command toggle field. Select ‘blank  
field’, NONE, CUSTOMER, or NETWORK. Press Enter or Return. The following  
confirmation message appears:  
This Command Could Be Service Affecting...  
Are You Sure? (y/n)  
8. Press Enter or Return, then observe the indications on the monitoring equipment.  
Note: The Drop Direction Status field displays NONE (the default), CUSTOMER, or  
NETWORK.  
9. To drop other DS1 signals, repeat Steps 1 through 8, making different selections in Steps 5  
(Group) and 6 (DS1 Number).  
Note: All possible DS1 Drop and Insert configurations using the TAU module are  
illustrated in Figure 575-3 for reference.  
Note: The Intrusive Test indicator on the front panel of the TAU module will light red  
during any intrusive (Insert) tests.  
Note: Press the TAU’s Line Code pushbutton switch as necessary to select either B8ZS  
(which lights the B8ZS indicator) or AMI for the DS1 bipolar interface.  
10. To insert a Network or Customer DS1 signal:  
a) Perform Steps 1 through 6.  
b) Patch the front panel RX jack to the TX jack.  
c) Move to the Insert Direction Command field on the screen. Select ‘blank field’,  
NONE, CUSTOMER, or NETWORK. Press Enter or Return.  
11. To insert an external DS1 signal:  
a) Perform Steps 1 through 6.  
b) Patch the external test equipment to the RX jack.  
c) Move to the Insert Direction Command field on the screen. Select ‘blank field’,  
NONE, CUSTOMER, or NETWORK. Press Enter or Return.  
12. When you are finished using the TAU module, change the Drop Direction Command and  
Insert Direction Command fields to NONE, then disconnect any patch cords from the  
front panel RX and TX jacks.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-240  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 Issue 4 June 2000 Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-575  
Page 3 of 5  
TAU  
STATUS  
B8ZS  
LINE CODE  
INTRUSIVE  
TEST  
RX  
TX  
D
S
1
5842-B  
Figure 575-1. TAU Module Front Panel  
TEST ACCESS UNIT STATUS/COMMANDS  
Group: 1  
DS1#: 1  
Drop Direction  
==============  
Insert Direction  
================  
Status :  
Command :  
NONE  
NONE  
TAU Present Status: YES  
Press CONTROL-A For Assistance  
6188-B  
Figure 575-2. Test Access Unit Status/Commands Screen  
2-241  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 Issue 4 June 2000 Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-575  
Page 4 of 5  
DS3MUX  
DS3MUX  
DS1s  
DS1s  
DS3  
DS3  
:
:
:
:
CUSTOMER  
(LOW SPEED  
MODULES)  
CUSTOMER  
(LOW SPEED  
MODULES)  
NETWORK  
NETWORK  
:
:
:
:
TAU  
TAU  
RX  
RX  
TX  
TX  
6177-A  
6178-A  
Figure 575-3a. Drop: None/Insert: Network  
Figure 575-3b. Drop: None/Insert: Customer  
DS3MUX  
DS1s  
DS3MUX  
DS1s  
DS3  
NETWORK  
DS3  
:
:
:
:
CUSTOMER  
(LOW SPEED  
MODULES)  
CUSTOMER  
(LOW SPEED  
MODULES)  
NETWORK  
:
:
:
:
TAU  
TAU  
RX  
RX  
TX  
TX  
6176-A  
6175-A  
Figure 575-3c. Drop: Network/Insert: None  
Figure 575-3d. Drop: Customer/Insert: None  
Figure 575-3. TAU Drop/Insert Configurations  
2-242  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 Issue 4 June 2000 Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-575  
Page 5 of 5  
DS3MUX  
DS1s  
DS3MUX  
DS1s  
DS3  
DS3  
:
:
:
:
CUSTOMER  
(LOW SPEED  
MODULES)  
CUSTOMER  
(LOW SPEED  
MODULES)  
NETWORK  
NETWORK  
:
:
:
:
TAU  
TAU  
RX  
RX  
TX  
TX  
6174-A  
6173-A  
Figure 575-3e. Drop: Network / Insert: Customer  
Figure 575-3f. Drop: Customer / Insert: Network  
DS3MUX  
DS1s  
DS3MUX  
DS1s  
DS3  
:
:
DS3  
:
:
CUSTOMER  
(LOW SPEED  
MODULES)  
CUSTOMER  
(LOW SPEED  
MODULES)  
NETWORK  
NETWORK  
:
:
:
:
TAU  
TAU  
RX  
RX  
TX  
TX  
6172-A  
6171-A  
Figure 575-3g. Drop: Network / Insert: Network  
Figure 575-3h. Drop: Customer / Insert: Customer  
Figure 575-3. TAU Drop/Insert Configurations, continued  
2-243  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 Issue 4 June 2000 Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-576  
Page 1 of 2  
TBOS CHASSIS DAISY-CHAINING  
Summary: This procedure provides instructions for daisy-chaining one TBOS link to several  
chassis configured for compressed TBOS. Up to four chassis can be connected in this manner.  
1) Assign a different address in the range 0 through 7 to each of the compressed displays  
available on the link.  
Reference: DLP-549 Serial Port Configuration  
2) Make sure each chassis in the chain has an MPU installed.  
Reference: DLP-502 MPU Installation and Testing  
Reference: DLP-519 MPU Replacement and Testing  
3) Remove the termination strap from the Berg jumper pins labeled "JD 13" from each MPU's  
PC board except the last one in the chain, as shown in Figure 576-1.  
4) Make connections between chassis: from each Port 1 Txto Tx; from each Port 1 Tx+ to  
Tx+; from each Port 1 Rxto Rx; and from each Port 1 Rx+ to Rx+, as shown in  
Figure 576-2. Refer to the Soneplex Broadband System Chassis Installation Manual, listed  
under Related Publications at the beginning of this manual, for wiring instructions.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-244  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 Issue 4 June 2000 Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
DLP-576  
Page 2 of 2  
BERG JUMPER  
JD 13  
LAST  
CHASSIS  
ALL OTHER  
CHASSIS  
IN CHAIN (NO STRAP)  
10387-A  
Note: The default setting is “strapped”.  
Figure 576-1. Berg Jumper Configuration on MPU for TBOS Linking  
PORT 4  
PORT 1  
+ + –  
RX TX  
CHASSIS #1  
.
.
.
PORT 4  
PORT 1  
+ + –  
RX TX  
CHASSIS #4  
10392-A  
Figure 576-2. Daisy-Chaining Chassis for TBOS Linking  
2-245  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 Issue 4 June 2000 Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
2-246  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-100  
Page 1 of 2  
MAINTENANCE PHILOSOPHY  
Summary: Soneplex maintenance philosophy is built on the collection of system information  
through inspection of the Soneplex modules themselves, and through software interfaces. Central  
office (near-end) alarms are displayed on the modules in the chassis. Remote (far-end) alarms are  
displayed on the corresponding near-end modules by pressing the DISP RMT switch on the APU.  
Alarm information is also gathered through a software interface such as Craft, TL1 or TBOS.  
Trouble Analysis Procedures  
Trouble analysis procedures found in this document involve replacing faulty modules and  
obtaining alarm and status reports. Status and alarm reports are then analyzed to determine  
proper system operation and locate trouble.  
Module Failures  
APU, DLX, DS3 MUX, HLXC, MPU, ODS2, and RLX module failures are identified by status  
indicators and reported by system alarms. The first step in analyzing a module failure is to look  
for a red status LED indicator on the module. If operating the system through the Craft Interface,  
display the Active Alarms screen, and look for modules with a COMM FAIL or BOARD FAIL  
condition. Push the Reset switch on the module in question or perform a module reset through  
the Craft Interface. If these actions fail to restart the module, unplug and reseat the module in  
question. Reseating the module can correct a contact problem and avoid the return of a good  
module for repair. Use caution when unplugging modules, ensuring that protection switching is  
available for the module being removed.  
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Protection Considerations  
Modules can be damaged by static electricity that builds up in work areas, especially in areas  
with low relative humidity. The static buildup in work areas (on work surfaces, people, and  
clothing) is produced by the rubbing of objects together to produce an electrical charge.  
Caution: Electronic modules can be damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD). Before  
handling modules, wear an anti-static discharge wrist strap to prevent damage to  
electronic components. Place modules in anti-static packing material when transporting  
or storing. When working on modules, always place them on an approved anti-static mat  
that is electrically grounded.  
2-247  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-100  
Page 2 of 2  
All personnel handling modules should take the following precautions.  
1. Keep materials that tend to generate static electricity such as plastics, nylon clothing, and  
Styrofoam containers away from all modules.  
2. Read all caution and warning labels on bags and shipping cartons before opening any  
package.  
3. Open all modules, using properly grounded wrist straps and table mats designed to  
dissipate static electricity.  
4. Soneplex chassis are equipped with a grounding jack for connecting anti-static ground wrist  
straps. The jack is located in the front on the right side of the chassis.  
5. If possible, wait to remove modules from their protective anti-static packaging until it is  
time to install them into a chassis.  
6. Never touch module components or connector pins. Handle all modules only by the front  
plate, extractor, or by the card edges.  
7. Ensure that all modules removed from the chassis or not installed, are properly stored in  
anti-static packing material.  
2-248  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-101  
Page 1 of 9  
SPECIFICATIONS  
Summary: This TAD shows technical specifications for the Soneplex Broadband system with  
MPU Version 5 software in Table 101-1 (System Specifications), Table 101-2 (DS3 MUX  
Power), Table 101-3 (DLX Power), Table 101-4 (C1 HLXC Power), Table 101-5 (Version D and  
E HLXC Power), Table 101-6 (ODS2 Power), Table 101-7 (A2 RLX Power), and Table 101-8  
(Version B RLX / RLXIOR Power).  
Table 101-1. Soneplex Broadband System (V5) Specifications  
PARAMETER  
SPECIFICATION  
REMARKS  
Dimensions  
Chassis (H × W × D)  
10 × 21.5 × 12 inches  
(25.4 × 54.6 × 30.5 cm)  
Environment  
Operating Relative Humidity  
5% to 95%  
No condensation  
A and B feed  
Operating Temperature  
–40°F to 149°F (–40°C to 65°C)  
–40°F to 158°F (–40°C to 70°C)  
Storage Temperature  
Power  
Input Voltage Range  
–42.5 to –56.5 VDC  
Consumption (–48 VDC):  
APU  
7.5 watts maximum  
5 watts maximum  
See Table 101-2  
See Table 101-3  
See Table 101-4  
MPU  
DS3 MUX  
Per module  
Per module  
DLX  
C1 HLXC  
Version D and later HLXCs  
B1 HLXR  
See Table 101-5  
9.9 watts  
8.3 watts  
Simplex current enabled  
Simplex current disabled  
Version D and later HLXRs,  
HLXR 3192  
9 watts  
Simplex power enabled (D1, D2,  
D2A-SP, D3, D3A, D3B HLXRs  
only)  
4 watts  
Simplex power disabled (D2A,  
D4, D4A, D4B, and Version E  
HLXRs; and HLXR 3192 only)  
ODS2  
See Table 101-6  
A2 RLX  
See Table 101-7  
Version B RLX / RLXIOR  
TAU  
See Table 101-8  
2 watts maximum  
8.2 watts maximum  
Determined by configuration  
RTAU  
Maximum Power  
(continued)  
2-249  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-101  
Page 2 of 9  
Table 101-1. Soneplex Broadband System (V5) Specifications, continued  
PARAMETER  
SPECIFICATION  
REMARKS  
DS3 Interface (DS3 MUX)  
DS3 Input Level  
+5.7 dBm to –7.3 dBm  
–1.8 to +5.7 dBm  
DS3 Transmit Power Level  
Format  
Bipolar, Return to Zero  
75 ohms (nominal)  
B3ZS  
Impedance  
With splitter/combiner  
Line Code  
Line Rate  
44.736 Mbps 20 ppm  
450 ft. to cross-connect facility  
Maximum Span  
DS3 Interface (D1 DS3 MUX)  
DS3 Input Level  
+5.7 dBm to –7.4 dBm  
–1.8 to +5.7 dBm  
DS3 Transmit Power Level  
Format  
Bipolar, Return to Zero  
75 ohms nominal  
Impedance  
With splitter/combiner  
Line Code  
B3ZS  
Line Rate  
44.736 MHz 20 ppm  
450 ft. to cross-connect facility  
Maximum Span  
DLX Module  
Format  
Bipolar, Return to Zero  
100 ohms 5%  
0 to –10 dB  
Transparent to frame format  
Input Impedance  
Input Signal Level  
Line Code  
AMI or B8ZS  
Line Rate  
Standard DS1 code at  
1.544 Mbps 200 bps (130 ppm)  
Output Pulse  
Output Signal Level  
C1 HLXC Module  
Loop Loss  
Per GR-499-CORE, Issue 4  
0 dB  
22 AWG ABAM  
<35 dB @ 196 kHz  
135 ohm termination  
Loop Types  
Two-pair, single or mixed gauges With or without bridged taps  
Transmission:  
Format  
Two 784 kbps full duplex pairs,  
2B1Q modulation  
Line Impedance  
135 ohms nominal  
–132 5 VDC  
>20 dB  
Balanced  
Loop Power Output Voltage  
Return Loss  
40 kHz to 200 kHz  
Total Signal Power  
+13.5 dBm 0.5 dBm  
(continued)  
2-250  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-101  
Page 3 of 9  
Table 101-1. Soneplex Broadband System (V5) Specifications, continued  
PARAMETER  
SPECIFICATION  
REMARKS  
Version D and later HLXC  
Modules  
Loop Loss  
Loop Types  
Transmission:  
Format  
< 35 dB @ 196 kHz  
135 ohm termination  
Two-pair, single or mixed gauges With or without bridged taps  
Two 784 kbps full duplex pairs,  
2B1Q modulation  
Line Impedance  
135 ohms nominal  
Balanced  
Loop Power Output Voltage  
–132 5 VDC (without HRX)  
130 VDC (with HRX)  
Return Loss  
Total Signal Power  
B1 HLXR  
>20 dB  
40 kHz to 200 kHz  
+13.5 dBm 0.5 dBm  
DS1 Interface:  
Input / Output Signals  
Frequency  
Per ANSI T1-403  
1.544 Mbps  
HDSL Interface:  
Format  
Two 784 kbps full duplex pairs,  
2B1Q  
Impedance  
Loop Loss  
135 ohms  
<35 dB  
196 kHz  
Loop Type  
Output Signal Level  
Return Loss  
Power  
Two pair, single or mixed gauges With or without bridged taps  
+13.5 dBm  
>20 dB  
40 to 200 kHz  
–42 to –56 VDC (local)  
85 to 130 VDC (line)  
(continued)  
2-251  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-101  
Page 4 of 9  
Table 101-1. Soneplex Broadband System (V5) Specifications, continued  
PARAMETER  
SPECIFICATION  
REMARKS  
Version D and later HLXRs; HLXR 3192  
DS1 Interface:  
Input / Output Signals  
Per ANSI T1-403  
1.544 Mbps  
Frequency  
HLXR 3192 only: 200 bps  
received signal tolerance;  
50 bps generated signals  
HDSL Interface:  
Format  
Two 784 kbps full duplex pairs  
2B1Q  
Impedance  
Loop Loss  
135 ohms  
<35 dB  
196 kHz  
Loop Type  
Output Signal Level  
Return Loss  
Power  
Two pair, single or mixed gauges With or without bridged taps  
+13.5 dBm  
>20 dB  
40 to 200 kHz  
–42.5 to –56.5 VDC (local)  
130 VDC or 130 VDC (line)  
Version D HLXR only  
Constant voltage differential  
between loops 1 and 2 can vary  
from 42 VDC to 260 VDC  
Version A and Version B HRXs  
Impedance  
135 ohms  
Input Voltage  
Up to 130 VDC nominal  
Up to 35 dB  
Loop Loss Allowed  
HLXC to HRX, first HRX to  
second HRX, and HRX to HLXR  
Output Signal Level  
Power Consumption  
ODS2 Module  
13.5 0.5 dBm  
6.2 watts (max. per repeater)  
All power dissipated in the unit.  
Nominal  
Fiber Cable  
9/125 µm single mode  
6.312 Mbps 20 ppm  
Two single mode  
1300 nm 40 nm  
22.0 dB (minimum)  
FC or SC type (Tx/Rx)  
–7 dBm 2 dB  
Line Rate  
Number of Fibers  
Operating Wavelength  
Optical Budget  
Per ODS2 module  
Optical Connector  
Optical Transmit Power  
Receive Device  
Average power  
PIN Photodiode  
Receiver Dynamic Range  
Transmit Device  
–5 to –31 dBm @10-9 BER  
Laser  
(continued)  
2-252  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-101  
Page 5 of 9  
Table 101-1. Soneplex Broadband System (V5) Specifications, continued  
PARAMETER  
SPECIFICATION  
REMARKS  
A2 RLX Module  
Frame Format  
Frequency  
SF, ESF, SLC96, and unframed  
1.544 Mbps 200 bps (130 ppm)  
0 dB to –33 dB  
Input Signal Level  
Clock recovery range for loop  
timing.  
Line Code  
AMI or B8ZS  
Output Line Buildout Settings  
Output Signal Range  
0.0, 7.5, 15.0, and 22.5 dB  
Up to 3,000 feet (914.4 meters)  
Up to 6,000 feet (1,828.8 meters)  
with ideal cable conditions.  
Span Power  
60 mA, –140 VDC max.  
Up to 7 or 14 watts  
Version B RLX / RLXIOR Modules  
Frame Format  
SF, ESF, SLC96 and unframed  
1.544 Mbps 130 ppm  
0 dB to –33 dB  
Frequency  
Input Signal Level  
Clock recovery range for loop  
timing  
Line Code  
AMI or B8ZS  
Output Signal LBO Settings  
Output Signal Range  
0.0, 7.5, 15.0 and 22.5 dB  
Up to 3,000 feet (914.4 meters)  
over 22 AWG wire  
Up to 6,000 feet (1,828.8  
meters) depending on cable  
characteristics  
Span Power  
60 mA, 140 VDC maximum  
Up to 8 or 16 watts  
Streaker Module  
Internal Batteries  
Jack Type  
4 AAA 1.5 volt (6 VDC)  
Bantam  
Mounted on PCB  
System Input Voltage Range  
42.5 to 56.5 VDC  
48 VDC nominal  
TAU Module  
DS1 Jack Access Jack Type  
Electrical Interface  
Impedance  
Bantam  
Bipolar  
100 ohms nominal  
AMI or B8ZS  
1.544 Mbps 130 ppm max.  
Line Code  
Controlled by front panel switch  
(continued)  
Line Rate  
2-253  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-101  
Page 6 of 9  
Table 101-1. Soneplex Broadband System (V5) Specifications, continued  
PARAMETER  
SPECIFICATION  
REMARKS  
RTAU Module  
DS1 Jack Access Jack Type  
Electrical Interface  
Impedance  
Bantam  
Bipolar  
100 ohms nominal 5%  
AMI or B8ZS  
Line Code  
Controlled by front panel switch  
Per catalog number.  
Line Rate  
1.544 Mbps 130 ppm max.  
Interface Connections  
Alarm  
0.045 inch wire wrap post  
FC or SC  
Optical DS2  
DS3 Input  
75 ohm BNC  
HDSL/DS1  
0.045 inch wire wrap post  
MPU (Front Port)  
Craft Interface  
Serial Ports  
Port 1  
DB-25 D subminiature  
Craft, TL1 (EIA-232)  
0.045 inch wire wrap post  
DB-25 D subminiature  
DB-25 D subminiature  
TBOS (EIA-422)  
Port 2  
TBOS, Craft, TL1 (EIA-232)  
Craft, TL1, TL1 (X.25) (EIA-232)  
Port 3  
2-254  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-101  
Page 7 of 9  
Table 101-2. DS3 MUX Power Characteristics  
MAX. POWER  
CONSUMPTION/DISSIPATION  
MAX. CURRENT DRAIN  
(AT –48 VDC)  
8 watts  
166 mA  
Note: Two DS3 MUXs (one working and one protect) are  
used per chassis in Broadband (V5) applications.  
Table 101-3. Broadband (V5) Power Characteristics with DLX  
NO. OF DLXS IN  
CHASSIS  
MAX. POWER  
CONSUMPTION/DISSIPATION  
MAX. CURRENT DRAIN  
(AT –48 VDC)  
1
2 watts  
41 mA  
28  
84 watts  
1.8 amps  
Note: Power characteristics for fully configured chassis include common  
equipment: APU (7.5 watts), MPU (5 watts), and two DS3 MUX  
modules (8 watts each), for a total of 28 watts.  
Table 101-4. Broadband Power Characteristics with C1 HLXC  
HLXR  
CONFIGURATION  
NO. OF C1 HLXCS  
IN CHASSIS  
MAX. POWER  
CONSUMPTION  
MAX. POWER  
DISSIPATION  
MAX. CURRENT DRAIN  
(AT –48 VDC)  
Span Powered B1  
HLXR with DS1  
Simplex Disabled  
1
22.7 watts  
11.9 watts  
473 mA  
28  
1
664 watts  
28.2 watts  
361 watts  
12.4 watts  
13.8 amps  
587 mA  
Span Powered B1  
HLXR with DS1  
Simplex Enabled  
28  
1
818 watts  
8.9 watts  
375 watts  
8.9 watts  
17 amps  
248 mA  
Local Powered B1  
HLXR  
28  
277 watts  
277 watts  
5.8 amps  
Note: Power characteristics for fully configured chassis include common equipment: APU (7.5 watts), MPU  
(5 watts), and two DS3 MUX modules (8 watts each), for a total of 28 watts.  
2-255  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-101  
Page 8 of 9  
Table 101-5. Broadband Power Characteristics Version D and later HLXCs  
HLXR  
CONFIGURATION  
# OF HRXS IN  
SYSTEM  
# OF HLXCS IN  
CHASSIS  
MAX. POWER  
CONSUMPTION  
MAX. POWER  
DISSIPATION  
MAX. CURRENT DRAIN  
(AT –48 VDC)  
Span Power ON;  
DS1 simplex  
0
1
10.5 watts  
6.5 watts  
219 mA  
disabled; D2A, D4,  
D4A, D4B,  
Version E HLXRs  
28  
1
322 watts  
21.5 watts  
630 watts  
25.5 watts  
210 watts  
8.5 watts  
266 watts  
8.5 watts  
6.7 amps  
448 mA  
1
28  
1
13.1 amps  
531 mA  
2 (Version  
E HLXR  
only)  
28  
1
742 watts  
19.0 watts  
266 watts  
7.5 watts  
15.4 amps  
396 mA  
Span Power ON;  
DS1 simplex  
0
enabled; D1, D2,  
D2A-SP, D3, D3A,  
D3B HLXRs  
28  
1
560 watts  
28.0 watts  
812 watts  
5.5 watts  
238 watts  
9.5 watts  
294 watts  
5.5 watts  
11.7 amps  
583 mA  
1
0
28  
1
16.9 amps  
115 mA  
Span Power ON;  
Local power at  
remote; D1 HLXR  
28  
1
182 watts  
14.0 watts  
420 watts  
5.5 watts  
182 watts  
7.0 watts  
224 watts  
5.5 watts  
3.8 amps  
292 mA  
8.8 amps  
115 mA  
1
0
28  
1
Span Power OFF;  
Local power at  
remote; D1 HLXR  
28  
182 watts  
182 watts  
3.8 amps  
1
No power values because HRXs require span power.  
Note: Power values for a fully configured chassis (28 HLXCs) include the power of the common equipment:  
APU (7.5 watts), MPU (5 watts), and two DS3 MUX modules (8 watts each), for a total of 28 watts.  
2-256  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-101  
Page 9 of 9  
Table 101-6. Broadband (V5) Power Characteristics with ODS2 Modules  
NO. OF ODS2S  
IN CHASSIS  
MAX. POWER  
CONSUMPTION/DISSIPATION  
MAX. CURRENT DRAIN  
(AT –48 VDC)  
1
4 watts  
83 mA  
14  
84 watts  
1.8 amps  
Note: Power characteristics for fully configured chassis include  
common equipment: APU (7.5 watts), MPU (5 watts), and two DS3  
MUX modules (8 watts each), for a total of 28 watts.  
Table 101-7. Broadband Power Characteristics with A2 RLX  
A2 RLX  
CONFIGURATION  
NO. OF A2 RLXS  
IN CHASSIS  
MAX. POWER  
CONSUMPTION  
MAX. POWER  
DISSIPATION  
MAX. CURRENT DRAIN  
(AT –48 VDC)  
With Span Power  
1
28  
1
12.6 watts  
381 watts  
2.4 watts  
95 watts  
4.1 watts  
143 watts  
2.4 watts  
95 watts  
262 mA  
7.9 amps  
50 mA  
Without Span Power  
28  
2.0 amps  
Note: Power characteristics for fully configured chassis include common equipment: APU (7.5 watts), MPU  
(5 watts), and two DS3 MUX modules (8 watts each), for a total of 28 watts.  
Note: If a T1 repeater is powered by the RLX, Broadband power characteristics will change depending on the  
power consumption of the T1 repeater. The A2 RLX’s maximum span power is 8 watts.  
Table 101-8. Broadband Power Characteristics with Version B RLX / RLXIOR  
VERSION B RLX  
CONFIGURATION  
NO. OF RLXS IN  
CHASSIS  
MAX. POWER  
CONSUMPTION  
MAX. POWER  
DISSIPATION  
MAX. CURRENT DRAIN  
(AT –48 VDC)  
With Span Power,  
–130 VDC  
1
13.4 watts  
5.0 watts  
279 mA  
28  
1
403 watts  
23.4 watts  
168 watts  
6.6 watts  
8.4 amps  
487 mA  
With Span Power,  
130 VDC  
28  
1
683 watts  
2.7 watts  
104 watts  
213 watts  
2.7 watts  
104 watts  
14.2 amps  
57 mA  
Without Span Power  
28  
2.2 amps  
Note: Power characteristics for fully configured chassis include common equipment: APU (7.5 watts), MPU (5  
watts), and two DS3 MUX modules (8 watts each), for a total of 28 watts.  
Note: If a T1 repeater is powered by the RLX, Broadband power characteristics will change depending on  
the power consumption of the T1 repeater. The Version B RLX / RLXIOR’s maximum span power is 8  
watts at –130 VDC, and 16 watts at 130 VDC.  
2-257  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-102  
Page 1 of 5  
LOOPBACK PROCESS DESCRIPTION  
Summary: The HDSL loopback process is similar to other T1 intelligent repeater methods. For  
Version D and later HLX modules, the HLXC loopback is like an intelligent office repeater  
loopback. The HLXR loopback and HRX loopback are like an intelligent inline T1 repeater  
loopback.  
The HDSL loopback operation is described by the diagram in Figure 102-1. The four states are:  
• Disarmed  
• Armed  
• Loopup  
• Loopup/Time-Out Disable  
DISARMED  
STATE  
ARMING  
ARM  
TIME-OUT  
ARMED  
STATE  
ACTIVATION  
LOOPUP  
TIME-OUT  
DISARM  
DEACTIVATION  
LOOPUP  
STATE  
LOOPUP  
TIME-OUT  
DISABLE  
LOOPUP/NO TIME-OUT  
STATE  
7077-C  
Figure 102-1. Loopback Operation State Diagram  
Inband and ESF data link sequences and time-out operations produce the state transitions. These  
sequences and time-out values are:  
• Arming sequence (inband or ESF data link)  
• Activation sequence  
• Deactivation sequence  
• Disarming sequence (inband or ESF data link)  
• Loopup time-out  
• Arming time-out  
2-258  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-102  
Page 2 of 5  
The inband control code sequences will be recognized either in DS1 framed format (SF or ESF  
framing) or in unframed format.  
Table 102-1 contains a summary of loopback time-out and control codes. Notice that in the  
Default Code column, the inband codes are shown left bit transmitted first and the ESF data link  
codes are shown with the right bit transmitted first.  
Table 102-1. HDSL Loopback Time-Out and Control Default Codes  
NAME  
DEFAULT CODE  
DETECTION TIME  
COMMENTS  
Arming (inband)  
11000  
> 5 seconds  
The signal is sent inband or over  
ESF data link. HDSL units in  
disarmed state make the transition  
to armed state. When the inband  
arming code is detected, the  
Arming (ESF)  
0001 0010 1111 1111 4 repetitions  
smartjack loopup state activates.  
Activation (HLXC) 1101 0011 1101 0011 > 3 seconds  
Activation (HRX) 1100 0111 0100 0001 > 3 seconds  
Activation (HLXR) 1100 0111 0100 0010 > 3 seconds  
The signal is sent inband. HDSL  
units go to loopup state when they  
are in armed state. Loopup is  
activated for selected units.  
Deactivation (all  
HDSL units)  
1001 0011 1001 0011 > 5 seconds  
The signal is sent inband. Units in  
loopup state go back to armed state.  
Loopup time-out  
disable  
1101 0101 1101 0110 > 3 seconds  
Disable loopup time-out. Active  
loopbacks stay up until deactivation  
or disarm code is received.  
Disarming (inband) 11100  
> 5 seconds  
The signal is sent inband or over  
ESF data link. HDSL units are  
disarmed.  
Disarming (ESF)  
Arming time-out  
0010 0100 1111 1111 4 repetitions  
n/a  
n/a  
2 hours  
An armed HDSL unit goes to  
disarmed state.  
Loopup time-out  
Programmable  
from Version D  
HLXC  
An HDSL unit in loopup goes to  
armed state.  
Note: All codes are programmable.  
2-259  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-102  
Page 3 of 5  
Disarmed State  
The normal operation mode is the disarmed state. Although each HDSL unit is transparent to the  
data flow, each monitors the inband data flow and the ESF data link for the arming sequence.  
The CPE smartjack loopup inband control code sequence arms the loopback capability of all  
HDSL units at the same time. Each HDSL unit arms when the arm sequence code has been  
received for five seconds.  
The HDSL unit detects the unit arming and smartjack loopup sequence without disturbing the  
detection by the smartjack (the smartjack loopup response needs a minimum of five seconds).  
The arming sequence requires that the smartjack does the loopup and all HDSL units go from the  
disarmed state into the armed state. No other control code sequences are detected while in the  
disarmed state.  
The ESF data link sequence that arms the loopback capability of all HDSL units at the same time  
is the standard 16-bit ESF data link sequence used for CPE smartjack loopup. The ESF arm  
sequence is repeated four times.  
Note: If the HLXR is provisioned as NID-enabled, then the arming sequence will cause  
the HLXR to loop back in response to this NID (i.e. smartjack) loop-up code.  
In the same manner as described above for the inband code, the HDSL unit detects the unit  
arming and smartjack loopup sequence without disturbing the detection by the smartjack. For  
example, the ESF arm sequence causes the smartjack to loopup and all HDSL units move from  
the disarmed state into the armed state. No other ESF data link control code sequences are  
detected in the disarmed state.  
Note: If the HLXR is provisioned as NID-enabled, then the arming sequence will cause  
the HLXR to loop back in response to this NID (i.e. smartjack) loop-up code.  
Armed State  
The HDSL unit continues to be transparent to data flow in the armed state. However, the units  
monitor the inband data flow for activation and disarming sequences and the ESF data link for  
the disarming sequence.  
Note: The ESF data link does not directly command a loopup of the HDSL units.  
A unit returns to the disarmed state after an arming time-out occurs, or a disarm code is received.  
2-260  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-102  
Page 4 of 5  
Transition from Armed to Loopup State  
A specific HDSL unit moves from the armed state into the loopup state when commanded by an  
inband control code sequence. There is a unique 16-bit activation control code sequence for each  
HDSL unit as shown previously in Table 102-1.  
As part of the loopup activation process, each of the HDSL units will respond with a loopup  
identification signature that consists of a burst of bit errors in the looped payload. Upon  
receiving three or more seconds of the specific activation code sequence, the addressed HDSL  
unit will respond as follows:  
• Loopback of the received payload data for five seconds.  
• A burst of bit errors in the looped payload.  
• Continued loopback of the received payload.  
The number of bit errors returned in this loopup identification signature is specific to each HDSL  
unit as follows:  
• HLXC 231 bit errors  
• HRX – 10 bit errors  
• HLXR – 20 bit errors  
Note: The bit errors inserted for the loopup identification signature may occur in the  
frame bit position as well as the payload in a looped SF or ESF framed data signal.  
Transition from Armed to Disarmed State  
The standard 5-bit inband disarming sequence used for CPE smartjack loopdown is a command  
for all HDSL units to go from the armed state into the disarmed state. Each HDSL unit disarms  
after receiving the command for five seconds.  
The ESF data link disarming sequence used for CPE smartjack loopdown is a command for all  
HDSL units to go from the armed state into the disarmed state. The ESF disarm sequence is  
repeated four times.  
All HDSL units go from the armed state into the disarmed state when the default time-out value  
of two hours is reached.  
2-261  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-102  
Page 5 of 5  
Loopup State  
The selected HDSL unit provides continuous loopup of the DS1 signal in the loopup state. At the  
same time, the data flow is monitored for the inband deactivation sequence, the inband disarming  
sequence, and the ESF data link disarming sequence. A loopup time-out event forces a return to the  
armed state. No other control code sequences are detected in the loopup state.  
Transition from Loopup State to Loopup/No Time-out State  
A single inband 16-bit control code commands all HDSL units to go from the loopup state to the  
loopup/no time-out state. This loopup time-out disable code must be received for at least three  
seconds.  
When a unit is in the Loopup/No Time-out State, the loopback remains active until either the 16-  
bit deactivation code or disarm code (5-bit inband or ESF data link) is received.  
Transition from Loopup to Armed State  
A single inband 16-bit deactivate control code sequence is a command to all HDSL units to  
move from the loopup state into the armed state. All HDSL units use the same deactivation  
sequence. The deactivation sequence lasts a minimum of five seconds  
When the units are back in the armed state, they still respond to activation sequence control  
codes. All HDSL units move from the loopup state into the armed state when the selected loopup  
time-out value is reached. The loopup time-out is programmable via the MPU.  
Transition from Loopup to Disarmed State  
HDSL units can be commanded to move from the loopup state into the disarmed state all at the  
same time by using the standard 5-bit inband disarming sequence, or by using the ESF data link  
sequence.  
2-262  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-103  
Page 1 of 3  
PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTING LOCATIONS  
Summary: Performance Monitoring (PM) information for both DS1 and HDSL is found on the  
MPU’s main menu under Performance Monitoring. The following information is designed to  
show where the PM information is being reported from (that is, Near End [NEND] and Far End  
[FEND] PM report locations). Refer to Figure 103-1 for a drawing of the Soneplex HDSL  
system. Refer to Figure 103-2 for a drawing of the Soneplex T1 Repeater (RLX) system. Refer to  
Figure 103-3 for a drawing of the Soneplex Optical DS2 (QLX) system.  
Soneplex HDSL System  
HLXC  
HLXR  
CSU  
HRX  
CSU  
FEND  
NEND  
NETWORK  
NEND  
DS1  
FEND  
B
LOOP 1  
HDSL  
LOOP 1  
HDSL  
DS1  
A
C
D
E
F
H
LOOP 2  
LOOP 2  
G
14861-A  
Figure 103-1. Location of Critical Alarm Points on Soneplex HDSL System  
A= External CSU that will inject PRM (Performance Report Messages) back to B  
reporting all DS1 Far End Alarms. Errors or problems received at A are  
reported back to B via the PRM in the FDL (Facility Data Link).  
B= DS1 errors at HLXC are reported as T1-1-X-X-1 NEND PM and alarms.  
Report measures the actual DS1 performance as received from CSU A.  
- OR -  
DS1 errors at HLXC are reported as T1-1-X-X-1 FEND PM and alarms from  
CSU A via the PRM in the FDL (Facility Data Link).  
C= HDSL errors at HLXC are reported as HDSL-1-X-X-1 (Loop 1) or HDSL-1-  
X-X-2 (Loop 2) NEND PM and alarms.  
D= HDSL errors at HRX are reported as HDSL-1-X-X-1 (Loop 1) or HDSL-1-X-  
X-2 (Loop 2) REPR PM and alarms at HRX on CO side.  
E= HDSL errors at HRX are reported as HDSL-1-X-X-1 (Loop 1) or HDSL-1-X-  
X-2 (Loop 2) NEND PM and alarms at HRX (REPC) on CPE side.  
F = HDSL errors at HLXR are reported as HDSL-1-X-X-1 (Loop 1) or HDSL-1-  
X-X-2 (Loop 2) FEND PM and alarms.  
2-263  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-103  
Page 2 of 3  
G= DS1 errors at HLXR are reported as T1-1-X-X-2 NEND PM and alarms.  
Report measures the actual DS1 performance as received on transmission  
from CSU H.  
- OR -  
DS1 errors at HLXR are reported as T1-1-X-X-2 FEND PM and alarms from  
CSU H via the PRM in the FDL (Facility Data Link).  
H= External CSU at H will inject PRM back to G reporting DS1 Far End Alarms.  
Errors are accumulated in the transmission of the DS1 from A to H transmit  
direction.  
Soneplex T1 Repeater (RLX) System  
RLX  
CSU  
CSU  
NETWORK  
T1 REPEATER SPAN  
B
DS1  
DS1  
A
H
G
14863-A  
Figure 103-2. Location of Critical Alarm Points on Soneplex RLX System  
A= External CSU that will inject PRM (Performance Report Messages) back to B  
reporting all DS1 Far End Alarms. This is due to corrupted data received at A  
and reported back to B via the PRM in the FDL (Facility Data Link).  
B= RLX DS1 input monitors T1-1-X-X-1 NEND PM and alarms. Report measures  
the actual DS1 performance as received on transmission from CSU A.  
- OR -  
RLX DS1 input monitors T1-1-X-X-1 FEND PM and alarms from CSU A via  
the PRM in the FDL (Facility Data Link).  
G= RLX DS1 input monitors T1-1-X-X-2 NEND PM and alarms. This report  
measures the actual DS1 performance as received on transmit from CSU H.  
- OR -  
RLX DS1 input monitors T1-1-X-X-2 FEND PM and alarms from CSU H via  
the PRM in the FDL (Facility Data Link).  
H= External CSU at H will inject PRM back to G reporting DS1 Far End Alarms.  
This is due to corrupted data accumulated in the transmission of the DS1 from  
A to H transmit direction.  
2-264  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-103  
Page 3 of 3  
Soneplex Optical DS2 (QLX) System  
QLX  
QLX  
CSU  
CSU  
NETWORK  
B1  
DS1  
G1  
DS1  
H1  
A1  
DS2  
14862-A  
Figure 103-3. Location of Critical Alarm Points on Soneplex QLX System  
A1= External CSU that will inject PRM (Performance Report Messages) back to  
B1 reporting all DS1 Far End Alarms. This is due to corrupted data received at  
A1 and reported back to B1 via the PRM in the FDL (Facility Data Link).  
B1= QLX DS1 input monitors T1-1-X-X-1 NEND PM and alarms. Report measures  
the actual DS1 performance as received on transmission from CSU A1.  
G1= QLX DS1 input monitors T1-1-X-X-2 NEND PM and alarms. This report  
measures the actual DS1 performance as received on transmit from CSU H1.  
H1= External CSU at H1 will inject PRM back to G1 reporting DS1 Far End  
Alarms. This is due to corrupted data accumulated in the transmission of the  
DS1 from A1 to H1 transmit direction.  
Note: Ax indicates DS1 #1 of four possible DS1s.  
2-265  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-104  
Page 1 of 11  
TBOS INTERFACE DESCRIPTION  
Summary: This section provides information for operating the Soneplex Broadband system  
using a Telemetry Byte Oriented Serial (TBOS) remote interface. The TBOS interface provides a  
reliable means of communicating transmission alarm information between an Alarm Processing  
telemetry Remote (APR) unit and the Soneplex Broadband system.  
MPU  
The MPU contains the processor, memory, and communication facilities to interface with a  
centralized system administration control center. The MPU monitors the alarm/status conditions  
of each module installed in the same chassis, as well as the alarm/status conditions of the remote  
modules that are connected to them. The alarm/status conditions are saved in MPU memory for  
transmission to the centralized administration center via TBOS protocol.  
The MPU (Main Processing Unit) interfaces internally to the TBOS communications  
link/protocol link to report alarm/status for local and remote modules, control and report  
loopback configuration, and control and report protection switching status.  
The MPU interfaces externally to a TBOS communications link/protocol. TBOS is the basic  
communications format used by the customer-provided E2A-Alarm Processing telemetry  
Remote (APR) equipment. The E2A-APR allows the concentration of up to 504 alarm  
indications onto a four-wire alarm bus. The E2A-APR operates with a centralized alarm  
surveillance/reporting system similar to the Bell Network Monitoring and Analysis (NMA)  
System and TASC (Telecommunications Alarm Surveillance and Control) or the DFMS (Digital  
Facility Maintenance System). AT&T Compatibility Bulletin 149 (CB-149) specifies the detailed  
requirements of the E2A-APR.  
DS1 Signal Routing  
Each DS1 signal corresponds to a specific mounting slot in the chassis. The DS1 signal and the  
corresponding group-slot numbers are shown in Table 104-1.  
MPU TBOS Interface  
The MPU TBOS interface is designed to meet AT&T CB-149, Section B2. Selection of hardware  
port communication parameters and TBOS display options is performed through the Craft  
Interface Serial Port Configuration screen.  
Reference: DLP-549 Serial Port Configuration  
Information is transferred between the MPU and chassis modules via a synchronous  
communication channel in the chassis backplane. The MPU polls each module for alarm and  
status data and stores it into memory until requested by TBOS. Additionally, commands issued  
by TBOS are passed through the MPU to the target module across this channel.  
2-266  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-104  
Page 2 of 11  
Table 104-2 (TBOS Abbreviations and Acronyms) and Table 104-3 (Expanded Scan Displays 2  
Through 8 Definitions ) list the definitions of the abbreviations used in the TBOS displays shown  
in Figure 104-1 (Expanded Scan Display 1), Figure 104-2 (Expanded Scan Displays 2 through  
8), Figure 104-3 (Command Display 1), and Figure 104-4 (Command Displays 2 through 8). In  
Figure 104-1, scan point (bit) 5, indicates a power alarm. In Figure 104-4, when TBOS issues a  
command from command point 36 (D2 B8ZS), the module assigned to chassis group-slot 1-3  
sets B8ZS line code on DS1 signal number two. Point 64 on the TBOS display is reserved.  
Since the MPU module is used in both the Soneplex Loop Extender chassis and the Soneplex  
Broadband chassis, some TBOS Scan and Command points apply only to modules used only in  
the Soneplex Broadband chassis, such as the DS3 MUX module.  
The MPU scans both the local and remote modules for presentation of alarm and status data to  
TBOS. On the TBOS scan displays, active scan points are identified with a “1”. Inactive points  
are shown by a “0”.  
Commands issued from the Command Display affect any module installed in the chassis. These  
TBOS commands perform the same function as the corresponding commands from the MPU  
Craft Interface.  
Scan Displays (Expanded)  
The MPU provides eight Scan Displays, one for the APU and MPU modules and seven for the  
transmission portion of the chassis. Scan Display 1 shows conditions for the APU and MPU (see  
Figure 104-1). Scan displays 2 through 8 provide scan points for chassis groups 1 through 7,  
respectively (see Figure 104-2).  
Command Displays  
The MPU provides eight TBOS Command Displays for the chassis. Each command display  
provides command points from which the TBOS operator can remotely provision the modules.  
Command Display 1 shows command points for the APU and MPU (see Figure 104-3).  
Command displays 2 through 8 provide command points for chassis groups 1 through 7,  
respectively (see Figure 104-4).  
Scan Displays (Compressed)  
The MPU provides two Compressed Scan Displays, as shown in Figure 104-5 (Compressed Scan  
Display 1) and Figure 104-6 (Compressed Scan Display 2), for a total of 126 scan bits plus two  
reserved bits. Both displays are assigned a different display response address, in the range 0  
through 7, through the MPU Craft Interface.  
2-267  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-104  
Page 3 of 11  
Table 104-1. DS1 Signal Routing  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
GROUP-  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
SLOT  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
NUMBER  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1-1  
1-2  
1-3  
1-4  
2-1  
2-2  
2-3  
8
2-4  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
4-3  
4-4  
5-1  
5-2  
5-3  
5-4  
6-1  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
6-2  
6-3  
6-4  
7-1  
7-2  
7-3  
7-4  
9
3-1  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
3-2  
3-3  
3-4  
4-1  
4-2  
Table 104-2. TBOS Abbreviations and Acronyms  
ABBREVIATION/  
ACRONYM  
ABBREVIATION/  
DESCRIPTION  
Alarm Cut Off  
ACRONYM  
DESCRIPTION  
ACO  
ALM  
APS  
CL  
LPBK  
L/R  
Loopback  
Alarm  
Local/Remote  
Automatic Protection Switching  
LSP  
Low Speed Protect Module  
Low Speed Working Module  
Main Processing Unit  
Clear  
LSW  
MPU  
MX  
CUS  
D
Customer  
DS1 Signal  
Disable  
DS3 MUX or DS3MAP Module Pair  
DS3 MUX or DS3MAP Protect Module  
DS3 MUX or DS3MAP Working Module  
Network  
DIS  
MXP  
MXW  
NET  
OOS  
ENAB  
EQ  
Enable  
Equipped  
Equipment  
EQPT  
Out-of-Service  
FAC  
Facility  
P, PROT  
REM, RMT  
REQ  
Protect  
HS  
HSKP  
HSP  
High Speed  
Remote  
Housekeeping  
Request  
High Speed Protect Module  
High Speed Working Module  
HDSL Terminal Unit CO Side  
HDSL Terminal Unit Remote Side  
In-Service  
RX  
Receive  
HSW  
HLXC  
HLXR  
IS  
SIG  
Signal  
SNR  
Signal to Noise Ratio  
Switch  
SW  
TX  
Transmit  
Unequipped  
Unprotected  
Working  
L
Low Speed Slot  
UNEQ  
UNPROT  
W, WKG  
LBO  
Line Build Out  
LCL, LOC  
LOCK  
Local  
Lockout  
2-268  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-104  
Page 4 of 11  
Table 104-3. Expanded Scan Displays 2 Through 8 Definitions  
DISPLAY  
MODULE TYPE  
DESCRIPTION  
Lx1 EQPT Fail  
QLX  
Module Fail, MPU COMM Fail, Laser Degrade, DS1 TX  
LOS or (SISTER COMM Fail and not SISTER MPU  
COMM Fail).  
HLXC/RLX  
QLX  
BOARD Fail or MPU COMM Fail  
Remote Board Fail  
Lx1 EQPT Fail RMT  
Lx1 Link ALM  
HLXC/RLX  
QLX  
Not Applicable  
DS2 OPTICAL COMM Fail, DS2 OPTICAL LOS, DS2  
OPTICAL OOF, or DS2 OPTICAL BER  
HLXC  
RLX  
LOS, BER or SNR  
BER  
Lx1 RMT Link ALM  
QLX  
REMOTE OPTICAL COMM Fail, REMOTE DS2  
OPTICAL LOS, REMOTE DS2 OPTICAL OOF, or  
REMOTE OPTICAL DS2 BER  
HLXC  
REMOTE LOSW, DC Loop Continuity (if HLXR is line  
powered), BER, or SNR  
RLX  
Not Applicable  
Dx1 SIG Fail  
Dx1 RMT SIG Fail  
Lx1 RMT HSKP A/B  
QLX,/HLXC  
QLX,/HLXC  
QLX  
DS1 RX LOS  
Remote DS1 RX LOS  
Remote Housekeeping Alarm A reported by QFLC. Remote  
Housekeeping Alarm B is not applicable.  
HLXC  
RLX  
Remote Housekeeping Alarm A or B reported by an HLXR.  
Not Applicable  
Lx1 APS DIS  
QLX  
Lx1 APS Status or Lx1 APS lockout status  
1 - x represents the chassis slot number.  
2-269  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-104  
Page 5 of 11  
CRITICAL  
ALARM  
MAJOR  
ALARM  
MINOR  
ALARM  
REMOTE  
ALARM  
POWER  
ALARM  
MPU  
FAIL  
1
9
2
10  
18  
26  
34  
42  
50  
58  
3
11  
19  
27  
35  
43  
51  
59  
4
12  
20  
28  
36  
44  
52  
60  
5
13  
21  
29  
37  
45  
53  
61  
6
14  
22  
30  
38  
46  
54  
62  
7
15  
23  
31  
39  
47  
55  
63  
8
16  
24  
32  
40  
48  
56  
HSKP 1  
ALARM  
HSKP 2  
ALARM  
HSKP 3  
ALARM  
HSKP 4  
ALARM  
HSKP 5  
ALARM  
HSKP 6  
ALARM  
HSKP 7  
ALARM  
HSKP 8  
ALARM  
HSW  
EQPT  
FAIL  
HSP  
EQPT  
FAIL  
HSW  
SIG  
FAIL  
HSP  
SIG  
FAIL  
17  
25  
33  
41  
49  
57  
MXW  
EQPT  
FAIL  
MXP  
EQPT  
FAIL  
MXW  
SIG  
FAIL  
MXP  
SIG  
FAIL  
HS  
UNEQ  
HS  
OSS  
HSW TX  
OFFLINE  
HSW RX  
OFFLINE  
HS  
UNPROT  
HS LBO  
OUT  
HS APS  
DIS  
HS NET  
LPBK  
HS CUS  
LPBK  
HS DS3A  
NET  
LPBK  
HS DS3B  
NET  
LPBK  
HS DS3A  
CUS  
LPBK  
HS DS3B  
CUS  
LPBK  
MX  
UNEQ  
MX OSS  
MXW  
OFFLINE  
MX  
UNPROT  
MX  
LBO OUT  
MX APS  
DIS  
MX NET  
LBPK  
MX TX  
LPBK  
REQ  
MX RX  
LPBK  
REQ  
ACO  
ATT  
RESERVED  
64  
Note: Bit definitions for High Speed (HS) or MUX (MX) modules are not significant when the MPU is  
installed in the Soneplex Loop Extender chassis.  
Figure 104-1. Expanded Scan Display 1  
2-270  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-104  
Page 6 of 11  
L1 EQPT  
FAIL  
L2 EQPT  
FAIL  
L3 EQPT  
FAIL  
L4 EQPT  
FAIL  
L1 EQPT  
FAIL RMT  
L2 EQPT  
FAIL RMT  
L3 EQPT  
FAIL RMT  
L4 EQPT  
FAIL RMT  
1
9
2
10  
18  
26  
34  
3
11  
19  
27  
35  
4
12  
20  
28  
36  
5
13  
21  
29  
37  
45  
53  
61  
6
14  
22  
30  
38  
46  
54  
62  
7
15  
23  
31  
39  
47  
55  
63  
8
16  
24  
32  
40  
48  
56  
L1 LINK  
ALM  
L2 LINK  
ALM  
L3 LINK  
ALM  
L4 LINK  
ALM  
L1 RMT  
L2 RMT  
L3 RMT  
L4 RMT  
LINK ALM  
LINK ALM  
LINK ALM  
LINK ALM  
D1 SIG  
FAIL  
D2 SIG  
FAIL  
D3 SIG  
FAIL  
D4 SIG  
FAIL  
D1 RMT  
SIG FAIL  
D2 RMT  
SIG FAIL  
D3 RMT  
SIG FAIL  
D4 RMT  
SIG FAIL  
17  
25  
33  
L1 RMT  
HSKP A  
L1 RMT  
HSKP B  
L2 RMT  
HSKP A  
L2 RMT  
HSKP B  
L3 RMT  
HSKP A  
L3 RMT  
HSKP B  
L4 RMT  
HSKP A  
L4 RMT  
HSKP B  
L1  
UNEQ  
L2  
UNEQ  
L3  
UNEQ  
L4  
UNEQ  
D1  
OOS  
D2  
OOS  
D3  
OOS  
D4  
OOS  
D1 WKG  
LOC LPBK  
D2 WKG  
D3 WKG  
D4 WKG  
D1 WKG  
REM  
LPBK  
D2 WKG  
REM  
LPBK  
D3 WKG  
REM  
LPBK  
D4 WKG  
REM  
LPBK  
LOC LPBK  
LOC LPBK  
LOC LPBK  
41  
42  
43  
44  
D1 PROT  
LOC  
LPBK  
D2 PROT  
LOC  
LPBK  
D3 PROT  
LOC  
LPBK  
D4 PROT  
LOC  
LPBK  
D1 PROT  
REM  
LPBK  
D2 PROT  
REM  
LPBK  
D3 PROT  
REM  
LPBK  
D4 PROT  
REM  
LPBK  
49  
57  
50  
58  
51  
59  
52  
60  
D1  
AMI  
D2  
AMI  
D3  
AMI  
D4  
AMI  
L1  
OFFLINE  
L1  
UNPROT  
L1 APS  
DIS  
ATT  
RESERVED  
64  
Note: Bit definitions for High Speed (HS) or MUX (MX) modules are not significant when the MPU is  
installed in the Soneplex Loop Extender chassis.  
Note: Scan Displays 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, and 8 are the same as display 2 except for the DS1 signal numbers and  
mounting slot numbers. One group of four mounting slots is displayed on each scan display.  
Figure 104-2. Expanded Scan Displays 2 through 8  
2-271  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-104  
Page 7 of 11  
HS  
EQ  
HS  
UNEQ  
HS  
IS  
HS  
OSS  
HS  
PROT  
HS  
UNPROT  
HSW  
RESET  
HSP  
RESET  
1
9
2
10  
18  
26  
34  
42  
50  
58  
3
11  
19  
27  
35  
43  
51  
59  
4
12  
20  
28  
36  
44  
52  
60  
5
13  
21  
29  
37  
45  
53  
61  
6
14  
22  
30  
38  
46  
54  
62  
7
15  
23  
31  
39  
47  
55  
63  
8
16  
24  
32  
40  
48  
56  
SW TO  
HSW  
SW TO  
HSP  
HS NET  
HS NET  
HS A NET  
LPBK ON  
HS A NET  
LPBK OFF  
HS B NET  
LPBK ON  
HS B NET  
LPBK OFF  
LPBK ON  
LPBK OFF  
HS APS  
ENAB  
HS APS  
DIS  
HS CL  
APS  
LOCK  
17  
25  
33  
41  
49  
57  
HS CUS  
LPBK  
ON  
HS CUS  
LPBK  
OFF  
HS A CUS  
LPBK  
ON  
HS A CUS  
LPBK  
OFF  
HS B CUS  
LPBK  
ON  
HS B CUS  
LPBK  
OFF  
MX  
EQ  
MX  
UNEQ  
MX  
IS  
MX  
OSS  
MX TX  
LBO IN  
MX TX  
LBO OUT  
MX  
PROT  
MX  
UNPROT  
SW TO  
MXW  
SW TO  
MXP  
MX NET  
LPBK  
ON  
MX NET  
LPBK  
OFF  
MX CUS  
LPBK  
ON  
MX CUS  
LPBK  
OFF  
MXW  
RESET  
MXP  
RESET  
MX APS  
ENAB  
MX APS  
DIS  
MX CL  
APS  
LOCK  
ACO  
MPU  
RESET  
ATT  
RESERVED  
64  
Note: Bit definitions for High Speed (HS) or MUX (MX) modules are not significant when the MPU is  
installed in the Soneplex Loop Extender chassis.  
Figure 104-3. Command Display 1  
2-272  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-104  
Page 8 of 11  
L1  
EQ ON  
L1  
EQ OFF  
L2  
EQ ON  
L2  
EQ OFF  
L3  
EQ ON  
L3  
EQ OFF  
L4  
EQ ON  
L4  
EQ OFF  
1
9
2
10  
18  
26  
34  
42  
50  
58  
3
11  
19  
27  
35  
43  
51  
59  
4
12  
20  
28  
36  
44  
52  
60  
5
13  
21  
29  
37  
45  
53  
61  
6
14  
22  
30  
38  
46  
54  
62  
7
15  
23  
31  
39  
47  
55  
63  
8
16  
24  
32  
40  
48  
56  
D1  
IS  
D1  
D2  
IS  
D2  
D3  
IS  
D3  
D4  
IS  
D4  
OOS  
OOS  
OOS  
OOS  
D1 LCL  
LPBK  
ON  
D1 LCL  
LPBK  
OFF  
D2 LCL  
LPBK  
ON  
D2 LCL  
LPBK  
OFF  
D3 LCL  
LPBK  
ON  
D3 CLC  
LPBK  
OFF  
D4 LCL  
LPBK  
ON  
D4 LCL  
LPBK  
OFF  
17  
25  
33  
41  
49  
57  
D1 RMT  
LPBK  
ON  
D1 RMT  
LPBK  
OFF  
D2 RMT  
LPBK  
ON  
D2 RMT  
LPBK  
OFF  
D3 RMT  
LPBK  
ON  
D3 RMT  
LPBK  
OFF  
D4 RMT  
LPBK  
ON  
D4 RMT  
LPBK  
OFF  
D1  
AMI  
D1  
B8ZS  
D2  
AMI  
D2  
B8ZS  
D3  
AMI  
D3  
B8ZS  
D4  
AMI  
D4  
B8ZS  
L1  
RESET  
L2  
RESET  
L3  
RESET  
L4  
RESET  
SW TI  
LSW  
SW TO  
LSP  
L1  
PROT  
L1  
UNPROT  
L1  
APS  
ENAB  
L1  
APS  
DIS  
L1 CL  
APS  
LOCK  
ATT  
RESERVED  
64  
Note: Bit definitions for High Speed (HS) or MUX (MX) modules are not significant when the MPU is  
installed in the Soneplex Loop Extender chassis.  
Note: Command Displays 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, and 8 are the same as display 2 except for the DS1 signal numbers  
and chassis slot numbers. One group of four mounting slots is displayed on each command display.  
Figure 104-4. Command Displays 2 through 8  
2-273  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-104  
Page 9 of 11  
Table 104-4. Compressed TBOS Scan Display Definitions  
DISPLAY  
UNIT TYPE  
Shelf  
DESCRIPTION  
Critical Alarm shelf summary  
Critical Alarm  
Major Alarm  
Minor Alarm  
Remote Alarm  
Power Alarm  
HSW Eqpt Alm  
HSP Eqpt Alm  
HWS Fac Alm  
HSP Fac Alm  
Shelf  
Shelf  
Shelf  
Shelf  
N/A  
Major Alarm shelf summary  
Minor Alarm shelf summary  
Remote Alarm shelf summary  
Shelf Power A or B input failure (but not both)  
Not Applicable for this release  
N/A for this release  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A for this release  
N/A  
N/A for this release  
MXW Eqpt Alm  
MXP Eqpt Alm  
DS3 MUX  
Unit Fail, MPU COMM Fail, DS3 TX LOS, or (SISTER COMM Fail and not SISTER  
MPU COMM Fail)  
MXW Fac Alm  
MXP Fac Alm  
DS3 MUX  
DS3 RX LOS, DS3 RX OOF, DS3 Loopback  
a
Dx L/R Alarm  
ODS2 & QLX DS2 Optical COMM Fail, DS2 Optical LOS, DS2 Optical OOF, DS2 Optical BER,  
DS1 RX LOS, DS1 Loopback  
Dx L/R Alarm  
HLX  
DS1 RX LOS, HDSL LOSW, HDSL BER, HDSL SNR, DC Loop Continuity (if HLXR  
is line powered), DS1 Loopback  
Dx L/R Alarm  
Dx L/R Alarm  
HSKPx Rmt Alm  
RLX  
DLX  
DS1 RX LOS, DS1 RX LOF, DS1 Loopback  
DS1 RX LOS, DS1 BER, DS1 Loopback  
ODS2 & QLX Slot number is x-1: HSKP1 alarm reporting by QFLC or QLX working.  
Slot number is x-2: HSKP2 alarm reporting by QLX working only.  
Slot number is x-3: HSKP3 alarm reporting by QFLC or QLX working.  
Slot number is x-4: HSKP4 alarm reporting by QLX working only.  
HSKPx Rmt Alm  
HSKPx Rmt Alm  
HSKPx Rmt Alm  
Lx Lcl Alarm  
HLX  
RLX  
DLX  
Remote Housekeeping Alarm A or B reported by an HLXR  
N/A  
N/A  
ODS2 & QLX Unit Fail, MPU COMM Fail, Laser Degrade, DS1 TX LOS, or (SISTER COMM Fail  
and not SISTER MPU COMM Fail)  
Lx Lcl Alarm  
Lx Lcl Alarm  
Lx Lcl Alarm  
Lx Rmt Alarm  
Lx Rmt Alarm  
Lx Rmt Alarm  
HLX  
RLX  
DLX  
Unit Fail, MPU COMM Fail  
Unit Fail, MPU COMM Fail  
MPU COMM Fail  
ODS2 & QLX Remote Unit Fail  
HLX  
RLX  
DLX  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
Lx Rmt Alarm  
a
“x” represents the Soneplex chassis (shelf) slot number  
2-274  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-104  
Page 10 of 11  
CRITICAL  
ALARM  
MAJOR  
ALARM  
MINOR  
ALARM  
REMOTE  
FAILURE  
POWER  
ALARM  
MPU  
ALARM  
HSW  
EQPT ALM  
HSP  
EQPT ALM  
1
9
2
10  
18  
26  
34  
42  
50  
58  
3
4
5
13  
21  
29  
37  
45  
53  
61  
6
14  
22  
30  
38  
46  
54  
62  
7
8
HSW  
HSP  
MXW  
MXP  
MXW  
MXP  
D1-1 L/R  
ALARM  
D1-2 L/R  
ALARM  
FAC ALM  
FAC ALM  
EQPT ALM  
EQPT ALM  
FAC ALM  
FAC ALM  
11  
19  
27  
35  
43  
51  
59  
12  
20  
28  
36  
44  
52  
60  
15  
23  
31  
39  
47  
55  
63  
16  
24  
32  
40  
48  
56  
D1-3 L/R  
ALARM  
D1-4 L/R  
ALARM  
D2-1 L/R  
ALARM  
D2-2 L/R  
ALARM  
D2-3 L/R  
ALARM  
D2-4 L/R  
ALARM  
D3-1 L/R  
ALARM  
D3-2 L/R  
ALARM  
17  
25  
33  
41  
49  
57  
D3-3 L/R  
ALARM  
D3-4 L/R  
ALARM  
D4-1 L/R  
ALARM  
D4-2 L/R  
ALARM  
D4-3 L/R  
ALARM  
D4-4 L/R  
ALARM  
D5-1 L/R  
ALARM  
D5-2 L/R  
ALARM  
D5-3 L/R  
ALARM  
D5-4 L/R  
ALARM  
D6-1 L/R  
ALARM  
D6-2 L/R  
ALARM  
D6-3 L/R  
ALARM  
D6-4 L/R  
ALARM  
D7-1 L/R  
ALARM  
D7-2 L/R  
ALARM  
D7-3 L/R  
ALARM  
D7-4 L/R  
ALARM  
HSKP 1-1  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 1-2  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 1-3  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 1-4  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 2-1  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 2-2  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 2-3  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 2-4  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 3-1  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 3-2  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 3-3  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 3-4  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 4-1  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 4-2  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 4-3  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 4-4  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 5-1  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 5-2  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 5-3  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 5-4  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 6-1  
RMT ALM  
ATT  
RESERVED  
64  
Figure 104-5. Compressed Scan Display 1  
2-275  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-104  
Page 11 of 11  
HSKP 6-2  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 6-3  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 6-4  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 7-1  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 7-2  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 7-3  
RMT ALM  
HSKP 7-4  
RMT ALM  
L1-1 LCL  
ALARM  
1
9
2
10  
18  
26  
34  
42  
50  
58  
3
11  
19  
27  
35  
43  
51  
59  
4
12  
20  
28  
36  
44  
52  
60  
5
13  
21  
29  
37  
45  
53  
61  
6
14  
22  
30  
38  
46  
54  
62  
7
15  
23  
31  
39  
47  
55  
63  
8
16  
24  
32  
40  
48  
56  
L1-2 LCL  
ALARM  
L1-3 LCL  
ALARM  
L1-4 LCL  
ALARM  
L2-1 LCL  
ALARM  
L2-2 LCL  
ALARM  
L2-3 LCL  
ALARM  
L2-4 LCL  
ALARM  
L3-1 LCL  
ALARM  
L3-2 LCL  
ALARM  
L3-3 LCL  
ALARM  
L3-4 LCL  
ALARM  
L4-1 LCL  
ALARM  
L4-2 LCL  
ALARM  
L4-3 LCL  
ALARM  
L4-4 LCL  
ALARM  
L5-1 LCL  
ALARM  
17  
25  
33  
41  
49  
57  
L5-2 LCL  
ALARM  
L5-3 LCL  
ALARM  
L5-4 LCL  
ALARM  
L6-1 LCL  
ALARM  
L6-2 LCL  
ALARM  
L6-3 LCL  
ALARM  
L6-4 LCL  
ALARM  
L6-1 LCL  
ALARM  
L7-2 LCL  
ALARM  
L7-3 LCL  
ALARM  
L7-4 LCL  
ALARM  
L1-1 RMT  
ALARM  
L1-2 RMT  
ALARM  
L1-3 RMT  
ALARM  
L1-4 RMT  
ALARM  
L2-1 RMT  
ALARM  
L2-2 RMT  
ALARM  
L2-3 RMT  
ALARM  
L2-4 RMT  
ALARM  
L3-1 RMT  
ALARM  
L3-2 RMT  
ALARM  
L3-3 RMT  
ALARM  
L3-4 RMT  
ALARM  
L4-1 RMT  
ALARM  
L4-2 RMT  
ALARM  
L4-3 RMT  
ALARM  
L4-4 RMT  
ALARM  
L5-1 RMT  
ALARM  
L5-2 RMT  
ALARM  
L5-3 RMT  
ALARM  
L5-4 RMT  
ALARM  
L6-1 RMT  
ALARM  
L6-2 RMT  
ALARM  
L6-3 RMT  
ALARM  
L6-4 RMT  
ALARM  
L7-1 RMT  
ALARM  
L7-2 RMT  
ALARM  
L7-3 RMT  
ALARM  
L7-4 RMT  
ALARM  
ATT  
RESERVED  
64  
Figure 104-6. Compressed Scan Display 2  
2-276  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-105  
Page 1 of 8  
TRANSACTION LANGUAGE 1 (TL1) INTERFACE DESCRIPTION  
Summary: This TAD describes the commands used to operate the Soneplex Loop Extender  
through a terminal using Transaction Language 1 (TL1). All operations are performed at a local  
and/or remote terminal using an EIA-232 interface. For additional information on TL1 commands,  
refer to the Soneplex TL1 Interface Specification Manual, listed under Related Publications at the  
beginning of this manual, for more information.  
Note: The TL1 interface is case-insensitive. All input commands are mapped to  
uppercase except for TID and CTAG. Size of input commands is limited to 512 bytes.  
The following notational conventions are used throughout this TAD:  
cr — Carriage return  
lf — Line feed  
^ — Blank space  
YY-MM-DD —  
HH:MM:SS —  
Year-Month-Day  
Hour:Minute:Second  
... — Indicates zero or more repetitions of expression contained in brackets  
[ ] — One or more parameters contained in brackets are optional  
{ x }— Selection of one and only one of the listed parameters is allowed  
< > — Indicate names of parameters that will be replaced by parameter  
values in actual TL1 transactions  
TL1 Command Syntax  
Any user request is considered a command. Commands generally consist of five blocks:  
<command block>:<routing block>:<access block>:<correlation block>:<data block(s)>;  
The command block consists of commands, verbs, and modifiers separated by hyphens.  
<command verb> - <modifier>[-<modifier>]  
For example: The command block OPR-LPBK contains the command verb OPR (OPeRate) and  
the modifier LPBK (LooPBacK) to provide for the loopback function. The command block SET-  
ATTR-T1 contains the command verb SET, the modifier ATTR (ATTRibute), and the modifier  
T1 to provide the mechanism for setting attributes of a T1 circuit.  
2-277  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-105  
Page 2 of 8  
The routing block contains a target identifier parameter with parameter name Target  
Identification (TID). The TID may be any valid simple or compound TL1 identifier or text  
string, and is limited to 20 ASCII characters. A valid text string or the TID is defined as letters,  
numbers, and hyphens within double quotes. TIDs are configurable items that can be defined  
using TL1 provisioning driven messages. The TID is the destination code for the command. For  
a Network Element (NE) to accept the command the TID must be the same as the NE’s system  
identification, which the user sets through the SET-SID command. A null TID entry for any TL1  
command defaults to the system identification.  
The access block identifies the circuit (T1, T2, T3, or HDSL) or equipment related to the  
command function. For commands that relate to the system itself rather than a specific circuit or  
equipment, no access block entry is required or permitted. When using the command modifier  
ALL, the access block must be null.  
For commands that relate to a specific circuit access point, an access identification (AID) is  
required.  
Reference: TAD-106 Access Identifier  
The fourth required block is called the message correlation block and contains one parameter to  
serve as a Correlation Tag (CTAG). The CTAG parameter correlates an input command with its  
associated output response(s). The user assigns a CTAG value and it is the responsibility of the  
NE to copy this value into the appropriate field of the output response(s) associated with that  
input command. The value of a CTAG must either be a TL1 identifier or decimal numeral,  
consisting of no more than six characters. An example of a valid CTAG is 123 in the following  
command:  
REPT-STAT ::: 123;  
The data block contains all parameters that are required by the NE to complete the command.  
The data block is command specific and is described in each specific command and response.  
Parameters are separated by commas. Parameter grouping is allowed for some parameters to  
provide a nonsequential series of singly defined data items. An ampersand (&) is used to  
separate each item. An example of parameter grouping is shown in the following command:  
RTRV-ATTR-T1 : SONEPLEX : 1-2-3-1:123: : ,LOS & LOF;  
All parameters are either position- or keyword-defined. Position-defined parameters are defined  
by the location or order that they are entered. White space or nothing between two commas  
indicates a null value selection for the parameter defined in that position. Keyword-defined  
parameters may be entered in any position in the block by entering the keyword and an equal  
sign followed by the value being selected. A missing keyword implies selection of a null value  
for that parameter (usually the default value). No extra commas may be entered to imply a null  
default selection and no keyword may be entered without a value being entered. All parameters  
are position-defined unless keyword-defined is specified in the command syntax description.  
2-278  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-105  
Page 3 of 8  
It should be noted that if no data block parameters are required for a command, the colon  
separating the correlation block from the data block may be omitted. Trailing commas in the data  
block (that is, commas used as position place holders that have no parameter values following  
them) may also be omitted. This action selects default values and can only be used after the last  
required parameter. For example:  
RTRV-ATTR-Tl : SONEPLEX : 1-2-3-1:123::, , , , ;  
RTRV-ATTR-T1 : SONEPLEX : 1-2-3-1:123;  
Because of the trailing commas rule, the expression : [a] , [b] , [c] , [d] ; implies [ : [[a] [ , [b] [ ,  
[c] [ , [d] ] ] ] ] ] ;.  
TL1 Response Syntax  
TL1 output has three distinct types of messages:  
1. Full response messages sent to indicate completion or denial of a request.  
2. Acknowledgment output sent when a full response may not be sent within 2 seconds.  
3. Autonomous messages that are sent without an associated command request.  
Full Response Syntax  
TL1 responses consist of four components:  
<header> <identification of output> <text block> <end of output>  
A header consists of the following format:  
cr lf If  
^^^<SID>^YY-MM-DD^HH:MM:SS cr lf  
1. SID — Source identification of the Network Element.  
2. YY-MM-DD — Year - Month - Day.  
3. HH:MM:SS — Hour : Minute : Second.  
The identification of output consists of the following format:  
M^^<CTAG>^<completion code> cr lf  
1. M — Priority to indicate that the output is a response to an input message.  
2. CTAG — Correlation code.  
3. Completion code — Will contain COMPLD to acknowledge the completion of the input  
command or DENY to indicate that the input command was not executed. A Deny  
response will always include information such as an error code and comments to indicate  
why the command was not executed.  
2-279  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-105  
Page 4 of 8  
The text block contains additional information that is specific to the input command. No  
parameter grouping is allowed in output. No null defaults unless specified in response syntax  
description.  
The end of output is a single character. A semicolon (;) is used for normal end of output. The  
continuation symbol, a “greater-than” sign (>), is used on a message to indicate that another  
associated output message follows. When the continuation symbol is used, the associated output  
messages must have the same CTAG and the last associated message must have a semicolon.  
Example: Standard Error Response Format  
The following error message format will be used whenever the NE is unable to execute a TL1  
command.  
cr lf lf  
^^^<SID>^YY-MM-DD^HH:MM:SS cr lf  
M^^<CTAG>^DENY cr lf  
^^^<ERRCDE> cr lf  
*
[^^^/* <comment> /cr lf]•••  
;
1. ERRCDE — Error code.  
2. Comment — Optional free form text that provides more information about the error.  
Acknowledgment Output Syntax  
When there is a delay of more than two seconds before a response can be sent, a brief output  
message is sent to acknowledge the receipt of the command. This response has three  
components:  
<acknowledgment code>^[<CTAG>]cr lf  
<
1. Acknowledgment code values:  
IP — In progress  
PF — Printout follows  
OK — Okay  
RL — Repeat later  
2. CTAG — Correlation code.  
3. < — Indicates end of acknowledgment output.  
2-280  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-105  
Page 5 of 8  
Autonomous Message Syntax  
Autonomous messages are used to report alarms, events, and reports. The format is the same as  
the full response except the identification of output is replaced by:  
<ALMCDE>^<ATAG>^<output code> cr lf  
1. Alarm Codes (ALMCDE):  
*C — Critical alarm  
** — Major alarm  
*^ — Minor alarm  
AA — Automatic message  
2. ATAG is the autonomously generated correlation tag that the user can use to see if any  
spontaneous outputs have been missed by checking for omissions in the sequence of  
messages received. It starts with a value of one (l) and increments until the system is  
initialized again. Range is from 1 to 65535. When 65535 is reached, the value returns to l.  
3. The output code identifies the nature of the output message. Values for the output code  
are: {REPT ALM | REPT EVT | REPT INITZN | REPT STAT }. The output code  
may have a modifier [ { T1 | EQPT } ]. Refer to individual message syntax descriptions.  
REPT ALM — Report alarm  
REPT EVT — Report event  
REPT INITZN — Report initialization of NE  
REPT STAT — Report status  
Autonomous Messages  
Autonomous messages are used to report information that is not a direct response to a specific  
command. Autonomous messages are:  
REPT ALM — Report alarm  
REPT EVT — Report event  
REPT INITZN — Report initialization  
REPT STAT — Report status  
TL1 Commands  
The TL1 commands supported by Version 5 MPU software are listed in Table 105-1.  
2-281  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-105  
Page 6 of 8  
Table 105-1. TL1 Commands  
COMMAND  
DESCRIPTION  
General System Commands  
Report Initialization  
REPT-INITZN  
REPT-STAT  
RTRV-HDR  
SET-DAT  
Report Status  
Retrieve header  
Set system time and date  
Set system ID  
SET-SID  
DS1 Loopback Commands and Responses  
Operate loopback  
OPR-LPBK  
RLS-LPBK  
Release loopback  
RTRV-LPBK-T1  
SET-LPBK-T1  
Retrieve loopback  
Set T1 loopback codes  
Performance Monitoring Commands and Responses  
Allow automatic messages  
Allow PM reporting on line(s) that have been inhibited  
Inhibit automatic messages  
Inhibit PM reporting  
ALW-MSG  
ALW-PMREPT  
INH-MSG  
INH-PMREPT  
INIT-REG  
Initialize register  
OPR-ACO  
Operate alarm cutoff  
RTRV-ALM  
RTRV-ATTR  
RTRV-COND  
RTRV-ITH  
Retrieve active alarms  
Retrieve alarm attributes  
Report conditions (events, etc.)  
Report internal threshold  
Retrieve PM history on a line or lines  
Retrieve PM schedule  
RTRV-PM  
RTRV-PMSCHED  
RTRV-TH  
Retrieve threshold  
SCHED-PMREPT  
SET-ATTR  
Schedule PM, select parameters to measure  
Set severity and activation of alarm and event reporting  
Set internal threshold  
SET-ITH  
SET-TH  
Set threshold for reporting events  
Switch to protection  
SW-TOPROTN  
SW-TOWKG  
Switch to working  
(continued)  
2-282  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-105  
Page 7 of 8  
Table 105-1. TL1 Commands, continued  
COMMAND  
DESCRIPTION  
TL1 Security Commands  
ACT-USER  
Logon a user to port  
CANC-USER  
Logoff a user from port  
DLT-SECU-USER  
ED-SECU-CMD  
ED-SECU-PID  
Remove user ID from system  
Change the security level required to execute command  
Changes the PID of the current user  
Changes the security level or password of a user  
Change the security level required to execute a TL1 command  
Add a user to database  
ED-SECU-USER  
ENT-SECU-CMD  
ENT-SECU-USER  
RTRV-SECU-CMD  
RTRV-SECU-USER  
Retrieves the security level required by a user  
Retrieves the security level or password of a user  
Administration Commands  
DLT-EQPT  
DLT-T1  
Delete equipment  
Delete T1 configuration  
ED-HDSL  
ED-SER  
Change configuration HDSL  
Change the configuration of a serial port  
Change configuration T1  
ED-T1  
ED-T2  
Change configuration T2  
ED-T3  
Change configuration T3  
ED-EQPT  
ENT-EQPT  
ENT-T1  
Change equipment  
Provision equipment  
Provision T1  
RTRV-EQPT  
RTRV-HDSL  
RTRV-SER  
RTRV-T1  
RTRV-T2  
RTRV-T3  
Retrieve equipment configuration data  
Retrieve HDSL configuration data  
Retrieve the configuration of a serial port  
Retrieve T1 configuration data  
Retrieve ODS2/QFLC configuration data  
Retrieve T3 configuration data  
(continued)  
2-283  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-105  
Page 8 of 8  
Table 105-1. TL1 Commands, continued  
COMMAND  
DESCRIPTION  
TEST ACCESS COMMANDS  
Connect Test Access T1  
CONN-TACC-T1  
DISC-TACC  
Disconnect Test Access  
CHG-ACCMD-T1  
CHG-TSTSIG-T1  
DISC-TSTSIG  
CHG-LPBK-T1  
MEAS-SIG-T1  
DISC-MEAS  
Change Access Mode T1  
Change Test Signal  
Disconnect Test Signal  
Change Loopback Signal  
Measure Incoming DS1 Signal  
Terminate a Measurement  
REPT-RSLT  
Report Intermediate Measurement Results  
Insert Data or Frame Bit Errors in Test Signal  
TST-INSERRBITS  
2-284  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-106  
Page 1 of 2  
ACCESS IDENTIFIER  
Summary: Circuits displayed in the Craft Interface are identified by the Access Identifier (AID).  
Figure 106-1 shows an example of a circuit with descriptions of each part of the AID. The DS3  
signal is demultiplexed by the DS3 MUX into 28 DS1 signals and seven DS2 signals. See Table  
106-1 for DS1 signal routing details. See Table 106-2 for DS2 signal routing details. See Figure  
106-2 for chassis slot numbering.  
CIRCUIT AID  
Shelf Number Group Number: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7  
Site or Loop Number: 1 (Local or HDSL  
Loop 1) or 2 (Remote or HDSL Loop 2)  
T1-1-7-2-1  
Circuit Identifier:  
(T1, T2, T3 or HDSL)  
Slot Number: 1, 2, 3, or 4  
EQUIPMENT AID  
Equipment Type (LIU, MPU, MXP, MXW, TAU or EXT) and Shelf Number  
Group Number: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7  
Site or Loop Number: 1 (Local or HDSL  
Loop 1) or 2 (Remote or HDSL Loop 2)  
EQPT-LIU1-7-2-1  
Identifier for Equipment AID  
Slot Number: 1, 2, 3, or 4  
LIU = Line Interface Unit  
MPU = Main Processor Unit  
MXP = DS3 MUX (Protect)  
MXW = DS# MUX (Working)  
TAU = Remote Test Access Unit (RTAU)  
EXT = External  
14852-A  
Figure 106-1. Access Identifier Display  
2-285  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAD-106  
Page 2 of 2  
Table 106-1. DS1 Signal Routing  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
GROUP-  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
GROUP-  
SLOT  
NUMBER  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
SLOT  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
DS1  
SIGNAL  
NUMBER  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1-1  
1-2  
1-3  
1-4  
2-1  
2-2  
2-3  
8
2-4  
3-1  
3-2  
3-3  
3-4  
4-1  
4-2  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
4-3  
4-4  
5-1  
5-2  
5-3  
5-4  
6-1  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
6-2  
6-3  
6-4  
7-1  
7-2  
7-3  
7-4  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
Table 106-2. DS2 Signal Routing  
GROUP-SLOT  
NUMBER  
(WORKING)  
GROUP-SLOT  
NUMBER  
DS2 SIGNAL  
(PROTECT)  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1-1  
2-1  
3-1  
4-1  
5-1  
6-1  
7-1  
1-3  
2-3  
3-3  
4-3  
5-3  
6-3  
7-3  
HIGH SPEED UNITS  
LOW SPEED UNITS  
HSW HSP MXW MXP TAU  
APU  
1-1 1-3 2-1 2-3 3-1 3-3 4-1 4-3 5-1 5-3 6-1 6-3 7-1 7-3  
1-2 1-4 2-2 2-4 3-2 3-4 4-2 4-4 5-2 5-4 6-2 6-4 7-2 7-4  
MPU  
GROUP- NUMBERS  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1982-A  
Figure 106-2. Slot Locations  
2-286  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-101  
Page 1 of 13  
ALARM TROUBLESHOOTING  
Summary: This TAP describes the various alarm screens in the Craft Interface. An accurate  
diagnosis of the Active Alarms or Alarm History screens allows you to determine where the  
trouble is and dispatch the appropriate technician to isolate and repair the problem.  
1. Log on to the Craft Interface. The Main Menu will then be displayed on your screen.  
Reference: DLP-526 Craft Interface System Logon  
2. To silence any audible alarms, use the arrow or number keys to select System Maintenance  
from the Main Menu and execute an Alarm Cut-Off (ACO).  
Reference: DLP-539 ACO (Alarm Cut-Off) Command  
3. Use the arrow or number keys to select Alarms from the Main Menu. Press Enter or Return.  
The Alarms menu will be displayed on your screen.  
4. Use the arrow or number keys to select Display Active Alarms or Display Alarm History  
from the Alarms menu. Press Enter or Return. The screen you selected will appear. Active  
Alarms screens are shown in Figure 101-1 (MPU Software Version 5.1), and Figure 101-2  
(V5.2). Alarm History screens are shown in Figure 101-3 (V5.1), and Figure 101-4 (V5.2).  
Note: If the date and time of the alarm are important to your diagnosis, select the Alarm  
History screen. The Alarm History screen displays the date and time of the alarms stored  
in the history file.  
5. Screen Navigation: A maximum of 112 entries is displayed on the screen. Use the  
following for description of keys that can be used to navigate the screen:  
KEY  
ACTION  
Up Arrow  
Down Arrow  
Left Arrow  
Right Arrow  
Control-R  
Scrolls display up 1 line  
Scrolls display down one line  
Scrolls display up 1 page  
Scrolls display down one page  
Queries the database and refreshes the screen  
6. Column Descriptions: There are six columns that appear on the Active Alarms screen:  
Access Identifier, Locn (Location), Circuit Identifier, Condition, St (Status), and ACO.  
There are seven columns that appear on the Alarm History screen: Date, Time, Access  
Identifier, Locn (Location), Circuit Identifier, Condition, and St (Status).  
The Access ID (AID) column identifies an entity in the chassis to which the alarm  
condition pertains. Different alarm conditions result in different types of AIDs. The AID  
consists of several parts: the Identifier, the Shelf, the Group, the Slot, and the Site or Loop  
Number, as described below. See Figure 101-5 for a complete definition of the Access  
Identifier.  
2-287  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-101  
Page 2 of 13  
Identifier  
“EQPT-XXXY” identifies modules within the chassis where XXX represents the type of  
module (MPU, LIU, MXW, MXP, or EXT), and “#” represents the number of the  
Soneplex chassis in the system (always “1”).  
“HDSL” identifies trouble on the HDSL loop. A “1” in the last column of the AID  
indicates trouble on HDSL Loop 1. A “2” in the last column of the AID indicates  
trouble on HDSL Loop 2.  
“T1” identifies trouble on the DS1 either at the local or remote site.  
“T2” identifies trouble on the DS2 either at the local or remote site.  
“T3” identifies trouble on the DS3.  
Shelf Number  
This is the number of the Soneplex chassis in the system.  
Group Number  
This is the number of the group in the chassis where the module is located (1, 2, 3, 4, 5,  
6, or 7). The Group number does not apply when the identifier is T3.  
Slot Number  
This is the number of the slot within the group where the module is located (1, 2, 3,  
or 4). The Slot number does not apply when the identifier is T3.  
Site or Loop Number  
If HDSL appears in the first column of the access identifier and a “1” appears in this  
location, there is a problem on HDSL Loop 1. If HDSL appears in the first column of the  
circuit and a “2” appears in this location, there is a problem on HDSL Loop 2.  
If “T1”, “T2”, “T3”, or “EQPT” appears in the first column of the circuit and a “1”  
appears in this location, there is a problem at the local site. If “T1”, “T2”, “T3”, or  
“EQPT” appears in the first column of the circuit and a “2” appears in this location, there  
is a problem at the remote site.  
The Locn (Location) column displays FEND, NEND, REPR, REPC, CRP, and RRP  
indicating the location of the alarm. Figure 101-6 (T1 system), Figure 101-7 (HDSL  
system with one HRX), Figure 101-8 (HDSL system with two HRXs), and Figure 101-9  
(DLX), Figure 101-10 (ODS2 system), and Figure 101-11 (RLX system) show locations  
and descriptions of FEND, NEND, REPR, REPC, CRP, and RRP.  
2-288  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-101  
Page 3 of 13  
The Circuit ID column displays the circuit identifier or facility name of the circuit in  
trouble.  
Reference: DLP-532 DLX Configuration  
Reference: DLP-531 HLX Configuration  
Reference: DLP-530 ODS2 Module Configuration  
Reference: DLP-533 RLXIOR Configuration  
Reference: DLP-534 RLX Configuration  
The Condition column displays the alarm condition present on the circuit. See  
Table 101-1 for a listing of the possible alarm conditions.  
The St (Status) column displays Critical (CR), Major (MJ), Minor (MN), or Event (EV),  
indicating the degree of the alarm. When an alarm clears, it is indicated on the Alarm  
History screen by the letters CL. Events are reported as they occur, but are not reported as  
cleared when they clear. Conditions configured as Not Reported are never reported at all.  
The ACO column indicates whether the ACO is active (YES or NO) for the particular  
alarm. This column is found only on the Active Alarms screen.  
7. Troubleshoot the problem, following local practices. Once the problem is located and  
corrected, the alarm is cleared and the LEDs return to their normal state.  
Stop! You have completed this procedure.  
2-289  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-101  
Page 4 of 13  
ACTIVE ALARMS  
Legend:  
Access ID=Identifier[-]Shelf-Grp-Slot[-Site(1=Lcl,2=Rmt) | -Loop(1=Lp 1,2=Lp 2)]  
Access ID  
Locn Circuit ID  
Condition  
Status ACO  
---------------- ---- -------------------- ---------------- ------ ---  
T2-1-3-1  
T2-1-3-1  
T1-7-1-1  
T1-7-1-2  
NEND  
NEND  
FEND  
FEND  
NEND  
NEND  
FEND  
FEND  
FEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
FEND  
FEND  
FEND  
OPTICAL LOS  
OPTICAL LOF  
AIS  
LOF  
T-BERP  
T-SNR  
LOF  
T-BERP  
T-SNR  
RECOVERY  
LOF  
T-BERP  
T-SNR  
MJ  
MJ  
MN  
MJ  
MN  
EV  
MJ  
MN  
EV  
MN  
MJ  
MN  
EV  
MJ  
MN  
EV  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
HDSL-1-7-1-1  
HDSL-1-7-1-1  
HDSL-1-7-1-1  
HDSL-1-7-1-1  
HDSL-1-7-1-1  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
LOF  
T-BERP  
T-SNR  
Page 1 of 1  
Press CONTROL-A for assistance  
6675-B  
Figure 101-1. Active Alarms Screen (MPU V5.1) (Sample)  
ACTIVE ALARMS  
Legend:  
Access ID=Identifier[-]Shelf-Grp-Slot[-Site(1=Lcl,2=Rmt) | -Loop(1=Lp 1,2=Lp 2)]  
Access ID  
---------------- ----  
EQPT-1-3-1  
T2-1-3-1  
T1-1-1-4-1  
Locn  
Circuit ID  
-------------------- ----------------  
Condition  
Status ACO  
------ ---  
GRP 2 MISMATCH  
OPTICAL LOF  
AIS  
MN  
MJ  
EV  
MJ  
EV  
MN  
EV  
MJ  
MN  
EV  
MN  
MJ  
MN  
EV  
MJ  
MN  
EV  
NO  
NO  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
CRP1  
HLXR  
NEND  
FEND  
FEND  
FEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
FEND  
FEND  
FEND  
T1-1-1-4-2  
T1-1-7-1-2  
LOS  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NO  
NET LOOPED BACK  
INCOMPATIBLE  
T-SNR  
LOF  
T-BERP  
T-SNR  
RECOVERY  
LOF  
T-BERP  
T-SNR  
EQPT-LIU1-2-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-1  
HDSL-1-7-1-1  
HDSL-1-7-1-1  
HDSL-1-7-1-1  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
HDSL-1-7-1-2  
LOF  
T-BERP  
T-SNR  
Page 1 of 1  
Press CONTROL-A for assistance  
11376-A  
Figure 101-2. Active Alarms Screen (MPU V5.2) (Sample)  
2-290  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-101  
Page 5 of 13  
ALARM HISTORY  
Legend:  
Access ID=Identifier[-]Shelf-Grp-Slot[-Site(1=Lcl,2=Rmt) | -Loop(1=Lp 1,2=Lp 2)]  
Date  
Time  
Access ID  
Locn Circuit ID  
Condition  
St  
-------- -------- ---------------- ---- -------------------- ---------------- --  
01/03/95 22:37:00 T1-6-1-2  
01/03/95 22:37:00 T1-6-1-1  
FEND  
FEND  
NEND  
NEND  
FEND  
FEND  
FEND  
NEND  
FEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
NEND  
LOF  
LOF  
LOF  
LOF  
LOF  
LOF  
LOF  
RECOVERY  
LOF  
RECOVERY  
RECOVERY  
RECOVERY  
RECOVERY  
RECOVERY  
DC CONTINUITY  
RECOVERY  
RECOVERY  
CL  
CL  
CL  
CL  
MJ  
MJ  
CL  
CL  
CL  
CL  
MN  
MN  
CL  
CL  
CL  
MN  
MN  
01/03/95 22:36:57 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/95 22:36:57 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/95 22:36:52 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/95 22:36:52 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/95 22:36:48 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/95 22:36:48 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/95 22:36:48 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/95 22:36:48 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/95 22:36:36 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/95 22:36:36 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/95 22:36:34 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/95 22:36:34 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/95 22:36:32 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/95 22:36:25 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/95 22:36:25 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
Page 1 of 2  
Press CONTROL-A for assistance  
6677-B  
Figure 101-3. Alarm History Screen (MPU V5.1) (Sample)  
ALARM HISTORY  
Legend:  
Access ID=Identifier[-]Shelf-Grp-Slot[-Site(1=Lcl,2=Rmt) | -Loop(1=Lp 1,2=Lp 2)]  
Date  
Time  
Access ID  
Locn Circuit ID  
Condition  
St  
--  
-------- -------- --------------- ---- ------------------- ---------------  
01/03/98 22:38:57 EQPT-LIU1-1-1-2  
01/03/98 22:38:54 EQPT-LIU1-1-1-2  
01/03/98 22:37:00 T1-6-1-2  
HLXR INCOMPATIBLE CL  
HLXR INCOMPATIBLE MN  
LOF  
LOF  
LOF  
LOF  
LOF  
LOF  
LOF  
RECOVERY  
LOF  
RECOVERY  
RECOVERY  
RECOVERY  
RECOVERY  
RECOVERY  
DC CONTINUITY  
FEND  
FEND  
RRP1  
RRP1  
CRP1  
CRP1  
CRP1  
RRP1  
CRP1  
RRP1  
RRP1  
RRP1  
RRP1  
RRP1  
RRP1  
CL  
CL  
CL  
CL  
MJ  
MJ  
CL  
CL  
CL  
CL  
MN  
MN  
CL  
CL  
CL  
01/03/98 22:37:00 T1-6-1-1  
01/03/98 22:36:57 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/98 22:36:57 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/98 22:36:52 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/98 22:36:52 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/98 22:36:48 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/98 22:36:48 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/98 22:36:48 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/98 22:36:48 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/98 22:36:36 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/98 22:36:36 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/98 22:36:34 HDSL-1-6-1-2  
01/03/98 22:36:34 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
01/03/98 22:36:32 HDSL-1-6-1-1  
Page 1 of 2  
Press CONTROL-A for assistance  
11378-A  
Figure 101-4. Alarm History Screen (MPU V5.2) (Sample)  
2-291  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-101  
Page 6 of 13  
CIRCUIT AID  
Shelf Number Group Number: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7  
Site or Loop Number: 1 (Local or HDSL  
Loop 1) or 2 (Remote or HDSL Loop 2)  
T1-1-7-2-1  
Circuit Identifier:  
(T1, T2, T3 or HDSL)  
Slot Number: 1, 2, 3, or 4  
EQUIPMENT AID  
Equipment Type (LIU, MPU, MXP, MXW, TAU or EXT) and Shelf Number  
Group Number: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or 7  
Site or Loop Number: 1 (Local or HDSL  
Loop 1) or 2 (Remote or HDSL Loop 2)  
EQPT-LIU1-7-2-1  
Identifier for Equipment AID  
Slot Number: 1, 2, 3, or 4  
LIU = Line Interface Unit  
MPU = Main Processor Unit  
MXP = DS3 MUX (Protect)  
MXW = DS# MUX (Working)  
TAU = Remote Test Access Unit (RTAU)  
EXT = External  
14852-A  
Figure 101-5. Access Identifier  
2-292  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-101  
Page 7 of 13  
Table 101-1. Alarm Descriptions/Conditions  
MPU ALARMS, AID = EQPT-MPU#  
DESCRIPTION  
CONDITION  
GRP 1 MISMATCH  
GRP 2 MISMATCH  
GRP 3 MISMATCH  
GRP 4 MISMATCH  
GRP 5 MISMATCH  
GRP 6 MISMATCH  
GRP 7 MISMATCH  
POWER  
Invalid card type combination in group 1  
Invalid card type combination in group 2  
Invalid card type combination in group 3  
Invalid card type combination in group 4  
Invalid card type combination in group 5  
Invalid card type combination in group 6  
Invalid card type combination in group 7  
Chassis power input (A or B) not connected  
Carrier Group Alarm: 6 or more DS1’s in MAJOR alarm  
EXTERNAL ALARMS, AID = EQPT-EXT#  
CGA  
CONDITION  
HSKP1*  
HSKP2*  
HSKP3*  
HSKP4*  
HSKP5*  
HSKP6*  
HSKP7*  
HSKP8*  
DESCRIPTION  
Contact closure detected at HSKP IN, pair 1 on backplane  
Contact closure detected at HSKP IN, pair 2 on backplane  
Contact closure detected at HSKP IN, pair 3 on backplane  
Contact closure detected at HSKP IN, pair 4 on backplane  
Contact closure detected at HSKP IN, pair 5 on backplane  
Contact closure detected at HSKP IN, pair 6 on backplane  
Contact closure detected at HSKP IN, pair 7 on backplane  
Contact closure detected at HSKP IN, pair 8 on backplane  
DS3 MUX ALARMS, AID = T3  
CONDITION  
AIS  
DESCRIPTION  
AIS (Alarm Indication Signal) detected  
APS limit of 3 switches in 24 hours has been reached, APS disabled  
Working module forced online, APS disabled  
Protect module forced online, APS disabled  
Idle code detected  
APS LIMIT  
FORCE TO WORK  
FORCE TO PROT  
IDLE  
LOF  
Loss of Frame  
LOOPED BACK  
LOS  
Signal looped back toward network  
Loss of Signal  
YELLOW  
Yellow alarm detected  
* HSKP alarm names can be configured in the Shelf Housekeeping Labels screen, described in DLP-550.  
(continued)  
2-293  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-101  
Page 8 of 13  
Table 101-1. Alarm Descriptions/Conditions, continued  
DS3 MUX ALARMS, AID = EQPT-MXW#, EQPT-MXP#  
DESCRIPTION  
CONDITION  
BOARD FAIL  
Fatal hardware or software error  
COMM FAIL  
MPU unable to communicate with DS3 MUX  
Configuration mismatch with mate module  
Unable to communicate with mate module (Working-Protect)  
ODS2 ALARMS, AID = EQPT-LIU#  
CONFIG MISMATCH  
PROTECT COMM FAIL  
CONDITION  
DESCRIPTION  
BOARD FAIL  
COMM FAIL  
Fatal hardware or software error  
MPU unable to communicate with ODS2  
Configuration mismatch with mate module or remote module  
Housekeeping alarm detected at remote end (QFLC or QLX)  
CONFIG MISMATCH  
RMT-HSKP1 or RMT-  
HSKP2  
PROTECT COMM FAIL  
OPTICAL COMM FAIL  
VERSION MISMATCH  
Unable to communicate with mate module (Working-Protect)  
Unable to communicate with remote module  
Incompatible software versions with mate module or remote module  
ODS2 ALARMS, AID = T1  
CONDITION  
DESCRIPTION  
LOOPED BACK  
RECEIVE LOS  
TRANSMIT LOS  
Signal looped back at either ODS2 or remote  
Loss Of Signal detected at remote end (QFLC or QLX)  
Transmit Loss of Signal detected at remote end (QFLC or QLX),  
hardware failure  
ODS2 ALARMS, AID = T2  
CONDITION  
DESCRIPTION  
APS LIMIT REACHED  
FORCE TO WORK  
FORCE TO PROT  
LASER DEGRADE  
OPTICAL LOF  
OPTICAL LOS  
T-BER  
APS limit of 3 switches in 24 hours has been reached, APS disabled  
Working module forced online, APS disabled  
Protect module forced online, APS disabled  
Laser driver degradation, hardware failure  
Optical Loss of Frame  
Optical Loss Of Signal  
Bit Error Rate exceeds user-defined threshold  
(continued)  
2-294  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-101  
Page 9 of 13  
Table 101-1. Alarm Descriptions/Conditions, continued  
HLXC ALARMS, AID = EQPT-LIU#  
DESCRIPTION  
CONDITION  
BOARD FAIL  
Fatal hardware or software error  
COMM FAIL  
MPU unable to communicate with HLXC  
Incompatible software versions with remote module  
Incompatible software versions with HRX  
Pairs crossed at HLXR  
HLXR INCOMPATIBLE  
HRX INCOMPATIBLE  
LOOP REVERSAL  
TP/RNG REVERSAL  
PRIMARY POWER  
SECONDARY POWER  
Tip and Ring reversed (either loop)  
Local power fail indication (1) detected at HLXR  
Local power fail indication (2) detected at HLXR  
HLXC ALARMS, AID = T1  
CONDITION  
AIS  
DESCRIPTION  
AIS detected  
LOOPBACK  
LOF  
Signal looped back toward network  
DS1 Loss of Frame  
LOS  
DS1 Loss of Signal  
T-BERL  
YEL  
DS1 BER threshold crossed (based on BPVs)  
Yellow alarm (DS1) detected  
HLXC ALARMS, AID = HDSL  
CONDITION  
DC CONTINUITY  
LOF  
DESCRIPTION  
Loss of loop power DC continuity detected  
Loss of Frame (a.k.a. HDSL Loss of Sync Word (LOSW) Failure)  
HDSL loop is performing start-up process  
HDSL loop BER threshold crossed (based on HDSL CRC)  
HDSL Pulse Attenuation threshold crossed.  
HDSL loop SNR threshold crossed  
HLXC ALARMS, AID = EQPT-EXT#  
RECOVERY  
T-BERP  
T-PA  
T-SNR  
CONDITION  
DESCRIPTION  
RMT-HSKP1  
RMT-HSKP2  
Housekeeping contact closure (1) detected at HLXR  
Housekeeping contact closure (2) detected at HLXR  
(continued)  
2-295  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-101  
Page 10 of 13  
Table 101-1. Alarm Descriptions/Conditions, continued  
DLX ALARMS, AID = EQPT-LIU#  
DESCRIPTION  
CONDITION  
COMM FAIL  
MPU unable to communicate with DLX  
DLX ALARMS, AID = T1  
CONDITION  
LOOPED BACK  
LOS  
DESCRIPTION  
Signal looped back toward network  
DS1 Loss of Signal  
T-BERL  
DS1 BER threshold crossed (based on BPVs)  
LOCAL  
REMOTE  
(SITE = -1)  
(SITE = -2)  
DS1  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 2  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 2  
DS1  
DS1  
A
FEND  
NEND  
NEND  
FEND  
2
HLXC  
HRX  
HLXR  
DS1  
TO NETWORK  
KEY  
TO CUSTOMER  
NEND means "PM information collected directly from incoming T1 signals, both at local and remote sites."  
FEND means "ESF PRM information collected at the opposite ends of spans from the affected circuit and  
returned to the system via the ESF Datalink, both at local and remote sites". The framing format must be  
ESF in order for FEND information to be displayed.  
Note: For Site 1, FEND information is at A; for Site 2, FEND information is at 2.  
11377-A  
Figure 101-6. T1 HLXC/HRX/HLXR NEND and FEND Locations  
2-296  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-101  
Page 11 of 13  
REPR  
XCVR  
REPC  
NEND  
LOOP 1  
FEND  
LOOP 1  
XCVR  
HLXC  
HRX  
HLXR  
LOOP 2  
FEND  
LOOP 2  
NEND  
XCVR  
REPR  
XCVR  
REPC  
TO NETWORK  
TO CUSTOMER  
KEY  
NEND means "at the HLXC, looking toward the customer (HLXR)."  
FEND means "at the HLXR, looking toward the network (HLXC)."  
REPC means "at the HRX, looking toward the customer (HLXR)."  
REPR means "at the HRX, looking toward the network (HLXC). "  
REPR (PM Reports) = C-SIDE (Display Status) = LINE 1 (TL1)  
REPC (PM Reports) = R-SIDE (Display Status) = LINE 2 (TL1)  
9450-B  
Figure 101-7. HDSL HLXC/HRX/HLXR NEND and FEND Locations (MPU V5.1)  
CRP1  
XCVR  
RRP1  
XCVR  
CRP2  
XCVR  
RRP2  
XCVR  
NEND  
FEND  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 2  
LOOP 1  
HLXC  
HRX1  
HRX2  
HLXR  
LOOP 2  
LOOP 2  
XCVR  
CRP1  
XCVR  
RRP1  
XCVR  
CRP2  
XCVR  
RRP2  
NEND  
TO NETWORK  
FEND  
TO CUSTOMER  
KEY  
NEND means "at the HLXC, looking toward the customer (HLXR)."  
FEND means "at the HLXR, looking toward the network (HLXC)."  
CRP1 means "at the central office side of the HRX1, looking toward the network (HRX2/HLXR)."  
RRP1 means "at the remote (CPE) side of the HRX1, looking toward the customer (HLXC)."  
CRP2 means "at the central office side of the HRX2, looking toward the network (HLXR)."  
RRP2 means "at the remote (CPE) side of the HRX2, looking toward the customer (HRX1/HLXC)."  
CRP1 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 1 (TL1)  
RRP1 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 2 (TL1)  
CRP2 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 3 (TL1)  
RRP2 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 4 (TL1)  
NOTE: CRP2 and RRP2 are not present when there is no HRX2.  
11375-A  
Figure 101-8. HDSL HLXC/HRX/HLXR NEND and FEND Locations (MPU V5.2)  
2-297  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-101  
Page 12 of 13  
LOCAL  
REMOTE  
(SITE = -1)  
(SITE = -2)  
NEND  
DS1  
T1  
DS1  
DLX  
DSX  
DS1  
T1  
DS1  
NEND  
TO NETWORK  
TO CUSTOMER  
KEY  
NEND means "PM information collected directly from  
incoming T1 signals, both at local and remote sites".  
10455-A  
Figure 101-9. DLX NEND Locations  
LOCAL  
REMOTE  
(SITE = -1)  
(SITE = -2)  
NEND  
DS1  
OPTICAL DS2  
OPTICAL DS2  
DS1  
DS1  
QLX  
OR  
QFLC  
ODS2  
DS1  
NEND  
TO CUSTOMER  
TO NETWORK  
KEY  
NEND means "PM information collected directly from  
incoming T1 signals, both at local and remote sites".  
10456-A  
Figure 101-10. ODS2 NEND Locations  
2-298  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-101  
Page 13 of 13  
LOCAL  
REMOTE  
(SITE = -2)  
(SITE = -1)  
NEND  
DS1  
FEND  
DS1  
T1  
Span  
Repeater  
RLX  
DS1  
T1  
DS1  
FEND  
NEND  
TO NETWORK  
TO CUSTOMER  
KEY  
NEND means "PM information collected directly from incoming T1 signals, both at  
local and remote sites".  
FEND means "ESF PM information collected at the opposite end of spans from the  
affected circuit and returned to the system via ESF datalink".The framing format  
must be ESF in order for FEND information to be displayed.  
10265-A  
Figure 101-11. RLX NEND and FEND Locations  
2-299  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-102  
Page 1 of 11  
PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTS DESCRIPTION  
The Craft Interface provides 15-Minute Performance Monitoring (PM), Daily PM, and Summary  
PM reports when you select Performance Monitoring at the Main Menu. Performance  
Monitoring reports are based on the data stored in the MPU memory.  
Note: Parameters that do not apply to a given module have a hyphen (-) replacing the  
numeric value in all PM reports.  
15-Minute Performance Monitoring Report  
This report displays the Mon Type PM data for the current 15-minute period and the previous  
thirty-two 15-minute periods.  
Daily Performance Monitoring Report  
This report displays the Mon Type PM data for the current day and the previous seven daily  
periods.  
Summary Performance Monitoring Report  
This report displays the Mon Type PM data for the previous 15-minute period, current 15-minute  
period, previous day, and current day.  
Performance Monitoring Reports are shown in Figure 102-1 (DS1 15-Minute) Figure 102-2  
(DS1 Daily), Figure 102-3 (DS1 Summary), Figure 102-4 (HDSL 15-Minute), Figure 102-5  
(HDSL Daily), and Figure 102-6 (HDSL Summary). Retrieve the Performance Monitoring  
Report that you wish to view.  
Reference: DLP-565 Performance Monitoring Reports Retrieval  
Mon Types  
The MPU evaluates the current counts and derived parameters for threshold violations once per  
second. There are 15-minute and daily threshold settings for all counts and derived parameters.  
These thresholds define the number of errors that constitute a 15-minute or daily threshold  
violation when exceeded. These 15-minute and daily thresholds may be set for any one or all the  
Mon Types. Mon Types and descriptions are given in Tables 102-1 and 102-2. For descriptions  
of locations where thresholds are monitored (such as FEND, NEND, REPC, REPR, CRP, and  
RRP), refer to Figure 102-7 (T1 system), Figure 102-8 (HDSL system), Figure 102-9 (DLX  
system), Figure 102-10 (ODS2 system), and Figure 102-11 (RLX system).  
2-300  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-102  
Page 2 of 11  
Note: In the DS1 Performance Reports screens, Figure 102-1 (DS1 15-Minute), Figure  
102-2 (DS1 Daily), Figure 102-3 (DS1 Summary), NE (Near End) and FE (Far End)  
apply to the entire time period (e.g., 00:15), not just the statistics that appear on their  
respective lines. In addition, the headings shown over each column apply respectively to  
each statistic in the column. For example, in Figure 102-1, “FCP” applies to the first  
column, first row; “CVL” applies to the first column, second row; and “ESL” applies to  
the first column, third row.  
Note: In Figure 102-1 (DS1 15-Minute), Figure 102-2 (DS1 Daily), Figure 102-3 (DS1  
Summary), Figure 102-4 (HDSL 15-Minute), Figure 102-5 (HDSL), and Figure 102-6  
(HDSL Summary), certain status abbreviations are used and are described below:  
COMPL means “Completed”.  
PRTL means “Partial” when all the statistics from the time period have not yet been  
compiled, or when data has been lost.  
NA means “Not Applicable” when SF framing is in use.  
2-301  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-102  
Page 3 of 11  
Table 102-1. DS1 Mon Type Descriptions  
LOCATION DESCRIPTION  
MON TYPE  
MEANING  
CVL  
Code Violation Line  
NEND Count of Bipolar Violations (BPV) and excessive  
zeros (EXZ) in the DS1 signal. Note: The maximum  
rate of indications across HDSL loops that the far end  
can report is 166.7 BPV per second (10,000 per  
minute).  
LOSS  
ESL  
Loss Of Signal  
Second  
NEND A second in which one or more Loss Of Signal defects  
occurred.  
Errored Second Line  
NEND A second in which there occurred one or more BPVs,  
one or more EXZs, or one or more LOS defects.  
SESL  
FCP  
Severely Errored  
Second Line  
NEND A second in which more than some user specified  
value of CVLs or one or more LOS defects occurred.  
Failure Count Path  
NEND A count of Loss Of Frame (LOF) or Alarm Indication  
Signal (AIS) failures within the interval. A failure is  
counted when the failure condition transitions from  
OFF to ON. Failure count is independent of the  
duration (in seconds) of the failure condition.  
CVP  
Code Violation Path  
NEND Count of (FE) Frame sync Errors in SF format or  
count of CRC errors in ESF format.  
AISSP  
SASP  
AIS Second Path  
NEND A second containing one or more AIS defects.  
SEF/AIS Second Path  
NEND A second containing one or more AISSPs or one or  
more SEF (Severely Errored Framing/OOF) defects.  
ESP  
Errored Second Path  
NEND SF framing format: this is a second in which there  
occurred one or more FE events, one or more SEF  
defects, or one or more AIS defects.  
ESF framing format: this is a second in which there  
occurred one or more CVP errors, one or more SEF  
defects, or one or more AIS defects.  
SESP  
Severely Errored  
Second Path  
NEND SF framing format: this is a second in which there  
occurred more than eight FE events, one or more SEF  
defects, or one or more AIS defects.  
ESF framing format: this is a second in which there  
occurred more than some user specified value of CVP  
errors, one or more SEF defects, or one or more AIS  
defects.  
Note: DS1 Path Parameters are collected at the HLXC for both directions, as shown in Figure 102-7.  
Note: Far-end parameters are not derived from defects detected in the incoming signal but rather from the  
PRM (Performance Report Messages) embedded in the incoming signal from the far end. A Remote Alarm  
Indication condition disallows reception of a valid PRM. The framing format must be ESF for FEND  
information to be transmitted and displayed.  
Note: For complete information on counts, refer to ANSI T1.231.  
(continued)  
2-302  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-102  
Page 4 of 11  
Table 102-1. DS1 Mon Type Descriptions, continued  
MON TYPE  
MEANING  
LOCATION DESCRIPTION  
UASP  
Unavailable Second  
Path  
NEND A count of second(s) in which the DS1 signal is not  
available. A signal becomes unavailable upon the  
completion of ten consecutive SESPs. A signal  
becomes available again at the completion of ten  
consecutive seconds with no SESPs. When a path is  
unavailable, no other PM counts are maintained.  
FCP-FE  
Failure Count Path  
FEND  
A count of Loss Of Frame (LOF) or Remote Alarm  
Indication (RAI) failures within the interval. This is  
also called a Yellow alarm. A failure is counted when  
the failure condition transitions from OFF to ON.  
Failure count is independent of the duration (in  
seconds) of the failure condition.  
ESL-FE  
CVP-FE  
Errored Second Line  
Code Violation Path  
FEND  
A second in which there occurred one or more BPVs, one  
or more EXZs, or one or more LOS defects. Derived  
from Line Code violation indicator in the PRM.  
FEND  
FEND  
FEND  
Count of CRC errors in ESF format. Derived from  
PRM GBIT (G1 – G6) indicators.  
SEFSP-FE Severely Errored  
Framing Second Path  
Derived from PRM Severely Errored Framing Event  
(SE).  
ESP-FE  
Errored Second Path  
This is a second in which there occurred one or more  
CVP errors, one or more SEF defects, or one or more  
AIS defects. Derived from PRM G1 - G6, SE, or Slip  
Event (SL) indicator, or the occurrence of an RAI  
failure.  
SESP-FE  
CSSP-FE  
Severely Errored  
Second Path  
FEND  
This is a second in which there occurred more than  
some user-specified value of CVP errors, one or more  
SEF defects, or one or more AIS defects.  
Controlled Slip  
second Path  
FEND  
FEND  
A second in which one or more controlled frame slips  
occurred. Derived from PRM SL indicator.  
UASP-FE Unavailable Second  
Path  
A count of second(s) in which the DS1 signal is not  
available. A signal becomes unavailable upon the  
completion of ten consecutive SESPs. A signal  
becomes available again at the completion of ten  
consecutive seconds with no SESPs. When a path is  
unavailable, no other PM counts are maintained.  
Derived from SESP-FEs.  
Note: DS1 Path Parameters are collected at the HLXC for both directions, as shown in Figure 102-7.  
Note: Far-end parameters are not derived from defects detected in the incoming signal but rather from  
the PRM (Performance Report Messages) embedded in the incoming signal from the far end. A Remote  
Alarm Indication condition disallows reception of a valid PRM. The framing format must be ESF for  
FEND information to be transmitted and displayed.  
Note: For complete information on counts, refer to ANSI T1.231.  
2-303  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-102  
Page 5 of 11  
Table 102-2. HDSL Mon Type Descriptions  
LOCATION DESCRIPTION  
NEND, FEND, REPC, Count of Loss Of Sync Word (LOSW)  
MON TYPE  
MEANING  
FCP  
Failure Count Path  
REPR, CRP, RRP* failures on the HDSL loop.  
CVP  
ESP  
Code Violation Path  
NEND, FEND, REPC, Count of CRC errors on the HDSL loop.  
REPR, CRP, RRP  
Errored Second Path NEND, FEND, REPC, A second in which one or more CRC  
REPR, CRP, RRP  
errors occurred on the HDSL loop, and  
no LOSW defects occurred.  
SESP  
Severely Errored  
Second Path  
NEND, FEND, REPC, A second in which the number of CRC  
REPR, CRP, RRP  
errors on the HDSL loop was greater  
than or equal to some user-specified  
value, and no LOSW defects occurred.  
SEFSP  
PA-H  
Severely Errored  
Framing Second Path REPR, CRP, RRP  
NEND, FEND, REPC, A second in which one or more LOSW  
defects occurred on the HDSL loop.  
Pulse Attenuation –  
High Path  
NEND, FEND, REPC, Highest Pulse Attenuation value detected  
REPR, CRP, RRP  
on the HDSL loop within the interval.  
This value is only updated when the  
HDSL loop is active. If the HDSL loop  
has never been activated, this value will  
be set to 0.  
SNR-L  
Signal-to-Noise Ratio NEND, FEND, REPC, Lowest SNR detected on the HDSL loop  
Low Path  
REPR, CRP, RRP  
within the interval. This value is only  
updated when the HDSL loop is active.  
If the HDSL loop has never been  
activated, this value will be set to 71.  
* For descriptions of locations where thresholds are monitored (such as FEND, NEND, REPC, REPR,  
CRP, and RRP), refer to Figure 102-7 (T1 system), Figure 102-8 (HDSL system), Figure 102-9 (DLX  
system), Figure 102-10 (ODS2 system), and Figure 102-11 (RLX system).  
2-304  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-102  
Page 6 of 11  
DS1 PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTS  
Group: 6  
Circuit: 1  
Site: LOCAL  
Report Type: 15-MINUTE  
Circuit ID:  
FCP  
CVL  
ESL  
SESL  
LOSS  
CVP  
ESP  
SESP  
UASP  
SASP  
AISSP  
FCP-FE ESP-FE CSSP-FE  
ESL-FE SESP-FE SEFSP-FE  
CVP-FE UASP-FE  
PERIOD  
STATUS  
======== =========== ======= ======= ======= ======= ======== ======= ========  
00:15  
NE: NA  
FE: NA  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
00:00  
NE: NA  
FE: NA  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Page 1 of 1  
Press CONTROL-A for assistance  
6651-B  
Figure 102-1. DS1 15-Minute Performance Monitoring Report  
DS1 PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTS  
Group: 6  
Circuit: 1  
Site: LOCAL  
Report Type: DAILY  
Circuit ID:  
FCP  
CVL  
ESL  
SESL  
LOSS  
CVP  
ESP  
SESP  
UASP  
SASP  
AISSP  
FCP-FE ESP-FE CSSP-FE  
ESL-FE SESP-FE SEFSP-FE  
CVP-FE UASP-FE  
PERIOD  
STATUS  
======== =========== ======= ======= ======= ======= ======== ======= ========  
01/01/93 NE: NA  
FE: NA  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Page 1 of 1  
Press CONTROL-A for assistance  
6652-B  
Figure 102-2. DS1 Daily Performance Monitoring Report  
2-305  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-102  
Page 7 of 11  
DS1 PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTS  
Group: 6  
Circuit: 1  
Site: LOCAL  
Report Type: SUMMARY  
Circuit ID:  
FCP  
CVL  
ESL  
SESL  
LOSS  
CVP  
ESP  
SESP  
UASP  
SASP  
AISSP  
FCP-FE ESP-FE CSSP-FE  
ESL-FE SESP-FE SEFSP-FE  
CVP-FE UASP-FE  
PERIOD  
STATUS  
======== =========== ======= ======= ======= ======= ======== ======= ========  
00:15  
NE: NA  
FE: NA  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
00:00  
NE: NA  
FE: NA  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
01/01/93 NE: NA  
FE: NA  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Page 1 of 1  
Press CONTROL-A for assistance  
6653-B  
Figure 102-3. DS1 Summary Performance Monitoring Report  
HDSL PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTS  
Group: 1  
Circuit: 2  
Circuit ID:  
Loop: 1  
Report Type: 15-MINUTE  
PERIOD  
LOCN STAT  
FCP  
CVP  
ESP  
SESP  
SEFSP  
PA-H  
SNR-L  
======== ==== ===== ======== ======= ======= ======= ======== ======= ========  
00:00  
23:45  
23:30  
23:15  
NEND COMPL  
FEND COMPL  
CRP1 COMPL  
RRP1 COMPL  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17  
17  
17  
17  
NEND COMPL  
FEND COMPL  
CRP2 COMPL  
RRP2 COMPL  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17  
17  
17  
17  
NEND COMPL  
FEND COMPL  
CRP1 COMPL  
RRP1 COMPL  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17  
17  
17  
17  
NEND COMPL  
0
0
0
0
0
0
17  
Page 2 of 9  
Press CONTROL-A for Assistance  
6655-B  
Figure 102-4. HDSL 15-Minute Performance Monitoring Report  
2-306  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-102  
Page 8 of 11  
HDSL PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTS  
Group: 1  
Circuit: 2  
Circuit ID:  
Loop: 1  
Report Type: DAILY  
PERIOD  
LOCN STAT  
FCP  
CVP  
ESP  
SESP  
SEFSP  
PA-H  
SNR-L  
======== ==== ===== ======== ======= ======= ======= ======== ======= ========  
06/01/98 NEND COMPL  
FEND COMPL  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17  
17  
17  
17  
REPR COMPL  
REPC COMPL  
Page 2 of 9  
Press CONTROL-A for Assistance  
11391-A  
Figure 102-5. HDSL Daily Performance Monitoring Report  
HDSL PERFORMANCE MONITORING REPORTS  
Group: 1  
Circuit: 2  
Circuit ID:  
Loop: 1  
Report Type: SUMMARY  
PERIOD  
LOCN STAT  
FCP  
CVP  
ESP  
SESP  
SEFSP  
PA-H  
SNR-L  
======== ==== ===== ======== ======= ======= ======= ======== ======= ========  
00:00  
NEND COMPL  
FEND COMPL  
REPR COMPL  
REPC COMPL  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
23:45  
NEND COMPL  
FEND COMPL  
REPR COMPL  
REPC COMPL  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
06/01/95 NEND COMPL  
FEND COMPL  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
REPR COMPL  
REPC COMPL  
Page 1 of 1  
Press CONTROL-A for Assistance  
6656-B  
Figure 102-6. HDSL Summary Performance Monitoring Report  
2-307  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-102  
Page 9 of 11  
LOCAL  
REMOTE  
(SITE = -1)  
(SITE = -2)  
DS1  
DS1  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 2  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 2  
DS1  
DS1  
A
FEND  
NEND  
NEND  
FEND  
2
HLXC  
HRX  
HLXR  
TO NETWORK  
KEY  
TO CUSTOMER  
NEND means "PM information collected directly from incoming T1 signals, both at local and remote sites."  
FEND means "ESF PRM information collected at the opposite ends of spans from the affected circuit and  
returned to the system via the ESF Datalink, both at local and remote sites". The framing format must be  
ESF in order for FEND information to be displayed.  
Note: For Site 1, FEND information is at A; for Site 2, FEND information is at 2.  
11377-A  
Figure 102-7. T1 HLXC/HRX/HLXR NEND and FEND Locations  
CRP1  
XCVR  
RRP1  
XCVR  
CRP2  
XCVR  
RRP2  
XCVR  
NEND  
FEND  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 1  
LOOP 2  
LOOP 1  
HLXC  
HRX1  
HRX2  
HLXR  
LOOP 2  
LOOP 2  
XCVR  
CRP1  
XCVR  
RRP1  
XCVR  
CRP2  
XCVR  
RRP2  
NEND  
TO NETWORK/MUX  
FEND  
TO CUSTOMER  
KEY  
NEND means "at the HLXC, looking toward the customer (HLXR)."  
FEND means "at the HLXR, looking toward the network (HLXC)."  
CRP1 means "at the central office side of the HRX1, looking toward the network (HLXC)."  
RRP1 means "at the remote (CPE) side of the HRX1, looking toward the customer (HRX2/HLXR)."  
CRP2 means "at the central office side of the HRX2, looking toward the network (HRX1/HLXC)."  
RRP2 means "at the remote (CPE) side of the HRX2, looking toward the customer (HLXR)."  
CRP1 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 1 (TL1)  
RRP1 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 2 (TL1)  
CRP2 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 3 (TL1)  
RRP2 (Alarm History, PM Reports, and Status screens) = LINE 4 (TL1)  
NOTE: CRP2 and RRP2 are not present when there is no HRX2.  
11375-B  
Figure 102-8. HDSL HLXC/HRX/HLXR NEND and FEND Locations  
2-308  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-102  
Page 10 of 11  
LOCAL  
REMOTE  
(SITE = -2)  
(SITE = -1)  
NEND  
DS1  
T1  
DS1  
DLX  
DSX  
DS1  
T1  
DS1  
NEND  
TO NETWORK  
TO CUSTOMER  
KEY  
NEND means "PM information collected directly from  
incoming T1 signals, both at local and remote sites".  
10455-A  
Figure 102-9. DLX NEND Locations  
LOCAL  
REMOTE  
(SITE = -1)  
(SITE = -2)  
NEND  
DS1  
OPTICAL DS2  
OPTICAL DS2  
DS1  
DS1  
QLX  
OR  
QFLC  
ODS2  
DS1  
NEND  
TO CUSTOMER  
TO NETWORK  
KEY  
NEND means "PM information collected directly from  
incoming T1 signals, both at local and remote sites".  
10456-A  
Figure 102-10. ODS2 NEND Locations  
2-309  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-102  
Page 11 of 11  
LOCAL  
REMOTE  
(SITE = -1)  
(SITE = -2)  
NEND  
DS1  
FEND  
DS1  
T1  
Span  
Repeater  
RLX  
DS1  
T1  
DS1  
FEND  
NEND  
TO NETWORK  
TO CUSTOMER  
KEY  
NEND means "PM information collected directly from incoming T1 signals, both at  
local and remote sites".  
FEND means "ESF PM information collected at the opposite end of spans from the  
affected circuit and returned to the system via ESF datalink".The framing format  
must be ESF in order for FEND information to be displayed.  
10265-A  
Figure 102-11. RLX NEND and FEND Locations  
2-310  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-103  
Page 1 of 1  
LOCAL CRAFT INTERFACE CONNECTION TROUBLESHOOTING  
This TAP describes how to troubleshoot local Craft Interface connections.  
1. Verify that you have the correct cable and connectors for the port you intend to use:  
A straight-through RS-232 25-pin D-sub female connectorized cable is required to  
connect to the MPU.  
A null-modem RS-232 25-pin D-sub female connectorized cable is required to connect  
to chassis Port 2 or 3.  
Reference: DLP-504 Local Craft Interface Connection  
2. Verify that the cable length is correct for your application by referring to the EIA-232  
protocol. The maximum length is 50 feet.  
3. Verify that the cables and connectors are in good working condition.  
4. Verify that you are using a control terminal (VT-100 or equivalent) or a host computer with  
VT-100 emulation.  
5. Verify that the MPU is functioning properly by re-installing it. This procedure is non-  
service-affecting.  
Reference: DLP-502 MPU Installation and Testing  
Reference: DLP-519 MPU Replacement and Testing  
6. If you are using chassis Port 2 or 3 and are unable to logon to the local Craft Interface after  
following Steps 1 through 5:  
Verify that Port 2 or 3 is configured for CRAFT through a connection to the MPU Craft  
Port.  
Note: Ports 2 and 3 must be configured through the Craft Interface first before they can  
be used because they do not default to CRAFT.  
Reference: DLP-504 Local Craft Interface Connection  
Reference: DLP-549 Serial Port Configuration  
7. If you are using the MPU Craft Port and are unable to logon to the local Craft Interface  
after following Steps 1 through 6:  
Check your records to see if the MPU has been reconfigured for a different interface  
than Craft, such as a TBOS or TL1 interface.  
Note: The MPU Craft Port defaults to CRAFT but can also be configured for TBOS,  
TL1 or NONE. Refer to the TBOS and TL1 sections in this manual for additional  
information.  
Reference: DLP-549 Serial Port Configuration  
2-311  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-104  
Page 1 of 3  
DUAL REPEATER INCOMPATIBILITY DIAGNOSIS  
Summary: This TAP describes how to diagnose dual repeater software (MPU V5.2)  
incompatibilities for HLXCs, HLXRs, and HRXs; and also describes how they are reported. Except  
where noted, system configurations are assumed to include two HRXs, and the HLXCs and HLXRs  
are assumed to be compatible with MPU V5.2.  
HLXC  
An incompatible HLXC is any Version D or earlier HLXC without software support for a second  
HRX. In such a case, the HRX1 will detect the incompatible HLXR, set the alarm bit, and report  
“2ND-HRX-IN” in the serial number in its inventory data to “2ND-HRX-IN”. If the HLXC is a  
Version D or earlier, and the HRX1 is a Version A, incompatibilities are not detectable. (Note:  
Version C or earlier HLXCs do not support any HRXs. However, a Version B HRX in the HRX1  
position will set an alarm bit for an incompatible HLXR.) The MPU should activate the “Version  
Mismatch” alarm and display the HRX inventory with the corrupted serial number.  
Reference: DLP-540  
HLXR  
Inventory Display  
An incompatible HLXR is any Version D or earlier HLXR without software support for a second  
HRX. In such a case, the HRX1 will detect the incompatible HLXR, set the alarm bit, and report  
“2ND-HRX-IN” in the serial number in its inventory data to “2ND-HRX-IN”. (Note: In addition,  
when Version B and C HLXRs are used, the HRX2 must shut off power to the HLXR to avoid  
damage.) The MPU should activate the “Version Mismatch” alarm and display the HRX  
inventory with the corrupted serial number.  
HRX1  
An incompatible HRX1 is any Version A HRX that has another HRX between it and the HLXR.  
This is diagnosed by the HLXC when it finds an HRX2 in the system. If the HLXC is a Version  
D or earlier, it cannot set the alarm bit for the incompatible HRX1, or corrupt the serial number.  
The HLXC will set the alarm bit for the incompatible HRX1 and report “OLD-HRX-IN” in the  
serial number field of the HRX1 inventory. Thus, a Version D (or earlier) HLXC with a Version  
A HRX in the first position (HRX1) cannot be diagnosed at all. The MPU should also activate the  
“Version Mismatch” alarm and display the corrupted serial number. If the HLXC is a Version D or  
earlier, the alarm bit for dual repeater incompatibility cannot be set. Thus, the MPU can only  
display the corrupted serial number.  
2-312  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-104  
Page 2 of 3  
HRX2  
An incompatible HRX2 is a Version A HRX that has another HRX between it and the HLXC. This  
is diagnosed by the HRX1. As a result, systems with two incompatible HRXs cannot be diagnosed.  
The HLXC will set the alarm bit for the incompatible HRX2 and report “OLD-HRX-IN” in the  
serial number of field of the HRX2 inventory. The MPU should activate the “Version Mismatch”  
alarm and display the corrupted serial number.  
HRX3  
A third HRX is always incompatible. This situation is diagnosed by the HRX2. As a result, systems  
with three HRXs when the HRX2 is a Version A cannot be diagnosed. The HRX2 will set the serial  
number in the HRX2 inventory data to “3RD-HRX-IN.” The HLXC will set the alarm bit for the  
incompatible HLXR. The MPU should activate the “Version Mismatch” alarm and display the  
corrupted serial number. If the HLXC is a Version D or earlier, the alarm bit for dual repeater  
incompatibility cannot be set. Thus, the MPU can only display the corrupted serial number.  
Dual Repeater Compatibility Indicators  
Table 104-1 shows the various configurations that should be tested for dual repeater  
compatibility issues. All legal configurations require extensive testing.  
2-313  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 2: Operation and Maintenance  
TAP-104  
Page 3 of 3  
Table 104-1. Dual Repeater Compatibility Indicators  
UNIT TYPE  
HRX2**  
INCOMPATIBILITY  
INDICATOR  
CORRUPTED  
HLXC*  
HRX1**  
HRX3  
HLXR***  
SERIAL NUMBER  
NO INCOMPATIBILITIES  
New  
New  
Old  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
New  
Old  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
None  
--  
--  
--  
New  
New  
New  
New  
Old  
New  
Old  
New  
New  
Old  
New  
Old  
New  
Old  
New  
--  
--  
New  
New  
Old  
--  
--  
--  
New  
Old  
Old  
--  
New  
New  
--  
Old  
New  
New  
SINGLE INCOMPATIBILITIES  
Old  
New  
New  
New  
New  
New  
Old  
New  
New  
Old  
--  
New  
New  
New  
Old  
HLXR  
HRX1  
HRX2  
HLXR  
HLXR  
2ND-HRX1-IN  
OLD-HRX1-IN  
OLD-HRX2-IN  
--  
New  
New  
New  
--  
--  
New  
New  
2ND-HRX1-IN  
Old/New  
New  
3RD-HRX2-IN  
UNDETECTABLE INCOMPATIBILITIES  
Old  
Old  
Old  
Old/New  
Old  
Any  
Any  
Old/New  
Old/New  
Undetectable  
Undetectable  
Not Shown  
Not Shown  
Old/New  
*
“New” HLXC refers to the Version E HLXC; “Old” HLXC refers to the Version D (or earlier) HLXC.  
** “New” HRX refers to the Version B HRX; “Old” HRX refers to the Version A HRX.  
*** “New” HLXR refers to the Version E HLXR; “Old” HLXR refers to the Version D (or earlier) HLXR.  
The corrupted serial numbers shown in these examples will appear in the Craft Interface’s  
Inventory Status screen if the incompatibility is present.  
2-314  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 3: General Information  
SECTION 3: GENERAL INFORMATION  
Content  
Page  
1
2
3
4
5
6
WARRANTY/SOFTWARE ............................................................... 3-1  
REPAIR/ADVANCE REPLACEMENT POLICY................................................... 3-1  
REPAIR CHARGES ................................................................... 3-2  
REPLACEMENT/SPARE PRODUCTS........................................................ 3-2  
RETURNED MATERIAL ................................................................ 3-2  
CUSTOMER INFORMATION AND ASSISTANCE ................................................ 3-3  
1 WARRANTY/SOFTWARE  
The Product and Software warranty policy and warranty period for all Products of ADC  
Telecommunications, Inc. (hereinafter referred to as ADC) is published in ADC’s Warranty/  
Software Handbook. Contact the Business Broadband Group (BBG) Technical Assistance  
Center at 1-800-366-3891, extension 3223 (in U.S.A. or Canada) or 952-946-3223 (outside  
U.S.A. and Canada) for warranty or software information or for a copy of the  
Warranty/Software Handbook.  
2 REPAIR/ADVANCE REPLACEMENT POLICY  
All repairs of ADC Products must be done by ADC or an authorized representative. Any  
attempt to repair or modify ADC Products without prior written authorization from ADC shall  
void ADC’s warranty.  
If a malfunction cannot be resolved by the normal troubleshooting procedures, call the BBG  
Technical Assistance Center at 1-800-366-3891, extension 3223 (in U.S.A. or Canada) or  
952-946-3223 (outside U.S.A. and Canada). A telephone consultation can sometimes resolve a  
problem without the need to repair or replace the ADC Product.  
If, during a telephone consultation, ADC determines the ADC Product requires repair, ADC  
will authorize the return of the affected Product by the issue of a Return Material  
Authorization number and complete return shipping instructions. If service is affected, ADC  
can arrange to ship a replacement Product when available from designated inventory. In all  
cases, the defective Product must be carefully packaged to eliminate damage, and returned to  
ADC in accordance with issued ADC instructions.  
Page 3-1  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 3: General Information  
3 REPAIR CHARGES  
If the defect and the necessary repairs are covered by warranty, Buyer’s only obligation is the  
payment of all transportation and associated costs in returning the defective Product to the  
location designated by ADC. ADC, at its option, will either repair or replace the Product at no  
charge and return the Product to Buyer with transportation costs paid by ADC, only when  
ADC contracted carriers are used. Requested return of Product by any other means will be at  
Buyer’s cost. Buyer is responsible for all other associated costs in return of Products from  
ADC. If Product is Out of Warranty or NTF (no trouble found), ADC will charge a percentage  
of the current Product list price. To obtain the percentage factor for Out of Warranty or NTF  
Product, contact the ADC Product Return Department at 1-800-366-3891, extension 3000 (in  
U.S.A. or Canada) or 952-946-3000 (outside U.S.A. and Canada).  
If a service affecting advance replacement Product is requested, the current list price of a new  
Product will be charged initially. A customer purchase order is required to ship an advance  
replacement Product. Upon receipt of the defective Product, there will be no credit issued by  
ADC to the buyer for any returned Product found to be Out of Warranty. ADC will credit buyer  
eighty percent (80%) of Product price charged for any In Warranty Product under the Program  
terms. Products must be returned within thirty (30) days to be eligible for any advance  
replacement credit. If repairs necessitate a field visit by an ADC representative, a customer  
authorization (purchase order) must be obtained prior to dispatching a representative. ADC will  
charge the current price of a field visit plus round trip transportation charges from Minneapolis  
to the customer’s site.  
4 REPLACEMENT/SPARE PRODUCTS  
Replacement parts, including but not limited to button caps and lenses, lamps, fuses, and patch  
cords, are available from ADC on a special order basis. Contact the BBG Technical  
Assistance Center at 1-800-366-3891, extension 3223 (in U.S.A. or Canada) or 952-946-3223  
(outside U.S.A. and Canada) for additional information.  
Spare Products and accessories can be purchased from ADC. Contact Sales Administration at 1-  
800-366-3891, extension 3000 (in U.S.A. or Canada) or 952-946-3000 (outside U.S.A. and  
Canada) for a price quote and to place your order.  
5 RETURNED MATERIAL  
Contact the ADC Product Return Department at 1-800-366-3891, extension 3000 (in U.S.A.  
or Canada) or 952-946-3000 (outside U.S.A. and Canada) to obtain a Return Material  
Authorization number prior to returning an ADC Product.  
All returned Products must have a Return Material Authorization (RMA) number clearly  
marked on the outside of the package. The Return Material Authorization number is valid for  
thirty (30) days from authorization.  
Page 3-2  
2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADCP-61-471 • Issue 4 • June 2000 • Section 3: General Information  
6 CUSTOMER INFORMATION AND ASSISTANCE  
For customers wanting information on ADC products or help in using them, ADC offers the  
services listed below. To obtain any of these services by telephone, first dial the central ADC  
telephone number, then dial the extension provided below.  
The central number for calls originating in the U.S.A. or Canada is 1-800-366-3891. For calls  
originating outside the U.S.A. or Canada, dial country code “1” then dial 952-946-3000.  
Sales Assistance  
Extension 3000  
• Quotation Proposals  
• Ordering and Delivery  
• General Product Information  
Systems Integration  
Extension 3000  
• Complete Solutions (from Concept to Installation)  
• Network Design and Integration Testing  
• System Turn-Up and Testing  
• Network Monitoring (Upstream or Downstream)  
• Power Monitoring and Remote Surveillance  
• Service/Maintenance Agreements  
• Systems Operation  
BBG Technical Assistance Center • Technical Information  
Extension 3223  
• System/Network Configuration  
• Product Specification and Application  
• Training (Product-Specific)  
• Installation and Operation Assistance  
• Troubleshooting and Repair/Field Assistance  
Product Return Department  
Extension 3748  
E-Mail: repair&[email protected]  
• ADC Return Authorization number and instructions must  
be obtained before returning products.  
Product information may also be obtained using the ADC web site at www.adc.com or by  
writing ADC Telecommunications, Inc., P.O. Box 1101, Minneapolis, MN 55440-1101, U.S.A.  
Contents herein are current as of the date of publication. ADC reserves the right to change the contents without prior notice. In  
no event shall ADC be liable for any damages resulting from loss of data, loss of use, or loss of profits and ADC further  
disclaims any and all liability for indirect, incidental, special, consequential or other similar damages. This disclaimer of  
liability applies to all products, publications and services during and after the warranty period.  
This publication may be verified at any time by contacting ADC’s Technical Assistance Center at 1-800-366-3891, extension  
3223 (in U.S.A. or Canada) or 952-946-3223 (outside U.S.A. and Canada), or by writing to ADC Telecommunications, Inc.,  
Attn: Technical Assistance Center, Mail Station #77, P.O. Box 1101, Minneapolis, MN 55440-1101, U.S.A.  
© 2000, ADC Telecommunications, Inc.  
All Rights Reserved  
Printed in U.S.A.  
Page 3-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
www.adc.com  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Acer Personal Computer R920 Series User Manual
ADC Network Router LSX 288 User Manual
Adesso Computer Keyboard AKB 131PB User Manual
AIPTEK Camcorder A V5Z5S User Manual
Airlink101 Switch AKVM 2UA User Manual
Allied Telesis Switch 48W User Manual
American Standard Plumbing Product 2018 User Manual
Bacharach Carbon Monoxide Alarm Dual Purpose Leak Detector User Manual
Beko DVD Player DVD 2008 User Manual
Beko MP3 Player MP 300 R User Manual